diff --git a/.gitignore b/.gitignore index 64b5e1221c04..f632636e0fdd 100644 --- a/.gitignore +++ b/.gitignore @@ -3,6 +3,7 @@ ## Dear ImGui artifacts imgui.ini +imgui*.ini ## General build artifacts *.o diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_allegro5.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_allegro5.cpp index 03a457082c0f..db366fa742b0 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_allegro5.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_allegro5.cpp @@ -62,8 +62,8 @@ #ifdef _WIN32 #include #endif -#define ALLEGRO_HAS_CLIPBOARD (ALLEGRO_VERSION_INT >= ((5 << 24) | (1 << 16) | (12 << 8))) // Clipboard only supported from Allegro 5.1.12 -#define ALLEGRO_HAS_DRAW_INDEXED_PRIM (ALLEGRO_VERSION_INT >= ((5 << 24) | (2 << 16) | ( 5 << 8))) // DX9 implementation of al_draw_indexed_prim() got fixed in Allegro 5.2.5 +#define ALLEGRO_HAS_CLIPBOARD ((ALLEGRO_VERSION_INT & ~ALLEGRO_UNSTABLE_BIT) >= ((5 << 24) | (1 << 16) | (12 << 8))) // Clipboard only supported from Allegro 5.1.12 +#define ALLEGRO_HAS_DRAW_INDEXED_PRIM ((ALLEGRO_VERSION_INT & ~ALLEGRO_UNSTABLE_BIT) >= ((5 << 24) | (2 << 16) | ( 5 << 8))) // DX9 implementation of al_draw_indexed_prim() got fixed in Allegro 5.2.5 // Visual Studio warnings #ifdef _MSC_VER diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.cpp index 883917875fa3..3058916243a4 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.cpp @@ -20,6 +20,9 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-07-08: *BREAKING* Renamed ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback to ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(), added GLFWWindow* parameter. +// 2024-07-08: Emscripten: Added support for GLFW3 contrib port (GLFW 3.4.0 features + bug fixes): to enable, replace -sUSE_GLFW=3 with --use-port=contrib.glfw3 (requires emscripten 3.1.59+) (https://github.com/pongasoft/emscripten-glfw) +// 2024-07-02: Emscripten: Added io.PlatformOpenInShellFn() handler for Emscripten versions. // 2023-12-19: Emscripten: Added ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback() to register canvas selector and auto-resize GLFW window. // 2023-10-05: Inputs: Added support for extra ImGuiKey values: F13 to F24 function keys. // 2023-07-18: Inputs: Revert ignoring mouse data on GLFW_CURSOR_DISABLED as it can be used differently. User may set ImGuiConfigFLags_NoMouse if desired. (#5625, #6609) @@ -100,6 +103,11 @@ #ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ #include #include +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_PORT_CONTRIB_GLFW3 +#include +#else +#define EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 +#endif #endif // We gather version tests as define in order to easily see which features are version-dependent. @@ -131,7 +139,7 @@ struct ImGui_ImplGlfw_Data ImVec2 LastValidMousePos; bool InstalledCallbacks; bool CallbacksChainForAllWindows; -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 const char* CanvasSelector; #endif @@ -145,7 +153,7 @@ struct ImGui_ImplGlfw_Data GLFWcharfun PrevUserCallbackChar; GLFWmonitorfun PrevUserCallbackMonitor; #ifdef _WIN32 - WNDPROC GlfwWndProc; + WNDPROC PrevWndProc; #endif ImGui_ImplGlfw_Data() { memset((void*)this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } @@ -335,7 +343,7 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_ScrollCallback(GLFWwindow* window, double xoffset, double yo if (bd->PrevUserCallbackScroll != nullptr && ImGui_ImplGlfw_ShouldChainCallback(window)) bd->PrevUserCallbackScroll(window, xoffset, yoffset); -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 // Ignore GLFW events: will be processed in ImGui_ImplEmscripten_WheelCallback(). return; #endif @@ -346,7 +354,7 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_ScrollCallback(GLFWwindow* window, double xoffset, double yo static int ImGui_ImplGlfw_TranslateUntranslatedKey(int key, int scancode) { -#if GLFW_HAS_GETKEYNAME && !defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) +#if GLFW_HAS_GETKEYNAME && !defined(EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3) // GLFW 3.1+ attempts to "untranslate" keys, which goes the opposite of what every other framework does, making using lettered shortcuts difficult. // (It had reasons to do so: namely GLFW is/was more likely to be used for WASD-type game controls rather than lettered shortcuts, but IHMO the 3.1 change could have been done differently) // See https://github.com/glfw/glfw/issues/1502 for details. @@ -357,7 +365,7 @@ static int ImGui_ImplGlfw_TranslateUntranslatedKey(int key, int scancode) GLFWerrorfun prev_error_callback = glfwSetErrorCallback(nullptr); const char* key_name = glfwGetKeyName(key, scancode); glfwSetErrorCallback(prev_error_callback); -#if GLFW_HAS_GETERROR && !defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) // Eat errors (see #5908) +#if GLFW_HAS_GETERROR && !defined(EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3) // Eat errors (see #5908) (void)glfwGetError(nullptr); #endif if (key_name && key_name[0] != 0 && key_name[1] == 0) @@ -454,7 +462,7 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_MonitorCallback(GLFWmonitor*, int) // Unused in 'master' branch but 'docking' branch will use this, so we declare it ahead of it so if you have to install callbacks you can install this one too. } -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 static EM_BOOL ImGui_ImplEmscripten_WheelCallback(int, const EmscriptenWheelEvent* ev, void*) { // Mimic Emscripten_HandleWheel() in SDL. @@ -497,7 +505,7 @@ static LRESULT CALLBACK ImGui_ImplGlfw_WndProc(HWND hWnd, UINT msg, WPARAM wPara ImGui::GetIO().AddMouseSourceEvent(GetMouseSourceFromMessageExtraInfo()); break; } - return ::CallWindowProcW(bd->GlfwWndProc, hWnd, msg, wParam, lParam); + return ::CallWindowProcW(bd->PrevWndProc, hWnd, msg, wParam, lParam); } #endif @@ -553,6 +561,10 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_SetCallbacksChainForAllWindows(bool chain_for_all_windows) bd->CallbacksChainForAllWindows = chain_for_all_windows; } +#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +EM_JS(void, ImGui_ImplGlfw_EmscriptenOpenURL, (char const* url), { url = url ? UTF8ToString(url) : null; if (url) window.open(url, '_blank'); }); +#endif + static bool ImGui_ImplGlfw_Init(GLFWwindow* window, bool install_callbacks, GlfwClientApi client_api) { ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); @@ -573,6 +585,9 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplGlfw_Init(GLFWwindow* window, bool install_callbacks, Glfw io.SetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplGlfw_SetClipboardText; io.GetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplGlfw_GetClipboardText; io.ClipboardUserData = bd->Window; +#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ + io.PlatformOpenInShellFn = [](ImGuiContext*, const char* url) { ImGui_ImplGlfw_EmscriptenOpenURL(url); return true; }; +#endif // Create mouse cursors // (By design, on X11 cursors are user configurable and some cursors may be missing. When a cursor doesn't exist, @@ -603,15 +618,10 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplGlfw_Init(GLFWwindow* window, bool install_callbacks, Glfw // Chain GLFW callbacks: our callbacks will call the user's previously installed callbacks, if any. if (install_callbacks) ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallCallbacks(window); - // Register Emscripten Wheel callback to workaround issue in Emscripten GLFW Emulation (#6096) - // We intentionally do not check 'if (install_callbacks)' here, as some users may set it to false and call GLFW callback themselves. - // FIXME: May break chaining in case user registered their own Emscripten callback? -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ - emscripten_set_wheel_callback(EMSCRIPTEN_EVENT_TARGET_DOCUMENT, nullptr, false, ImGui_ImplEmscripten_WheelCallback); -#endif // Set platform dependent data in viewport ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + main_viewport->PlatformHandle = (void*)bd->Window; #ifdef _WIN32 main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = glfwGetWin32Window(bd->Window); #elif defined(__APPLE__) @@ -622,8 +632,8 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplGlfw_Init(GLFWwindow* window, bool install_callbacks, Glfw // Windows: register a WndProc hook so we can intercept some messages. #ifdef _WIN32 - bd->GlfwWndProc = (WNDPROC)::GetWindowLongPtrW((HWND)main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw, GWLP_WNDPROC); - IM_ASSERT(bd->GlfwWndProc != nullptr); + bd->PrevWndProc = (WNDPROC)::GetWindowLongPtrW((HWND)main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw, GWLP_WNDPROC); + IM_ASSERT(bd->PrevWndProc != nullptr); ::SetWindowLongPtrW((HWND)main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw, GWLP_WNDPROC, (LONG_PTR)ImGui_ImplGlfw_WndProc); #endif @@ -654,18 +664,19 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_Shutdown() if (bd->InstalledCallbacks) ImGui_ImplGlfw_RestoreCallbacks(bd->Window); -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ - emscripten_set_wheel_callback(EMSCRIPTEN_EVENT_TARGET_DOCUMENT, nullptr, false, nullptr); +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 + if (bd->CanvasSelector) + emscripten_set_wheel_callback(bd->CanvasSelector, nullptr, false, nullptr); #endif for (ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_n = 0; cursor_n < ImGuiMouseCursor_COUNT; cursor_n++) glfwDestroyCursor(bd->MouseCursors[cursor_n]); - // Windows: register a WndProc hook so we can intercept some messages. + // Windows: restore our WndProc hook #ifdef _WIN32 ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); - ::SetWindowLongPtrW((HWND)main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw, GWLP_WNDPROC, (LONG_PTR)bd->GlfwWndProc); - bd->GlfwWndProc = nullptr; + ::SetWindowLongPtrW((HWND)main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw, GWLP_WNDPROC, (LONG_PTR)bd->PrevWndProc); + bd->PrevWndProc = nullptr; #endif io.BackendPlatformName = nullptr; @@ -682,7 +693,7 @@ static void ImGui_ImplGlfw_UpdateMouseData() // (those braces are here to reduce diff with multi-viewports support in 'docking' branch) { GLFWwindow* window = bd->Window; -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 const bool is_window_focused = true; #else const bool is_window_focused = glfwGetWindowAttrib(window, GLFW_FOCUSED) != 0; @@ -740,7 +751,7 @@ static void ImGui_ImplGlfw_UpdateGamepads() return; io.BackendFlags &= ~ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad; -#if GLFW_HAS_GAMEPAD_API && !defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) +#if GLFW_HAS_GAMEPAD_API && !defined(EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3) GLFWgamepadstate gamepad; if (!glfwGetGamepadState(GLFW_JOYSTICK_1, &gamepad)) return; @@ -814,7 +825,7 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_NewFrame() ImGui_ImplGlfw_UpdateGamepads(); } -#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +#ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_EMBEDDED_GLFW3 static EM_BOOL ImGui_ImplGlfw_OnCanvasSizeChange(int event_type, const EmscriptenUiEvent* event, void* user_data) { ImGui_ImplGlfw_Data* bd = (ImGui_ImplGlfw_Data*)user_data; @@ -835,7 +846,7 @@ static EM_BOOL ImGui_ImplEmscripten_FullscreenChangeCallback(int event_type, con // 'canvas_selector' is a CSS selector. The event listener is applied to the first element that matches the query. // STRING MUST PERSIST FOR THE APPLICATION DURATION. PLEASE USE A STRING LITERAL OR ENSURE POINTER WILL STAY VALID. -void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback(const char* canvas_selector) +void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(GLFWwindow*, const char* canvas_selector) { IM_ASSERT(canvas_selector != nullptr); ImGui_ImplGlfw_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplGlfw_GetBackendData(); @@ -847,8 +858,24 @@ void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback(const char* canvas_sel // Change the size of the GLFW window according to the size of the canvas ImGui_ImplGlfw_OnCanvasSizeChange(EMSCRIPTEN_EVENT_RESIZE, {}, bd); + + // Register Emscripten Wheel callback to workaround issue in Emscripten GLFW Emulation (#6096) + // We intentionally do not check 'if (install_callbacks)' here, as some users may set it to false and call GLFW callback themselves. + // FIXME: May break chaining in case user registered their own Emscripten callback? + emscripten_set_wheel_callback(bd->CanvasSelector, nullptr, false, ImGui_ImplEmscripten_WheelCallback); } -#endif +#elif defined(EMSCRIPTEN_USE_PORT_CONTRIB_GLFW3) +// When using --use-port=contrib.glfw3 for the GLFW implementation, you can override the behavior of this call +// by invoking emscripten_glfw_make_canvas_resizable afterward. +// See https://github.com/pongasoft/emscripten-glfw/blob/master/docs/Usage.md#how-to-make-the-canvas-resizable-by-the-user for an explanation +void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(GLFWwindow* window, const char* canvas_selector) +{ + GLFWwindow* w = (GLFWwindow*)(EM_ASM_INT({ return Module.glfwGetWindow(UTF8ToString($0)); }, canvas_selector)); + IM_ASSERT(window == w); // Sanity check + IM_UNUSED(w); + emscripten_glfw_make_canvas_resizable(window, "window", nullptr); +} +#endif // #ifdef EMSCRIPTEN_USE_PORT_CONTRIB_GLFW3 //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.h b/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.h index 6a9acd05b27d..a30ed64cabce 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.h +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_glfw.h @@ -30,9 +30,10 @@ IMGUI_IMPL_API bool ImGui_ImplGlfw_InitForOther(GLFWwindow* window, bool ins IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplGlfw_Shutdown(); IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplGlfw_NewFrame(); -// Emscripten related initialization phase methods +// Emscripten related initialization phase methods (call after ImGui_ImplGlfw_InitForOpenGL) #ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ -IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback(const char* canvas_selector); +IMGUI_IMPL_API void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(GLFWwindow* window, const char* canvas_selector); +//static inline void ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback(const char* canvas_selector) { ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(nullptr, canvas_selector); } } // Renamed in 1.91.0 #endif // GLFW callbacks install diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_opengl2.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_opengl2.cpp index 3eb092afd615..7f1ea325aa87 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_opengl2.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_opengl2.cpp @@ -22,6 +22,7 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-06-28: OpenGL: ImGui_ImplOpenGL2_NewFrame() recreates font texture if it has been destroyed by ImGui_ImplOpenGL2_DestroyFontsTexture(). (#7748) // 2022-10-11: Using 'nullptr' instead of 'NULL' as per our switch to C++11. // 2021-12-08: OpenGL: Fixed mishandling of the ImDrawCmd::IdxOffset field! This is an old bug but it never had an effect until some internal rendering changes in 1.86. // 2021-06-29: Reorganized backend to pull data from a single structure to facilitate usage with multiple-contexts (all g_XXXX access changed to bd->XXXX). @@ -113,6 +114,8 @@ void ImGui_ImplOpenGL2_NewFrame() if (!bd->FontTexture) ImGui_ImplOpenGL2_CreateDeviceObjects(); + if (!bd->FontTexture) + ImGui_ImplOpenGL2_CreateFontsTexture(); } static void ImGui_ImplOpenGL2_SetupRenderState(ImDrawData* draw_data, int fb_width, int fb_height) diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp index 58603a047324..7087a7c5706d 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_opengl3.cpp @@ -22,6 +22,7 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-06-28: OpenGL: ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_NewFrame() recreates font texture if it has been destroyed by ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyFontsTexture(). (#7748) // 2024-05-07: OpenGL: Update loader for Linux to support EGL/GLVND. (#7562) // 2024-04-16: OpenGL: Detect ES3 contexts on desktop based on version string, to e.g. avoid calling glPolygonMode() on them. (#7447) // 2024-01-09: OpenGL: Update GL3W based imgui_impl_opengl3_loader.h to load "libGL.so" and variants, fixing regression on distros missing a symlink. @@ -123,6 +124,7 @@ // Clang/GCC warnings with -Weverything #if defined(__clang__) #pragma clang diagnostic push +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunknown-warning-option" // warning: ignore unknown flags #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning: use of old-style cast #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion changes signedness #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-macros" // warning: macro is not used @@ -402,6 +404,8 @@ void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_NewFrame() if (!bd->ShaderHandle) ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateDeviceObjects(); + if (!bd->FontTexture) + ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_CreateFontsTexture(); } static void ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_SetupRenderState(ImDrawData* draw_data, int fb_width, int fb_height, GLuint vertex_array_object) diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_osx.mm b/backends/imgui_impl_osx.mm index 322798022914..ab0e0ecc62fe 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_osx.mm +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_osx.mm @@ -29,6 +29,7 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-07-02: Update for io.SetPlatformImeDataFn() -> io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() renaming in main library. // 2023-10-05: Inputs: Added support for extra ImGuiKey values: F13 to F20 function keys. Stopped mapping F13 into PrintScreen. // 2023-04-09: Inputs: Added support for io.AddMouseSourceEvent() to discriminate ImGuiMouseSource_Mouse/ImGuiMouseSource_Pen. // 2023-02-01: Fixed scroll wheel scaling for devices emitting events with hasPreciseScrollingDeltas==false (e.g. non-Apple mices). @@ -80,6 +81,7 @@ KeyEventResponder* KeyEventResponder; NSTextInputContext* InputContext; id Monitor; + NSWindow* Window; ImGui_ImplOSX_Data() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } }; @@ -133,7 +135,7 @@ - (void)setImePosX:(float)posX imePosY:(float)posY - (void)updateImePosWithView:(NSView *)view { - NSWindow *window = view.window; + NSWindow* window = view.window; if (!window) return; NSRect contentRect = [window contentRectForFrameRect:window.frame]; @@ -402,6 +404,9 @@ bool ImGui_ImplOSX_Init(NSView* view) //io.BackendFlags |= ImGuiBackendFlags_HasSetMousePos; // We can honor io.WantSetMousePos requests (optional, rarely used) bd->Observer = [ImGuiObserver new]; + bd->Window = view.window ?: NSApp.orderedWindows.firstObject; + ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + main_viewport->PlatformHandle = main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = (__bridge_retained void*)bd->Window; // Load cursors. Some of them are undocumented. bd->MouseCursorHidden = false; @@ -460,7 +465,7 @@ bool ImGui_ImplOSX_Init(NSView* view) [view addSubview:bd->KeyEventResponder]; ImGui_ImplOSX_AddTrackingArea(view); - io.SetPlatformImeDataFn = [](ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) -> void + io.PlatformSetImeDataFn = [](ImGuiContext*, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) -> void { ImGui_ImplOSX_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplOSX_GetBackendData(); if (data->WantVisible) diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_sdl2.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_sdl2.cpp index 892fe9050fa1..15db0a843a8f 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_sdl2.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_sdl2.cpp @@ -21,6 +21,8 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-07-02: Emscripten: Added io.PlatformOpenInShellFn() handler for Emscripten versions. +// 2024-07-02: Update for io.SetPlatformImeDataFn() -> io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() renaming in main library. // 2024-02-14: Inputs: Handle gamepad disconnection. Added ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetGamepadMode(). // 2023-10-05: Inputs: Added support for extra ImGuiKey values: F13 to F24 function keys, app back/forward keys. // 2023-04-06: Inputs: Avoid calling SDL_StartTextInput()/SDL_StopTextInput() as they don't only pertain to IME. It's unclear exactly what their relation is to IME. (#6306) @@ -90,9 +92,12 @@ // SDL #include #include -#if defined(__APPLE__) +#ifdef __APPLE__ #include #endif +#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +#include +#endif #if SDL_VERSION_ATLEAST(2,0,4) && !defined(__EMSCRIPTEN__) && !defined(__ANDROID__) && !(defined(__APPLE__) && TARGET_OS_IOS) && !defined(__amigaos4__) #define SDL_HAS_CAPTURE_AND_GLOBAL_MOUSE 1 @@ -150,7 +155,7 @@ static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetClipboardText(void*, const char* text) } // Note: native IME will only display if user calls SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_IME_SHOW_UI, "1") _before_ SDL_CreateWindow(). -static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetPlatformImeData(ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) +static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_PlatformSetImeData(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) { if (data->WantVisible) { @@ -163,8 +168,9 @@ static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetPlatformImeData(ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeDa } } -static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL2_KeycodeToImGuiKey(int keycode) +static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL2_KeyEventToImGuiKey(SDL_Keycode keycode, SDL_Scancode scancode) { + IM_UNUSED(scancode); switch (keycode) { case SDLK_TAB: return ImGuiKey_Tab; @@ -286,6 +292,7 @@ static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL2_KeycodeToImGuiKey(int keycode) case SDLK_F24: return ImGuiKey_F24; case SDLK_AC_BACK: return ImGuiKey_AppBack; case SDLK_AC_FORWARD: return ImGuiKey_AppForward; + default: break; } return ImGuiKey_None; } @@ -361,7 +368,7 @@ bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_ProcessEvent(const SDL_Event* event) case SDL_KEYUP: { ImGui_ImplSDL2_UpdateKeyModifiers((SDL_Keymod)event->key.keysym.mod); - ImGuiKey key = ImGui_ImplSDL2_KeycodeToImGuiKey(event->key.keysym.sym); + ImGuiKey key = ImGui_ImplSDL2_KeyEventToImGuiKey(event->key.keysym.sym, event->key.keysym.scancode); io.AddKeyEvent(key, (event->type == SDL_KEYDOWN)); io.SetKeyEventNativeData(key, event->key.keysym.sym, event->key.keysym.scancode, event->key.keysym.scancode); // To support legacy indexing (<1.87 user code). Legacy backend uses SDLK_*** as indices to IsKeyXXX() functions. return true; @@ -397,7 +404,11 @@ bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_ProcessEvent(const SDL_Event* event) return false; } -static bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer) +#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ +EM_JS(void, ImGui_ImplSDL2_EmscriptenOpenURL, (char const* url), { url = url ? UTF8ToString(url) : null; if (url) window.open(url, '_blank'); }); +#endif + +static bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer, void* sdl_gl_context) { ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); IMGUI_CHECKVERSION(); @@ -428,7 +439,10 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer) io.SetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetClipboardText; io.GetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GetClipboardText; io.ClipboardUserData = nullptr; - io.SetPlatformImeDataFn = ImGui_ImplSDL2_SetPlatformImeData; + io.PlatformSetImeDataFn = ImGui_ImplSDL2_PlatformSetImeData; +#ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ + io.PlatformOpenInShellFn = [](ImGuiContext*, const char* url) { ImGui_ImplSDL2_EmscriptenOpenURL(url); return true; }; +#endif // Gamepad handling bd->GamepadMode = ImGui_ImplSDL2_GamepadMode_AutoFirst; @@ -448,6 +462,7 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer) // Set platform dependent data in viewport // Our mouse update function expect PlatformHandle to be filled for the main viewport ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + main_viewport->PlatformHandle = (void*)window; main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = nullptr; SDL_SysWMinfo info; SDL_VERSION(&info.version); @@ -481,13 +496,13 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer) SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_MOUSE_AUTO_CAPTURE, "0"); #endif + (void)sdl_gl_context; // Unused in 'master' branch. return true; } bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForOpenGL(SDL_Window* window, void* sdl_gl_context) { - IM_UNUSED(sdl_gl_context); // Viewport branch will need this. - return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr); + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr, sdl_gl_context); } bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForVulkan(SDL_Window* window) @@ -495,7 +510,7 @@ bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForVulkan(SDL_Window* window) #if !SDL_HAS_VULKAN IM_ASSERT(0 && "Unsupported"); #endif - return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr); + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr, nullptr); } bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForD3D(SDL_Window* window) @@ -503,22 +518,22 @@ bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForD3D(SDL_Window* window) #if !defined(_WIN32) IM_ASSERT(0 && "Unsupported"); #endif - return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr); + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr, nullptr); } bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForMetal(SDL_Window* window) { - return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr); + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr, nullptr); } bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForSDLRenderer(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer) { - return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, renderer); + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, renderer, nullptr); } bool ImGui_ImplSDL2_InitForOther(SDL_Window* window) { - return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr); + return ImGui_ImplSDL2_Init(window, nullptr, nullptr); } static void ImGui_ImplSDL2_CloseGamepads(); diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.cpp index 0838766113e1..05718d21cfb0 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.cpp @@ -1,7 +1,8 @@ // dear imgui: Platform Backend for SDL3 (*EXPERIMENTAL*) // This needs to be used along with a Renderer (e.g. DirectX11, OpenGL3, Vulkan..) // (Info: SDL3 is a cross-platform general purpose library for handling windows, inputs, graphics context creation, etc.) -// (IMPORTANT: SDL 3.0.0 is NOT YET RELEASED. IT IS POSSIBLE THAT ITS SPECS/API WILL CHANGE BEFORE RELEASE) + +// (**IMPORTANT: SDL 3.0.0 is NOT YET RELEASED AND CURRENTLY HAS A FAST CHANGING API. THIS CODE BREAKS OFTEN**) // Implemented features: // [X] Platform: Clipboard support. @@ -9,8 +10,6 @@ // [X] Platform: Keyboard support. Since 1.87 we are using the io.AddKeyEvent() function. Pass ImGuiKey values to all key functions e.g. ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Space). [Legacy SDL_SCANCODE_* values will also be supported unless IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_KEYIO is set] // [X] Platform: Gamepad support. Enabled with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad'. // [X] Platform: Mouse cursor shape and visibility. Disable with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange'. -// Missing features: -// [ ] Platform: IME SUPPORT IS BROKEN IN SDL3 BECAUSE INPUTS GETS SENT TO BOTH APP AND IME + app needs to call 'SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_IME_SHOW_UI, "1");' before SDL_CreateWindow()!. // You can use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See examples/ folder for examples of using this. // Prefer including the entire imgui/ repository into your project (either as a copy or as a submodule), and only build the backends you need. @@ -22,6 +21,15 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-07-22: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_GetGamepads() memory ownership change. (#7807) +// 2024-07-18: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_GetClipboardText() memory ownership change. (#7801) +// 2024-07-15: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_GetProperty() change to SDL_GetPointerProperty(). (#7794) +// 2024-07-02: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDLK_x renames and SDLK_KP_x removals (#7761, #7762). +// 2024-07-01: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_SetTextInputRect() changed to SDL_SetTextInputArea(). +// 2024-06-26: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_StartTextInput()/SDL_StopTextInput()/SDL_SetTextInputRect() functions signatures. +// 2024-06-24: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_EVENT_KEY_DOWN/SDL_EVENT_KEY_UP contents. +// 2024-06-03; Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_ renames. +// 2024-05-15: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDLK_ renames. // 2024-04-15: Inputs: Re-enable calling SDL_StartTextInput()/SDL_StopTextInput() as SDL3 no longer enables it by default and should play nicer with IME. // 2024-02-13: Inputs: Fixed gamepad support. Handle gamepad disconnection. Added ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetGamepadMode(). // 2023-11-13: Updated for recent SDL3 API changes. @@ -76,6 +84,9 @@ struct ImGui_ImplSDL3_Data Uint64 Time; char* ClipboardTextData; + // IME handling + SDL_Window* ImeWindow; + // Mouse handling Uint32 MouseWindowID; int MouseButtonsDown; @@ -107,7 +118,8 @@ static const char* ImGui_ImplSDL3_GetClipboardText(void*) ImGui_ImplSDL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL3_GetBackendData(); if (bd->ClipboardTextData) SDL_free(bd->ClipboardTextData); - bd->ClipboardTextData = SDL_GetClipboardText(); + const char* sdl_clipboard_text = SDL_GetClipboardText(); + bd->ClipboardTextData = sdl_clipboard_text ? SDL_strdup(sdl_clipboard_text) : NULL; return bd->ClipboardTextData; } @@ -116,8 +128,15 @@ static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetClipboardText(void*, const char* text) SDL_SetClipboardText(text); } -static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetPlatformImeData(ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) +static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_PlatformSetImeData(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) { + ImGui_ImplSDL3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDL3_GetBackendData(); + SDL_Window* window = (SDL_Window*)viewport->PlatformHandle; + if ((data->WantVisible == false || bd->ImeWindow != window) && bd->ImeWindow != NULL) + { + SDL_StopTextInput(bd->ImeWindow); + bd->ImeWindow = nullptr; + } if (data->WantVisible) { SDL_Rect r; @@ -125,17 +144,36 @@ static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetPlatformImeData(ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeDa r.y = (int)data->InputPos.y; r.w = 1; r.h = (int)data->InputLineHeight; - SDL_SetTextInputRect(&r); - SDL_StartTextInput(); - } - else - { - SDL_StopTextInput(); + SDL_SetTextInputArea(window, &r, 0); + SDL_StartTextInput(window); + bd->ImeWindow = window; } } -static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeycodeToImGuiKey(int keycode) +static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeyEventToImGuiKey(SDL_Keycode keycode, SDL_Scancode scancode) { + // Keypad doesn't have individual key values in SDL3 + switch (scancode) + { + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_0: return ImGuiKey_Keypad0; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_1: return ImGuiKey_Keypad1; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_2: return ImGuiKey_Keypad2; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_3: return ImGuiKey_Keypad3; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_4: return ImGuiKey_Keypad4; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_5: return ImGuiKey_Keypad5; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_6: return ImGuiKey_Keypad6; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_7: return ImGuiKey_Keypad7; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_8: return ImGuiKey_Keypad8; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_9: return ImGuiKey_Keypad9; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_PERIOD: return ImGuiKey_KeypadDecimal; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_DIVIDE: return ImGuiKey_KeypadDivide; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_MULTIPLY: return ImGuiKey_KeypadMultiply; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_MINUS: return ImGuiKey_KeypadSubtract; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_PLUS: return ImGuiKey_KeypadAdd; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_ENTER: return ImGuiKey_KeypadEnter; + case SDL_SCANCODE_KP_EQUALS: return ImGuiKey_KeypadEqual; + default: break; + } switch (keycode) { case SDLK_TAB: return ImGuiKey_Tab; @@ -169,23 +207,6 @@ static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeycodeToImGuiKey(int keycode) case SDLK_NUMLOCKCLEAR: return ImGuiKey_NumLock; case SDLK_PRINTSCREEN: return ImGuiKey_PrintScreen; case SDLK_PAUSE: return ImGuiKey_Pause; - case SDLK_KP_0: return ImGuiKey_Keypad0; - case SDLK_KP_1: return ImGuiKey_Keypad1; - case SDLK_KP_2: return ImGuiKey_Keypad2; - case SDLK_KP_3: return ImGuiKey_Keypad3; - case SDLK_KP_4: return ImGuiKey_Keypad4; - case SDLK_KP_5: return ImGuiKey_Keypad5; - case SDLK_KP_6: return ImGuiKey_Keypad6; - case SDLK_KP_7: return ImGuiKey_Keypad7; - case SDLK_KP_8: return ImGuiKey_Keypad8; - case SDLK_KP_9: return ImGuiKey_Keypad9; - case SDLK_KP_PERIOD: return ImGuiKey_KeypadDecimal; - case SDLK_KP_DIVIDE: return ImGuiKey_KeypadDivide; - case SDLK_KP_MULTIPLY: return ImGuiKey_KeypadMultiply; - case SDLK_KP_MINUS: return ImGuiKey_KeypadSubtract; - case SDLK_KP_PLUS: return ImGuiKey_KeypadAdd; - case SDLK_KP_ENTER: return ImGuiKey_KeypadEnter; - case SDLK_KP_EQUALS: return ImGuiKey_KeypadEqual; case SDLK_LCTRL: return ImGuiKey_LeftCtrl; case SDLK_LSHIFT: return ImGuiKey_LeftShift; case SDLK_LALT: return ImGuiKey_LeftAlt; @@ -205,32 +226,32 @@ static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeycodeToImGuiKey(int keycode) case SDLK_7: return ImGuiKey_7; case SDLK_8: return ImGuiKey_8; case SDLK_9: return ImGuiKey_9; - case SDLK_a: return ImGuiKey_A; - case SDLK_b: return ImGuiKey_B; - case SDLK_c: return ImGuiKey_C; - case SDLK_d: return ImGuiKey_D; - case SDLK_e: return ImGuiKey_E; - case SDLK_f: return ImGuiKey_F; - case SDLK_g: return ImGuiKey_G; - case SDLK_h: return ImGuiKey_H; - case SDLK_i: return ImGuiKey_I; - case SDLK_j: return ImGuiKey_J; - case SDLK_k: return ImGuiKey_K; - case SDLK_l: return ImGuiKey_L; - case SDLK_m: return ImGuiKey_M; - case SDLK_n: return ImGuiKey_N; - case SDLK_o: return ImGuiKey_O; - case SDLK_p: return ImGuiKey_P; - case SDLK_q: return ImGuiKey_Q; - case SDLK_r: return ImGuiKey_R; - case SDLK_s: return ImGuiKey_S; - case SDLK_t: return ImGuiKey_T; - case SDLK_u: return ImGuiKey_U; - case SDLK_v: return ImGuiKey_V; - case SDLK_w: return ImGuiKey_W; - case SDLK_x: return ImGuiKey_X; - case SDLK_y: return ImGuiKey_Y; - case SDLK_z: return ImGuiKey_Z; + case SDLK_A: return ImGuiKey_A; + case SDLK_B: return ImGuiKey_B; + case SDLK_C: return ImGuiKey_C; + case SDLK_D: return ImGuiKey_D; + case SDLK_E: return ImGuiKey_E; + case SDLK_F: return ImGuiKey_F; + case SDLK_G: return ImGuiKey_G; + case SDLK_H: return ImGuiKey_H; + case SDLK_I: return ImGuiKey_I; + case SDLK_J: return ImGuiKey_J; + case SDLK_K: return ImGuiKey_K; + case SDLK_L: return ImGuiKey_L; + case SDLK_M: return ImGuiKey_M; + case SDLK_N: return ImGuiKey_N; + case SDLK_O: return ImGuiKey_O; + case SDLK_P: return ImGuiKey_P; + case SDLK_Q: return ImGuiKey_Q; + case SDLK_R: return ImGuiKey_R; + case SDLK_S: return ImGuiKey_S; + case SDLK_T: return ImGuiKey_T; + case SDLK_U: return ImGuiKey_U; + case SDLK_V: return ImGuiKey_V; + case SDLK_W: return ImGuiKey_W; + case SDLK_X: return ImGuiKey_X; + case SDLK_Y: return ImGuiKey_Y; + case SDLK_Z: return ImGuiKey_Z; case SDLK_F1: return ImGuiKey_F1; case SDLK_F2: return ImGuiKey_F2; case SDLK_F3: return ImGuiKey_F3; @@ -257,6 +278,7 @@ static ImGuiKey ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeycodeToImGuiKey(int keycode) case SDLK_F24: return ImGuiKey_F24; case SDLK_AC_BACK: return ImGuiKey_AppBack; case SDLK_AC_FORWARD: return ImGuiKey_AppForward; + default: break; } return ImGuiKey_None; } @@ -326,10 +348,11 @@ bool ImGui_ImplSDL3_ProcessEvent(const SDL_Event* event) case SDL_EVENT_KEY_DOWN: case SDL_EVENT_KEY_UP: { - ImGui_ImplSDL3_UpdateKeyModifiers((SDL_Keymod)event->key.keysym.mod); - ImGuiKey key = ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeycodeToImGuiKey(event->key.keysym.sym); + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("SDL_EVENT_KEY_%d: key=%d, scancode=%d, mod=%X\n", (event->type == SDL_EVENT_KEY_DOWN) ? "DOWN" : "UP", event->key.key, event->key.scancode, event->key.mod); + ImGui_ImplSDL3_UpdateKeyModifiers((SDL_Keymod)event->key.mod); + ImGuiKey key = ImGui_ImplSDL3_KeyEventToImGuiKey(event->key.key, event->key.scancode); io.AddKeyEvent(key, (event->type == SDL_EVENT_KEY_DOWN)); - io.SetKeyEventNativeData(key, event->key.keysym.sym, event->key.keysym.scancode, event->key.keysym.scancode); // To support legacy indexing (<1.87 user code). Legacy backend uses SDLK_*** as indices to IsKeyXXX() functions. + io.SetKeyEventNativeData(key, event->key.key, event->key.scancode, event->key.scancode); // To support legacy indexing (<1.87 user code). Legacy backend uses SDLK_*** as indices to IsKeyXXX() functions. return true; } case SDL_EVENT_WINDOW_MOUSE_ENTER: @@ -365,12 +388,12 @@ bool ImGui_ImplSDL3_ProcessEvent(const SDL_Event* event) static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetupPlatformHandles(ImGuiViewport* viewport, SDL_Window* window) { - IM_UNUSED(window); + viewport->PlatformHandle = window; viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = nullptr; -#if defined(__WIN32__) && !defined(__WINRT__) - viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = (HWND)SDL_GetProperty(SDL_GetWindowProperties(window), "SDL.window.win32.hwnd", nullptr); +#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(__WINRT__) + viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = (HWND)SDL_GetPointerProperty(SDL_GetWindowProperties(window), SDL_PROP_WINDOW_WIN32_HWND_POINTER, nullptr); #elif defined(__APPLE__) && defined(SDL_VIDEO_DRIVER_COCOA) - viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = (void*)SDL_GetProperty(SDL_GetWindowProperties(window), "SDL.window.cocoa.window", nullptr); + viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = SDL_GetPointerProperty(SDL_GetWindowProperties(window), SDL_PROP_WINDOW_COCOA_WINDOW_POINTER, nullptr); #endif } @@ -406,22 +429,22 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplSDL3_Init(SDL_Window* window, SDL_Renderer* renderer, void io.SetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetClipboardText; io.GetClipboardTextFn = ImGui_ImplSDL3_GetClipboardText; io.ClipboardUserData = nullptr; - io.SetPlatformImeDataFn = ImGui_ImplSDL3_SetPlatformImeData; + io.PlatformSetImeDataFn = ImGui_ImplSDL3_PlatformSetImeData; // Gamepad handling bd->GamepadMode = ImGui_ImplSDL3_GamepadMode_AutoFirst; bd->WantUpdateGamepadsList = true; // Load mouse cursors - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_ARROW); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_IBEAM); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeAll] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZEALL); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZENS); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZEWE); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZENESW); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_SIZENWSE); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_HAND); - bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_NotAllowed] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_NO); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_DEFAULT); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_TEXT); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeAll] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_MOVE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_NS_RESIZE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_EW_RESIZE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_NESW_RESIZE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_NWSE_RESIZE); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_Hand] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_POINTER); + bd->MouseCursors[ImGuiMouseCursor_NotAllowed] = SDL_CreateSystemCursor(SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_NOT_ALLOWED); // Set platform dependent data in viewport // Our mouse update function expect PlatformHandle to be filled for the main viewport @@ -617,7 +640,7 @@ static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_UpdateGamepads() { ImGui_ImplSDL3_CloseGamepads(); int sdl_gamepads_count = 0; - SDL_JoystickID* sdl_gamepads = SDL_GetGamepads(&sdl_gamepads_count); + const SDL_JoystickID* sdl_gamepads = SDL_GetGamepads(&sdl_gamepads_count); for (int n = 0; n < sdl_gamepads_count; n++) if (SDL_Gamepad* gamepad = SDL_OpenGamepad(sdl_gamepads[n])) { @@ -625,7 +648,6 @@ static void ImGui_ImplSDL3_UpdateGamepads() if (bd->GamepadMode == ImGui_ImplSDL3_GamepadMode_AutoFirst) break; } - SDL_free(sdl_gamepads); bd->WantUpdateGamepadsList = false; } diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.h b/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.h index eafb3474943f..f1c06db5d1ca 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.h +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_sdl3.h @@ -1,7 +1,8 @@ // dear imgui: Platform Backend for SDL3 (*EXPERIMENTAL*) // This needs to be used along with a Renderer (e.g. DirectX11, OpenGL3, Vulkan..) // (Info: SDL3 is a cross-platform general purpose library for handling windows, inputs, graphics context creation, etc.) -// (IMPORTANT: SDL 3.0.0 is NOT YET RELEASED. IT IS POSSIBLE THAT ITS SPECS/API WILL CHANGE BEFORE RELEASE) + +// (**IMPORTANT: SDL 3.0.0 is NOT YET RELEASED AND CURRENTLY HAS A FAST CHANGING API. THIS CODE BREAKS OFTEN**) // Implemented features: // [X] Platform: Clipboard support. @@ -9,8 +10,6 @@ // [X] Platform: Keyboard support. Since 1.87 we are using the io.AddKeyEvent() function. Pass ImGuiKey values to all key functions e.g. ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Space). [Legacy SDL_SCANCODE_* values will also be supported unless IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_KEYIO is set] // [X] Platform: Gamepad support. Enabled with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad'. // [X] Platform: Mouse cursor shape and visibility. Disable with 'io.ConfigFlags |= ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange'. -// Missing features: -// [ ] Platform: IME SUPPORT IS BROKEN IN SDL3 BECAUSE INPUTS GETS SENT TO BOTH APP AND IME + app needs to call 'SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_IME_SHOW_UI, "1");' before SDL_CreateWindow()!. // You can use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See examples/ folder for examples of using this. // Prefer including the entire imgui/ repository into your project (either as a copy or as a submodule), and only build the backends you need. diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_sdlrenderer3.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_sdlrenderer3.cpp index ae75b7c8baf5..8ba262548d69 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_sdlrenderer3.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_sdlrenderer3.cpp @@ -20,6 +20,7 @@ // - Introduction, links and more at the top of imgui.cpp // CHANGELOG +// 2024-07-01: Update for SDL3 api changes: SDL_RenderGeometryRaw() uint32 version was removed (SDL#9009). // 2024-05-14: *BREAKING CHANGE* ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_RenderDrawData() requires SDL_Renderer* passed as parameter. // 2024-02-12: Amend to query SDL_RenderViewportSet() and restore viewport accordingly. // 2023-05-30: Initial version. @@ -44,8 +45,10 @@ // SDL_Renderer data struct ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_Data { - SDL_Renderer* Renderer; // Main viewport's renderer - SDL_Texture* FontTexture; + SDL_Renderer* Renderer; // Main viewport's renderer + SDL_Texture* FontTexture; + ImVector ColorBuffer; + ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_Data() { memset((void*)this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } }; @@ -106,8 +109,28 @@ void ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_NewFrame() ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_CreateDeviceObjects(); } +// https://github.com/libsdl-org/SDL/issues/9009 +static int SDL_RenderGeometryRaw8BitColor(SDL_Renderer* renderer, ImVector& colors_out, SDL_Texture* texture, const float* xy, int xy_stride, const SDL_Color* color, int color_stride, const float* uv, int uv_stride, int num_vertices, const void* indices, int num_indices, int size_indices) +{ + const Uint8* color2 = (const Uint8*)color; + colors_out.resize(num_vertices); + SDL_FColor* color3 = colors_out.Data; + for (int i = 0; i < num_vertices; i++) + { + color3[i].r = color->r / 255.0f; + color3[i].g = color->g / 255.0f; + color3[i].b = color->b / 255.0f; + color3[i].a = color->a / 255.0f; + color2 += color_stride; + color = (const SDL_Color*)color2; + } + return SDL_RenderGeometryRaw(renderer, texture, xy, xy_stride, color3, sizeof(*color3), uv, uv_stride, num_vertices, indices, num_indices, size_indices); +} + void ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_RenderDrawData(ImDrawData* draw_data, SDL_Renderer* renderer) { + ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_Data* bd = ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_GetBackendData(); + // If there's a scale factor set by the user, use that instead // If the user has specified a scale factor to SDL_Renderer already via SDL_RenderSetScale(), SDL will scale whatever we pass // to SDL_RenderGeometryRaw() by that scale factor. In that case we don't want to be also scaling it ourselves here. @@ -183,7 +206,7 @@ void ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_RenderDrawData(ImDrawData* draw_data, SDL_Renderer* // Bind texture, Draw SDL_Texture* tex = (SDL_Texture*)pcmd->GetTexID(); - SDL_RenderGeometryRaw(renderer, tex, + SDL_RenderGeometryRaw8BitColor(renderer, bd->ColorBuffer, tex, xy, (int)sizeof(ImDrawVert), color, (int)sizeof(ImDrawVert), uv, (int)sizeof(ImDrawVert), diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_vulkan.h b/backends/imgui_impl_vulkan.h index c174a6ca1430..fb98bfbc4d6b 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_vulkan.h +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_vulkan.h @@ -55,7 +55,7 @@ // Vulkan includes #ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_VULKAN_USE_VOLK -#include +#include #else #include #endif diff --git a/backends/imgui_impl_win32.cpp b/backends/imgui_impl_win32.cpp index 3e59b62e36b4..0e48d86362fb 100644 --- a/backends/imgui_impl_win32.cpp +++ b/backends/imgui_impl_win32.cpp @@ -21,6 +21,7 @@ // CHANGELOG // (minor and older changes stripped away, please see git history for details) +// 2024-07-08: Inputs: Fixed ImGuiMod_Super being mapped to VK_APPS instead of VK_LWIN||VK_RWIN. (#7768) // 2023-10-05: Inputs: Added support for extra ImGuiKey values: F13 to F24 function keys, app back/forward keys. // 2023-09-25: Inputs: Synthesize key-down event on key-up for VK_SNAPSHOT / ImGuiKey_PrintScreen as Windows doesn't emit it (same behavior as GLFW/SDL). // 2023-09-07: Inputs: Added support for keyboard codepage conversion for when application is compiled in MBCS mode and using a non-Unicode window. @@ -98,6 +99,7 @@ typedef DWORD(WINAPI* PFN_XInputGetState)(DWORD, XINPUT_STATE*); #endif #if defined(__GNUC__) #pragma GCC diagnostic push +#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragmas" // warning: unknown option after '#pragma GCC diagnostic' kind #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-function-type" // warning: cast between incompatible function types (for loader) #endif @@ -169,7 +171,8 @@ static bool ImGui_ImplWin32_InitEx(void* hwnd, bool platform_has_own_dc) ImGui_ImplWin32_UpdateKeyboardCodePage(); // Set platform dependent data in viewport - ImGui::GetMainViewport()->PlatformHandleRaw = (void*)hwnd; + ImGuiViewport* main_viewport = ImGui::GetMainViewport(); + main_viewport->PlatformHandle = main_viewport->PlatformHandleRaw = (void*)bd->hWnd; IM_UNUSED(platform_has_own_dc); // Used in 'docking' branch // Dynamically load XInput library @@ -292,7 +295,7 @@ static void ImGui_ImplWin32_UpdateKeyModifiers() io.AddKeyEvent(ImGuiMod_Ctrl, IsVkDown(VK_CONTROL)); io.AddKeyEvent(ImGuiMod_Shift, IsVkDown(VK_SHIFT)); io.AddKeyEvent(ImGuiMod_Alt, IsVkDown(VK_MENU)); - io.AddKeyEvent(ImGuiMod_Super, IsVkDown(VK_APPS)); + io.AddKeyEvent(ImGuiMod_Super, IsVkDown(VK_LWIN) || IsVkDown(VK_RWIN)); } static void ImGui_ImplWin32_UpdateMouseData() diff --git a/docs/CHANGELOG.txt b/docs/CHANGELOG.txt index 154ae8ff8c09..fde5c5144e90 100644 --- a/docs/CHANGELOG.txt +++ b/docs/CHANGELOG.txt @@ -36,20 +36,260 @@ HOW TO UPDATE? - Please report any issue! ----------------------------------------------------------------------- - VERSION 1.90.8 WIP (In Progress) + VERSION 1.91.0 WIP (In Progress) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- Breaking changes: +- IO, IME: renamed platform IME hook and added explicit context for consistency and future-proofness. + - old: io.SetPlatformImeDataFn(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); + - new: io.PlatformSetImeDataFn(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); + It is expected that for a vast majority of users this is automatically set by core + library and/or platform backend so it won't have any effect. +- Item flag changes: + - Obsoleted PushButtonRepeat()/PopButtonRepeat() in favor of using new PushItemFlag()/PopItemFlag() + with ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat. Kept inline redirecting functions (will obsolete). + - Obsoleted PushTabStop()/PopTabStop() in favor of using new PushItemFlag()/PopItemFlag() + with ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop. Kept inline redirecting functions (will obsolete). + - Renamed ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups to ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoAutoClosePopups for + consistency. Kept inline redirecting functions (will obsolete). + + Internals: changed/inverted ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup (default==false) to + ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups (default==true), same logic, only inverted behavior. + (#1379, #1468, #2200, #4936, #5216, #7302, #7573) +- Commented out obsolete ImGuiModFlags (renamed to ImGuiKeyChord in 1.89). (#4921, #456) +- Commented out obsolete ImGuiModFlags_XXX values (renamed to ImGuiMod_XXX in 1.89). (#4921, #456) + - ImGuiModFlags_Ctrl -> ImGuiMod_Ctrl, ImGuiModFlags_Shift -> ImGuiMod_Shift etc. +- Backends: GLFW+Emscripten: Renamed ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback() to + ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(), with additional GLFWWindow* parameter. (#7647) [@ypujante] + +Other changes: + +- Added TextLink(), TextLinkOpenURL() hyperlink widgets. (#7660) +- IO: added io.PlatformOpenInShellFn handler to open a link/folder/file in OS shell. (#7660) + Default to use ShellExecute() under Windows, and system("") under Mac/Linux/etc. + Added IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS to disable default implementation. +- Added PushItemFlag()/PopItemFlags(), ImGuiItemFlags to modify shared item flags: + - Added ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop to disable tabbing through items. + - Added ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav to disable any navigation and focus of items. (#787) + - Added ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus to disable item being default focus. (#787) + - Added ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat to enable repeat on any button-like behavior. + - Added ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups to disable menu items/selection auto closing parent popups. + Disabling this was previously possible for Selectable() via a direct flag but not for MenuItem(). + (#1379, #1468, #2200, #4936, #5216, #7302, #7573) + - This was mostly all previously in imgui_internal.h. +- Inputs: added SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key) in public API. This is a simplified version of a more + complete set of function available in imgui_internal.h. One common use-case for this is to allow + your items to disable standard inputs behaviors such as Tab or Alt handling, Mouse Wheel scrolling, + etc. (#456, #2637, #2620, #2891, #3370, #3724, #4828, #5108, #5242, #5641) + // Hovering or activating the button will disable mouse wheel default behavior to scroll + InvisibleButton(...); + SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey_MouseWheelY); +- Multi-Select: added multi-select API and demos. (#1861, #6518) + - This system implements standard multi-selection idioms (CTRL+mouse click, CTRL+keyboard moves, + SHIFT+mouse click, SHIFT+keyboard moves, etc.) with support for clipper (not submitting non-visible + items), box-selection with scrolling, and many other details. + - In the spirit of Dear ImGui design, your code owns both items and actual selection data. + This is designed to allow all kinds of selection storage you may use in your application + (e.g. set/map/hash, intrusive selection, interval trees, up to you). + - The supported widgets are Selectable(), Checkbox(). TreeNode() is also technically supported but... + using this correctly is more complicated (you need some sort of linear/random access to your tree, + which is suited to advanced trees setups already implementing filters and clipper. + We will work toward simplifying and demoing this later. + - A helper ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage is provided to facilitate getting started in a typical app. + - Documentation: + - Wiki page https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Multi-Select for API overview. + - Demo code + headers are well commented. + - Added BeginMultiSelect(), EndMultiSelect(), SetNextItemSelectionUserData(). + - Added IsItemToggledSelection() for use if you need latest selection update during currnet iteration. + - Added ImGuiMultiSelectIO and ImGuiSelectionRequest structures: + - BeginMultiSelect() and EndMultiSelect() return a ImGuiMultiSelectIO structure, which + is mostly an array of ImGuiSelectionRequest actions (clear, select all, set range, etc.) + - Other fields are helpful when using a clipper, or wanting to handle deletion nicely. + - Added ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage helper to store and maintain a selection (optional): + - This is similar to if you used e.g. a std::set to store a selection, with all the right + glue to honor ImGuiMultiSelectIO requests. Most applications can use that. + - Added ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage helper to maintain an externally stored selection (optional): + - Helpful to easily bind multi-selection to e.g. an array of checkboxes. + - Added ImGuiMultiSelectFlags options: + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoSelectAll + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClearOnReselect (#7424) + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelectNoScroll + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow (default), ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClick (default), ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease + - ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NavWrapX + - Demo: Added "Examples->Assets Browser" demo. + - Demo: Added "Widgets->Selection State & Multi-Select" section, with: + - Multi-Select + - Multi-Select (with clipper) + - Multi-Select (with deletion) + - Multi-Select (dual list box) (#6648) + - Multi-Select (checkboxes) + - Multi-Select (multiple scopes) + - Multi-Select (advanced) +- Nav: fixed clicking window decorations (e.g. resize borders) from losing focused item when + within a child window using ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened. +- Clipper: added SeekCursorForItem() function. When using ImGuiListClipper::Begin(INT_MAX) you can + can use the clipper without knowing the amount of items beforehand. (#1311) + In this situation, call ImGuiListClipper::SeekCursorForItem(items_count) as the end of your iteration + loop to position the layout cursor correctly. This is done automatically if provided a count to Begin(). +- Groups, Tables: fixed EndGroup() failing to correctly capture current table occupied size. (#7543) +- TabBar, Style: added style.TabBarOverlineSize / ImGuiStyleVar_TabBarOverlineSize to manipulate + thickness of the horizontal line over selectable tabs. [@DctrNoob] +- Style: close button and collapse/window-menu button hover highlight made rectangular instead of round. +- Debug Tools: Added IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG(), ImGui::DebugLog() in public API. (#5855) + Debug log entries add a imgui frame counter prefix + are redirected to ShowDebugLogWindow() and + other configurable locations. Always call IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG() for maximum stripping in caller code. +- Debug Tools: Debug Log: Added "Configure Outputs.." button. (#5855) +- Debug Tools: Debug Log: Fixed incorrect checkbox layout when partially clipped. +- Demo: Reworked "Property Editor" demo in a manner that more ressemble the tree data and + struct description data that a real application would want to use. +- Backends: Win32: Fixed ImGuiMod_Super being mapped to VK_APPS instead of VK_LWIN||VK_RWIN. + (#7768, #4858, #2622) [@Aemony] +- Backends: SDL3: Update for API changes: SDL_GetGamepads() memory ownership change. (#7807) +- Backends: SDL3: Update for API changes: SDL_GetClipboardText() memory ownership change. (#7801) +- Backends: SDL3: Update for API changes: SDLK_x renames and SDLK_KP_x removals (#7761, #7762) +- Backends: SDL3: Update for API changes: SDL_GetProperty() change to SDL_GetPointerProperty(). (#7794) [@wermipls] +- Backends: SDL2,SDL3,OSX: Update for io.SetPlatformImeDataFn() -> io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() rename. +- Backends: GLFW,SDL2: Added io.PlatformOpenInShellFn handler for web/Emscripten versions. (#7660) + [@ypujante, @ocornut] +- Backends; GLFW+Emscripten: Added support for GLFW3 contrib port which fixes many of the things + not supported by the embedded GLFW: gamepad support, mouse cursor shapes, copy to clipboard, + workaround for Super/Meta key, different ways of resizing, multi-window (glfw/canvas) support. + (#7647) [@ypujante] +- Backends: GLFW+Emscripten: Fixed Emscripten warning when using mouse wheel on some setups + "Unable to preventDefault inside passive event listener". (#7647, #7600) [@ypujante] + + +----------------------------------------------------------------------- + VERSION 1.90.9 (Released 2024-07-01) +----------------------------------------------------------------------- + +Decorated log and release notes: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases/tag/v1.90.9 + +Breaking changes: + +- Removed old nested structure: renaming ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair type to + ImGuiStoragePair (simpler for many languages). No significant nested type left. +- BeginChild: added ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened as a replacement for the window + flag ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened: the feature only ever made sense for + BeginChild() calls anyhow. (#7687) [@cfillion] + - old: BeginChild("Name", size, 0, ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened); + - new: BeginChild("Name", size, ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened, 0) + Kept inline redirection flag (will obsolete). +- Style: renamed tab colors for clarity and consistency with other changes: (#261, #351) + - ImGuiCol_TabActive -> ImGuiCol_TabSelected + - ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused -> ImGuiCol_TabDimmed + - ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive -> ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected + Kept inline redirecting enums (will obsolete). +- IO: io.ClearInputKeys() (first exposed in 1.89.8) doesn't clear mouse data. + Newly added io.ClearInputMouse() does. (#4921) +- Drag and Drop: renamed ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload to + ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadAutoExpire. Kept inline redirecting enum (will obsolete). (#1725, #143) + +Other changes: + +- IO: do not disable io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges (which allow resizing from borders + and lower-left corner) when ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors is not set by backend. + The initial reasoning is that resizing from borders feels better when correct mouse cursor + shape change as honored by backends. Keeping this enabling will hopefully increase pressure + on third-party backends to set ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors and honor changes of + ImGui::GetMouseCursor() value. (#1495) +- IO: do not claim io.WantCaptureMouse=true on the mouse release frame of a button + which was pressed over void/underlying app, which is consistent/needed to allow the + mouse up event of a drag over void/underlying app to catch release. (#1392) [@Moka42] +- IO: Added io.ClearInputMouse() to clear mouse state. (#4921) +- Windows: BeginChild(): fixed a glitch when during a resize of a child window which is + tightly close to the boundaries of its parent (e.g. with zero WindowPadding), the child + position could have temporarily be moved around by erroneous padding application. (#7706) +- TabBar, Style: added ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline option to draw an horizontal + line over selected tabs to increase visibility. This is used by docking. + Added corresponding ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline and ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline colors. +- Tables: added TableGetHoveredColumn() to public API, as an alternative to testing for + 'TableGetColumnFlags(column) & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered' on each column. (#3740) +- Disabled, Inputs: fixed using Shortcut() or SetNextItemShortcut() within a disabled block + bypassing the disabled state. (#7726) +- Disabled: Reworked 1.90.8 behavior of Begin() not inheriting current BeginDisabled() state, + to make it that only tooltip windows are temporarily clearing it. (#211, #7640) +- Drags: added ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround flag for DragInt(), DragFloat() etc. (#7749) +- Drag and Drop: BeginDragDropSource() with ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern sets + active id so a multi-frame extern source doesn't interfere with hovered widgets. (#143) +- Drag and Drop: BeginDragDropSource() with ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern does not assume + a mouse button being pressed. Facilitate implementing cross-context drag and drop. (#143) +- Drag and Drop: Added ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadNoCrossContext/_PayloadNoCrossProcess flags + as metadata to specify that a payload may not be copied outside the context/process by + some logic aiming to copy payloads around. +- Drag and Drop: Fixes an issue when elapsing payload would be based on last payload + frame instead of last drag source frame, which makes a difference if not resubmitting + payload every frame. (#143) +- Debug Tools: Metrics/Debugger: Browsing a Storage perform hover lookup on identifier. +- Viewports: Backported 'void* ImGuiViewport::PlatformHandle' from docking branch for + use by backends. +- imgui_freetype: Fixed divide by zero while handling FT_PIXEL_MODE_BGRA glyphs. (#7267, #3369) +- Backends: OpenGL2, OpenGL3: ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_NewFrame() recreates font texture if it + has been destroyed by ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_DestroyFontsTexture(). (#7748) [@mlauss2] +- Backends: SDL3: Update for API removal of keysym field in SDL_KeyboardEvent. (#7728) +- Backends: SDL3: Update for SDL_StartTextInput()/SDL_StopTextInput() API changes. (#7735) +- Backends: SDL3: Update for SDL_SetTextInputRect() API rename. (#7760, #7754) [@maxortner01] +- Backends: SDLRenderer3: Update for SDL_RenderGeometryRaw() API changes. (SDL#9009). +- Backends: Vulkan: Remove Volk/ from volk.h #include directives. (#7722, #6582, #4854) + [@martin-ejdestig] +- Examples: SDL3: Remove use of SDL_HINT_IME_NATIVE_UI since new SDL_HINT_IME_IMPLEMENTED_UI + values has a more suitable default for our case case. +- Examples: GLFW+Vulkan, SDL+Vulkan: handle swap chain resize even without Vulkan + returning VK_SUBOPTIMAL_KHR, which doesn't seem to happen on Wayland. (#7671) + [@AndreiNego, @ocornut] + + +----------------------------------------------------------------------- + VERSION 1.90.8 (Released 2024-06-06) +----------------------------------------------------------------------- + +Decorated log and release notes: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases/tag/v1.90.8 + +Breaking changes: + +- Reordered various ImGuiInputTextFlags values. This should NOT be breaking unless + you are using generated headers that have values not matching the main library. +- Removed ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft + from imgui.h, was mostly unused and misleading. + Other changes: +- Inputs: fixed IsMouseClicked(..., repeat=true); broken in 1.90.7 on 2024/05/22. + (due to an internal api parameter swap, repeat wouldn't be honored and + ownership would be accidentally checked even though this api is meant to not + check ownership). (#7657) [@korenkonder] - Windows: fixed altering FramePadding mid-frame not correctly affecting logic responsible for honoring io.ConfigWindowsMoveFromTitleBarOnly. (#7576, #899) - Scrollbar: made scrolling logic more standard: clicking above or below the grab scrolls by one page, holding mouse button repeats scrolling. (#7328, #150) +- Scrollbar: fixed miscalculation of vertical scrollbar visibility when required + solely by the presence of an horizontal scrollbar. (#1574) +- InputScalar, InputInt, InputFloat: added ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal + to parse an empty field as zero-value. (#7305) [@supermerill, @ocornut] +- InputScalar, InputInt, InputFloat: added ImGuiInputTextFlags_DisplayEmptyRefVal + to display a zero-value as empty. (#7305) [@supermerill, @ocornut] +- Popups: fixed an issue preventing to close a popup opened over a modal by clicking + over void (it required clicking over the visible part of the modal). (#7654) +- Tables: fixed an issue where ideal size reported to parent container wouldn't + correctly take account of inner scrollbar, affecting potential auto-resize of + parent container. (#7651) +- Tables: fixed a bug where after disabling the ScrollY flag for a table, + previous scrollbar width would be accounted for. (#5920) - Combo: simplified Combo() API uses a list clipper (due to its api it wasn't previously trivial before we added clipper.IncludeItemByIndex() function). +- Disabled: nested tooltips or other non-child window within a BeginDisabled() + block disable the disabled state. (#211, #7640) - Misc: made ImGuiDir and ImGuiSortDirection stronger-typed enums. +- Backends: SDL3: Update for SDL_SYSTEM_CURSOR_xxx api renames. (#7653) ----------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -773,7 +1013,7 @@ Breaking changes: - IO: Obsoleted io.ClearInputCharacters() (added in 1.47) as it now ambiguous and often incorrect/misleading considering the existence of a higher-level - input queue. This is automatically cleared by io.ClearInputsKeys(). (#4921) + input queue. This is automatically cleared by io.ClearInputKeys(). (#4921) - ImDrawData: CmdLists[] array is now owned, changed from 'ImDrawList**' to 'ImVector'. Majority of users shouldn't be affected, but you cannot compare to NULL nor reassign manually anymore. @@ -811,10 +1051,10 @@ Other changes: will slightly reduce scrollbar size. Generally we tried to make it that window border size has no incidence on layout but this can't work with thick borders. (#2522) - IO: Added io.ClearEventsQueue() to clear incoming inputs events. (#4921) - May be useful in conjunction with io.ClearInputsKeys() if you need to clear + May be useful in conjunction with io.ClearInputKeys() if you need to clear both current inputs state and queued events (e.g. when using blocking native dialogs such as Windows's ::MessageBox() or ::GetOpenFileName()). -- IO: Changed io.ClearInputsKeys() specs to also clear current frame character buffer +- IO: Changed io.ClearInputKeys() specs to also clear current frame character buffer (what now obsoleted io.ClearInputCharacters() did), as this is effectively the desirable behavior. - Misc: Added IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_SPRINTF_IMPLEMENTATION config macro to disable diff --git a/docs/FAQ.md b/docs/FAQ.md index 9c7df2334262..e120e8cd6797 100644 --- a/docs/FAQ.md +++ b/docs/FAQ.md @@ -639,7 +639,7 @@ The applications in examples/ are doing that. Windows: you can use the WM_CHAR or WM_UNICHAR or WM_IME_CHAR message (depending if your app is built using Unicode or MultiByte mode). You may also use `MultiByteToWideChar()` or `ToUnicode()` to retrieve Unicode codepoints from MultiByte characters or keyboard state. Windows: if your language is relying on an Input Method Editor (IME), you can write your HWND to ImGui::GetMainViewport()->PlatformHandleRaw -for the default implementation of io.SetPlatformImeDataFn() to set your Microsoft IME position correctly. +for the default implementation of io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() to set your Microsoft IME position correctly. ##### [Return to Index](#index) diff --git a/examples/example_glfw_opengl3/main.cpp b/examples/example_glfw_opengl3/main.cpp index b377a78562c1..fb11a93aaeee 100644 --- a/examples/example_glfw_opengl3/main.cpp +++ b/examples/example_glfw_opengl3/main.cpp @@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ int main(int, char**) // Setup Platform/Renderer backends ImGui_ImplGlfw_InitForOpenGL(window, true); #ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ - ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback("#canvas"); + ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(window, "#canvas"); #endif ImGui_ImplOpenGL3_Init(glsl_version); diff --git a/examples/example_glfw_vulkan/main.cpp b/examples/example_glfw_vulkan/main.cpp index b6e53ed8d4e3..e1f099e3d3cb 100644 --- a/examples/example_glfw_vulkan/main.cpp +++ b/examples/example_glfw_vulkan/main.cpp @@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ // Volk headers #ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_VULKAN_USE_VOLK #define VOLK_IMPLEMENTATION -#include +#include #endif // [Win32] Our example includes a copy of glfw3.lib pre-compiled with VS2010 to maximize ease of testing and compatibility with old VS compilers. @@ -485,17 +485,14 @@ int main(int, char**) glfwPollEvents(); // Resize swap chain? - if (g_SwapChainRebuild) + int fb_width, fb_height; + glfwGetFramebufferSize(window, &fb_width, &fb_height); + if (fb_width > 0 && fb_height > 0 && (g_SwapChainRebuild || g_MainWindowData.Width != fb_width || g_MainWindowData.Height != fb_height)) { - int width, height; - glfwGetFramebufferSize(window, &width, &height); - if (width > 0 && height > 0) - { - ImGui_ImplVulkan_SetMinImageCount(g_MinImageCount); - ImGui_ImplVulkanH_CreateOrResizeWindow(g_Instance, g_PhysicalDevice, g_Device, &g_MainWindowData, g_QueueFamily, g_Allocator, width, height, g_MinImageCount); - g_MainWindowData.FrameIndex = 0; - g_SwapChainRebuild = false; - } + ImGui_ImplVulkan_SetMinImageCount(g_MinImageCount); + ImGui_ImplVulkanH_CreateOrResizeWindow(g_Instance, g_PhysicalDevice, g_Device, &g_MainWindowData, g_QueueFamily, g_Allocator, fb_width, fb_height, g_MinImageCount); + g_MainWindowData.FrameIndex = 0; + g_SwapChainRebuild = false; } // Start the Dear ImGui frame diff --git a/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/CMakeLists.txt b/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/CMakeLists.txt index e682836ddb58..77b492fdc278 100644 --- a/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/CMakeLists.txt +++ b/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/CMakeLists.txt @@ -27,6 +27,12 @@ set(IMGUI_DIR ../../) # Libraries if(EMSCRIPTEN) + if(EMSCRIPTEN_VERSION VERSION_GREATER_EQUAL "3.1.57") + set(IMGUI_EMSCRIPTEN_GLFW3 "--use-port=contrib.glfw3" CACHE STRING "Choose between --use-port=contrib.glfw3 and -sUSE_GLFW=3 for GLFW implementation (default to --use-port=contrib.glfw3)") + else() + # cannot use contrib.glfw3 prior to 3.1.57 + set(IMGUI_EMSCRIPTEN_GLFW3 "-sUSE_GLFW=3" CACHE STRING "Use -sUSE_GLFW=3 for GLFW implementation" FORCE) + endif() set(LIBRARIES glfw) add_compile_options(-sDISABLE_EXCEPTION_CATCHING=1 -DIMGUI_DISABLE_FILE_FUNCTIONS=1) else() @@ -82,9 +88,16 @@ target_link_libraries(example_glfw_wgpu PUBLIC ${LIBRARIES}) # Emscripten settings if(EMSCRIPTEN) + if("${IMGUI_EMSCRIPTEN_GLFW3}" STREQUAL "--use-port=contrib.glfw3") + target_compile_options(example_glfw_wgpu PUBLIC + "${IMGUI_EMSCRIPTEN_GLFW3}" + "-DEMSCRIPTEN_USE_PORT_CONTRIB_GLFW3" # unnecessary beyond emscripten 3.1.59 + ) + endif() + message(STATUS "Using ${IMGUI_EMSCRIPTEN_GLFW3} GLFW implementation") target_link_options(example_glfw_wgpu PRIVATE "-sUSE_WEBGPU=1" - "-sUSE_GLFW=3" + "${IMGUI_EMSCRIPTEN_GLFW3}" "-sWASM=1" "-sALLOW_MEMORY_GROWTH=1" "-sNO_EXIT_RUNTIME=0" diff --git a/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/main.cpp b/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/main.cpp index 4e47b8323bd6..c5872bd85c7f 100644 --- a/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/main.cpp +++ b/examples/example_glfw_wgpu/main.cpp @@ -101,7 +101,7 @@ int main(int, char**) // Setup Platform/Renderer backends ImGui_ImplGlfw_InitForOther(window, true); #ifdef __EMSCRIPTEN__ - ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCanvasResizeCallback("#canvas"); + ImGui_ImplGlfw_InstallEmscriptenCallbacks(window, "#canvas"); #endif ImGui_ImplWGPU_InitInfo init_info; init_info.Device = wgpu_device; diff --git a/examples/example_sdl2_vulkan/main.cpp b/examples/example_sdl2_vulkan/main.cpp index df0db4d1e67d..afcebf1b913d 100644 --- a/examples/example_sdl2_vulkan/main.cpp +++ b/examples/example_sdl2_vulkan/main.cpp @@ -24,7 +24,7 @@ // Volk headers #ifdef IMGUI_IMPL_VULKAN_USE_VOLK #define VOLK_IMPLEMENTATION -#include +#include #endif //#define APP_USE_UNLIMITED_FRAME_RATE @@ -494,17 +494,14 @@ int main(int, char**) } // Resize swap chain? - if (g_SwapChainRebuild) + int fb_width, fb_height; + SDL_GetWindowSize(window, &fb_width, &fb_height); + if (fb_width > 0 && fb_height > 0 && (g_SwapChainRebuild || g_MainWindowData.Width != fb_width || g_MainWindowData.Height != fb_height)) { - int width, height; - SDL_GetWindowSize(window, &width, &height); - if (width > 0 && height > 0) - { - ImGui_ImplVulkan_SetMinImageCount(g_MinImageCount); - ImGui_ImplVulkanH_CreateOrResizeWindow(g_Instance, g_PhysicalDevice, g_Device, &g_MainWindowData, g_QueueFamily, g_Allocator, width, height, g_MinImageCount); - g_MainWindowData.FrameIndex = 0; - g_SwapChainRebuild = false; - } + ImGui_ImplVulkan_SetMinImageCount(g_MinImageCount); + ImGui_ImplVulkanH_CreateOrResizeWindow(g_Instance, g_PhysicalDevice, g_Device, &g_MainWindowData, g_QueueFamily, g_Allocator, fb_width, fb_height, g_MinImageCount); + g_MainWindowData.FrameIndex = 0; + g_SwapChainRebuild = false; } // Start the Dear ImGui frame diff --git a/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/Makefile b/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/Makefile index 3a00a31e70f4..741e97d0c270 100644 --- a/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/Makefile +++ b/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/Makefile @@ -37,9 +37,9 @@ LIBS = ifeq ($(UNAME_S), Linux) #LINUX ECHO_MESSAGE = "Linux" - LIBS += $(LINUX_GL_LIBS) -ldl `sdl3-config --libs` + LIBS += $(LINUX_GL_LIBS) -ldl `pkg-config sdl3 --libs` - CXXFLAGS += `sdl3-config --cflags` + CXXFLAGS += `pkg-config sdl3 --cflags` CFLAGS = $(CXXFLAGS) endif @@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ ifeq ($(UNAME_S), Darwin) #APPLE LIBS += -framework OpenGL -framework Cocoa -framework IOKit -framework CoreVideo `sdl3-config --libs` LIBS += -L/usr/local/lib -L/opt/local/lib - CXXFLAGS += `sdl3-config --cflags` + CXXFLAGS += `pkg-config sdl3 --cflags` CXXFLAGS += -I/usr/local/include -I/opt/local/include CFLAGS = $(CXXFLAGS) endif diff --git a/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/main.cpp b/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/main.cpp index da12589f8b5f..c4eee77d4eac 100644 --- a/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/main.cpp +++ b/examples/example_sdl3_opengl3/main.cpp @@ -57,9 +57,6 @@ int main(int, char**) SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_CONTEXT_MINOR_VERSION, 0); #endif - // Enable native IME. - SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_IME_SHOW_UI, "1"); - // Create window with graphics context SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_DOUBLEBUFFER, 1); SDL_GL_SetAttribute(SDL_GL_DEPTH_SIZE, 24); @@ -199,7 +196,7 @@ int main(int, char**) ImGui_ImplSDL3_Shutdown(); ImGui::DestroyContext(); - SDL_GL_DeleteContext(gl_context); + SDL_GL_DestroyContext(gl_context); SDL_DestroyWindow(window); SDL_Quit(); diff --git a/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/Makefile b/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/Makefile index d0a73bf16486..238576c7c341 100644 --- a/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/Makefile +++ b/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/Makefile @@ -26,9 +26,9 @@ LIBS = ifeq ($(UNAME_S), Linux) #LINUX ECHO_MESSAGE = "Linux" - LIBS += -ldl `sdl3-config --libs` + LIBS += -ldl `pkg-config sdl3 --libs` - CXXFLAGS += `sdl3-config --cflags` + CXXFLAGS += `pkg-config sdl3 --cflags` CFLAGS = $(CXXFLAGS) endif @@ -37,7 +37,7 @@ ifeq ($(UNAME_S), Darwin) #APPLE LIBS += -framework OpenGL -framework Cocoa -framework IOKit -framework CoreVideo `sdl3-config --libs` LIBS += -L/usr/local/lib -L/opt/local/lib - CXXFLAGS += `sdl3-config --cflags` + CXXFLAGS += `pkg-config sdl3 --cflags` CXXFLAGS += -I/usr/local/include -I/opt/local/include CFLAGS = $(CXXFLAGS) endif diff --git a/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/main.cpp b/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/main.cpp index baa7cd76e77d..607d00b6b7bd 100644 --- a/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/main.cpp +++ b/examples/example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3/main.cpp @@ -31,9 +31,6 @@ int main(int, char**) return -1; } - // Enable native IME. - SDL_SetHint(SDL_HINT_IME_SHOW_UI, "1"); - // Create window with SDL_Renderer graphics context Uint32 window_flags = SDL_WINDOW_OPENGL | SDL_WINDOW_RESIZABLE | SDL_WINDOW_HIDDEN; SDL_Window* window = SDL_CreateWindow("Dear ImGui SDL3+SDL_Renderer example", 1280, 720, window_flags); @@ -160,7 +157,7 @@ int main(int, char**) // Rendering ImGui::Render(); //SDL_RenderSetScale(renderer, io.DisplayFramebufferScale.x, io.DisplayFramebufferScale.y); - SDL_SetRenderDrawColor(renderer, (Uint8)(clear_color.x * 255), (Uint8)(clear_color.y * 255), (Uint8)(clear_color.z * 255), (Uint8)(clear_color.w * 255)); + SDL_SetRenderDrawColorFloat(renderer, clear_color.x, clear_color.y, clear_color.z, clear_color.w); SDL_RenderClear(renderer); ImGui_ImplSDLRenderer3_RenderDrawData(ImGui::GetDrawData(), renderer); SDL_RenderPresent(renderer); diff --git a/examples/imgui_examples.sln b/examples/imgui_examples.sln index 071bcbd63823..9aee4a99e093 100644 --- a/examples/imgui_examples.sln +++ b/examples/imgui_examples.sln @@ -29,6 +29,10 @@ Project("{8BC9CEB8-8B4A-11D0-8D11-00A0C91BC942}") = "example_win32_opengl3", "ex EndProject Project("{8BC9CEB8-8B4A-11D0-8D11-00A0C91BC942}") = "example_sdl2_sdlrenderer2", "example_sdl2_sdlrenderer2\example_sdl2_sdlrenderer2.vcxproj", "{0C0B2BEA-311F-473C-9652-87923EF639E3}" EndProject +Project("{8BC9CEB8-8B4A-11D0-8D11-00A0C91BC942}") = "example_sdl3_opengl3", "example_sdl3_opengl3\example_sdl3_opengl3.vcxproj", "{84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}" +EndProject +Project("{8BC9CEB8-8B4A-11D0-8D11-00A0C91BC942}") = "example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3", "example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3\example_sdl3_sdlrenderer3.vcxproj", "{C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}" +EndProject Global GlobalSection(SolutionConfigurationPlatforms) = preSolution Debug|Win32 = Debug|Win32 @@ -141,6 +145,22 @@ Global {0C0B2BEA-311F-473C-9652-87923EF639E3}.Release|Win32.Build.0 = Release|Win32 {0C0B2BEA-311F-473C-9652-87923EF639E3}.Release|x64.ActiveCfg = Release|x64 {0C0B2BEA-311F-473C-9652-87923EF639E3}.Release|x64.Build.0 = Release|x64 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Debug|Win32.ActiveCfg = Debug|Win32 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Debug|Win32.Build.0 = Debug|Win32 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Debug|x64.ActiveCfg = Debug|x64 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Debug|x64.Build.0 = Debug|x64 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Release|Win32.ActiveCfg = Release|Win32 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Release|Win32.Build.0 = Release|Win32 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Release|x64.ActiveCfg = Release|x64 + {84AAA301-84FE-428B-9E3E-817BC8123C0C}.Release|x64.Build.0 = Release|x64 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Debug|Win32.ActiveCfg = Debug|Win32 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Debug|Win32.Build.0 = Debug|Win32 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Debug|x64.ActiveCfg = Debug|x64 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Debug|x64.Build.0 = Debug|x64 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Release|Win32.ActiveCfg = Release|Win32 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Release|Win32.Build.0 = Release|Win32 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Release|x64.ActiveCfg = Release|x64 + {C0290D21-3AD2-4A35-ABBC-A2F5F48326DA}.Release|x64.Build.0 = Release|x64 EndGlobalSection GlobalSection(SolutionProperties) = preSolution HideSolutionNode = FALSE diff --git a/imgui.cpp b/imgui.cpp index 770b2182a8d7..d666b513f63f 100644 --- a/imgui.cpp +++ b/imgui.cpp @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (main code and documentation) // Help: @@ -430,6 +430,24 @@ CODE When you are not sure about an old symbol or function name, try using the Search/Find function of your IDE to look for comments or references in all imgui files. You can read releases logs https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases for more details. + - 2024/07/15 (1.91.0) - renamed ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups to ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoAutoClosePopups. (#1379, #1468, #2200, #4936, #5216, #7302, #7573) + (internals: also renamed ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup into ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups with inverted behaviors) + - 2024/07/15 (1.91.0) - obsoleted PushButtonRepeat()/PopButtonRepeat() in favor of using new PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, ...)/PopItemFlag(). + - 2024/07/02 (1.91.0) - commented out obsolete ImGuiModFlags (renamed to ImGuiKeyChord in 1.89). (#4921, #456) + - commented out obsolete ImGuiModFlags_XXX values (renamed to ImGuiMod_XXX in 1.89). (#4921, #456) + - ImGuiModFlags_Ctrl -> ImGuiMod_Ctrl, ImGuiModFlags_Shift -> ImGuiMod_Shift etc. + - 2024/07/02 (1.91.0) - IO, IME: renamed platform IME hook and added explicit context for consistency and future-proofness. + - old: io.SetPlatformImeDataFn(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); + - new: io.PlatformSetImeDataFn(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); + - 2024/06/21 (1.90.9) - BeginChild: added ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened as a replacement for the window flag ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened: the feature only ever made sense for BeginChild() anyhow. + - old: BeginChild("Name", size, 0, ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened); + - new: BeginChild("Name", size, ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened, 0); + - 2024/06/21 (1.90.9) - io: ClearInputKeys() (first exposed in 1.89.8) doesn't clear mouse data, newly added ClearInputMouse() does. + - 2024/06/20 (1.90.9) - renamed ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload to ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadAutoExpire. + - 2024/06/18 (1.90.9) - style: renamed ImGuiCol_TabActive -> ImGuiCol_TabSelected, ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused -> ImGuiCol_TabDimmed, ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive -> ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected. + - 2024/06/10 (1.90.9) - removed old nested structure: renaming ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair type to ImGuiStoragePair (simpler for many languages). + - 2024/06/06 (1.90.8) - reordered ImGuiInputTextFlags values. This should not be breaking unless you are using generated headers that have values not matching the main library. + - 2024/06/06 (1.90.8) - removed 'ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft', was mostly unused and misleading. - 2024/05/27 (1.90.7) - commented out obsolete symbols marked obsolete in 1.88 (May 2022): - old: CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool) - new: SetNextFrameWantCaptureKeyboard(bool) @@ -1006,7 +1024,7 @@ CODE #endif // [Windows] OS specific includes (optional) -#if defined(_WIN32) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) +#if defined(_WIN32) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FILE_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) #define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS #endif #if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) @@ -1025,6 +1043,7 @@ CODE // The UWP and GDK Win32 API subsets don't support clipboard nor IME functions #define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS #define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS #endif #endif @@ -1077,7 +1096,7 @@ CODE #endif // Debug options -#define IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_SCORING 0 // Display navigation scoring preview when hovering items. Display last moving direction matches when holding CTRL +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_SCORING 0 // Display navigation scoring preview when hovering items. Hold CTRL to display for all candidates. CTRL+Arrow to change last direction. #define IMGUI_DEBUG_NAV_RECTS 0 // Display the reference navigation rectangle for each window // When using CTRL+TAB (or Gamepad Square+L/R) we delay the visual a little in order to reduce visual noise doing a fast switch. @@ -1114,7 +1133,8 @@ static void WindowSettingsHandler_WriteAll(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiSetti // Platform Dependents default implementation for IO functions static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data_ctx); static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data_ctx, const char* text); -static void SetPlatformImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); +static void PlatformSetImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); +static bool PlatformOpenInShellFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext* ctx, const char* path); namespace ImGui { @@ -1249,12 +1269,13 @@ ImGuiStyle::ImGuiStyle() TabBorderSize = 0.0f; // Thickness of border around tabs. TabMinWidthForCloseButton = 0.0f; // Minimum width for close button to appear on an unselected tab when hovered. Set to 0.0f to always show when hovering, set to FLT_MAX to never show close button unless selected. TabBarBorderSize = 1.0f; // Thickness of tab-bar separator, which takes on the tab active color to denote focus. + TabBarOverlineSize = 2.0f; // Thickness of tab-bar overline, which highlights the selected tab-bar. TableAngledHeadersAngle = 35.0f * (IM_PI / 180.0f); // Angle of angled headers (supported values range from -50 degrees to +50 degrees). TableAngledHeadersTextAlign = ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f);// Alignment of angled headers within the cell ColorButtonPosition = ImGuiDir_Right; // Side of the color button in the ColorEdit4 widget (left/right). Defaults to ImGuiDir_Right. ButtonTextAlign = ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f);// Alignment of button text when button is larger than text. SelectableTextAlign = ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f);// Alignment of selectable text. Defaults to (0.0f, 0.0f) (top-left aligned). It's generally important to keep this left-aligned if you want to lay multiple items on a same line. - SeparatorTextBorderSize = 3.0f; // Thickkness of border in SeparatorText() + SeparatorTextBorderSize = 3.0f; // Thickness of border in SeparatorText() SeparatorTextAlign = ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f);// Alignment of text within the separator. Defaults to (0.0f, 0.5f) (left aligned, center). SeparatorTextPadding = ImVec2(20.0f,3.f);// Horizontal offset of text from each edge of the separator + spacing on other axis. Generally small values. .y is recommended to be == FramePadding.y. DisplayWindowPadding = ImVec2(19,19); // Window position are clamped to be visible within the display area or monitors by at least this amount. Only applies to regular windows. @@ -1301,6 +1322,7 @@ void ImGuiStyle::ScaleAllSizes(float scale_factor) LogSliderDeadzone = ImTrunc(LogSliderDeadzone * scale_factor); TabRounding = ImTrunc(TabRounding * scale_factor); TabMinWidthForCloseButton = (TabMinWidthForCloseButton != FLT_MAX) ? ImTrunc(TabMinWidthForCloseButton * scale_factor) : FLT_MAX; + TabBarOverlineSize = ImTrunc(TabBarOverlineSize * scale_factor); SeparatorTextPadding = ImTrunc(SeparatorTextPadding * scale_factor); DisplayWindowPadding = ImTrunc(DisplayWindowPadding * scale_factor); DisplaySafeAreaPadding = ImTrunc(DisplaySafeAreaPadding * scale_factor); @@ -1360,6 +1382,7 @@ ImGuiIO::ImGuiIO() // Note: Initialize() will setup default clipboard/ime handlers. BackendPlatformName = BackendRendererName = NULL; BackendPlatformUserData = BackendRendererUserData = BackendLanguageUserData = NULL; + PlatformOpenInShellUserData = NULL; PlatformLocaleDecimalPoint = '.'; // Input (NB: we already have memset zero the entire structure!) @@ -1448,7 +1471,7 @@ void ImGuiIO::ClearEventsQueue() g.InputEventsQueue.clear(); } -// Clear current keyboard/mouse/gamepad state + current frame text input buffer. Equivalent to releasing all keys/buttons. +// Clear current keyboard/gamepad state + current frame text input buffer. Equivalent to releasing all keys/buttons. void ImGuiIO::ClearInputKeys() { #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_KEYIO @@ -1456,12 +1479,26 @@ void ImGuiIO::ClearInputKeys() #endif for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(KeysData); n++) { + if (ImGui::IsMouseKey((ImGuiKey)(n + ImGuiKey_KeysData_OFFSET))) + continue; KeysData[n].Down = false; KeysData[n].DownDuration = -1.0f; KeysData[n].DownDurationPrev = -1.0f; } KeyCtrl = KeyShift = KeyAlt = KeySuper = false; KeyMods = ImGuiMod_None; + InputQueueCharacters.resize(0); // Behavior of old ClearInputCharacters(). +} + +void ImGuiIO::ClearInputMouse() +{ + for (ImGuiKey key = ImGuiKey_Mouse_BEGIN; key < ImGuiKey_Mouse_END; key = (ImGuiKey)(key + 1)) + { + ImGuiKeyData* key_data = &KeysData[key - ImGuiKey_KeysData_OFFSET]; + key_data->Down = false; + key_data->DownDuration = -1.0f; + key_data->DownDurationPrev = -1.0f; + } MousePos = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(MouseDown); n++) { @@ -1469,7 +1506,6 @@ void ImGuiIO::ClearInputKeys() MouseDownDuration[n] = MouseDownDurationPrev[n] = -1.0f; } MouseWheel = MouseWheelH = 0.0f; - InputQueueCharacters.resize(0); // Behavior of old ClearInputCharacters(). } // Removed this as it is ambiguous/misleading and generally incorrect to use with the existence of a higher-level input queue. @@ -2023,6 +2059,10 @@ void ImFormatStringToTempBuffer(const char** out_buf, const char** out_buf_end, va_end(args); } +// FIXME: Should rework API toward allowing multiple in-flight temp buffers (easier and safer for caller) +// by making the caller acquire a temp buffer token, with either explicit or destructor release, e.g. +// ImGuiTempBufferToken token; +// ImFormatStringToTempBuffer(token, ...); void ImFormatStringToTempBufferV(const char** out_buf, const char** out_buf_end, const char* fmt, va_list args) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; @@ -2500,18 +2540,16 @@ void ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(float h, float s, float v, float& out_r, float& //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // std::lower_bound but without the bullshit -static ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* LowerBound(ImVector& data, ImGuiID key) +ImGuiStoragePair* ImLowerBound(ImGuiStoragePair* in_begin, ImGuiStoragePair* in_end, ImGuiID key) { - ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* first = data.Data; - ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* last = data.Data + data.Size; - size_t count = (size_t)(last - first); - while (count > 0) + ImGuiStoragePair* in_p = in_begin; + for (size_t count = (size_t)(in_end - in_p); count > 0; ) { size_t count2 = count >> 1; - ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* mid = first + count2; + ImGuiStoragePair* mid = in_p + count2; if (mid->key < key) { - first = ++mid; + in_p = ++mid; count -= count2 + 1; } else @@ -2519,28 +2557,28 @@ static ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair* LowerBound(ImVectorkey; + ImGuiID rhs_v = ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)rhs)->key; + return (lhs_v > rhs_v ? +1 : lhs_v < rhs_v ? -1 : 0); } // For quicker full rebuild of a storage (instead of an incremental one), you may add all your contents and then sort once. void ImGuiStorage::BuildSortByKey() { - struct StaticFunc - { - static int IMGUI_CDECL PairComparerByID(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) - { - // We can't just do a subtraction because qsort uses signed integers and subtracting our ID doesn't play well with that. - if (((const ImGuiStoragePair*)lhs)->key > ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)rhs)->key) return +1; - if (((const ImGuiStoragePair*)lhs)->key < ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)rhs)->key) return -1; - return 0; - } - }; - ImQsort(Data.Data, (size_t)Data.Size, sizeof(ImGuiStoragePair), StaticFunc::PairComparerByID); + ImQsort(Data.Data, (size_t)Data.Size, sizeof(ImGuiStoragePair), PairComparerByID); } +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE int ImGuiStorage::GetInt(ImGuiID key, int default_val) const { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(const_cast(Data.Data), const_cast(Data.Data + Data.Size), key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) return default_val; return it->val_i; @@ -2553,7 +2591,7 @@ bool ImGuiStorage::GetBool(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) const float ImGuiStorage::GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val) const { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(const_cast(Data.Data), const_cast(Data.Data + Data.Size), key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) return default_val; return it->val_f; @@ -2561,7 +2599,7 @@ float ImGuiStorage::GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val) const void* ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(const_cast(Data.Data), const_cast(Data.Data + Data.Size), key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) return NULL; return it->val_p; @@ -2570,7 +2608,7 @@ void* ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const // References are only valid until a new value is added to the storage. Calling a Set***() function or a Get***Ref() function invalidates the pointer. int* ImGuiStorage::GetIntRef(ImGuiID key, int default_val) { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(Data.Data, Data.Data + Data.Size, key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) it = Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, default_val)); return &it->val_i; @@ -2583,7 +2621,7 @@ bool* ImGuiStorage::GetBoolRef(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) float* ImGuiStorage::GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val) { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(Data.Data, Data.Data + Data.Size, key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) it = Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, default_val)); return &it->val_f; @@ -2591,7 +2629,7 @@ float* ImGuiStorage::GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val) void** ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val) { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(Data.Data, Data.Data + Data.Size, key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) it = Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, default_val)); return &it->val_p; @@ -2600,7 +2638,7 @@ void** ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val) // FIXME-OPT: Need a way to reuse the result of lower_bound when doing GetInt()/SetInt() - not too bad because it only happens on explicit interaction (maximum one a frame) void ImGuiStorage::SetInt(ImGuiID key, int val) { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(Data.Data, Data.Data + Data.Size, key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, val)); else @@ -2614,7 +2652,7 @@ void ImGuiStorage::SetBool(ImGuiID key, bool val) void ImGuiStorage::SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val) { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(Data.Data, Data.Data + Data.Size, key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, val)); else @@ -2623,7 +2661,7 @@ void ImGuiStorage::SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val) void ImGuiStorage::SetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key, void* val) { - ImGuiStoragePair* it = LowerBound(Data, key); + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(Data.Data, Data.Data + Data.Size, key); if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) Data.insert(it, ImGuiStoragePair(key, val)); else @@ -2877,15 +2915,6 @@ static void ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorAndSetupPrevLine(float pos_y, float line_ } } -static void ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorForItem(ImGuiListClipper* clipper, int item_n) -{ - // StartPosY starts from ItemsFrozen hence the subtraction - // Perform the add and multiply with double to allow seeking through larger ranges - ImGuiListClipperData* data = (ImGuiListClipperData*)clipper->TempData; - float pos_y = (float)((double)clipper->StartPosY + data->LossynessOffset + (double)(item_n - data->ItemsFrozen) * clipper->ItemsHeight); - ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorAndSetupPrevLine(pos_y, clipper->ItemsHeight); -} - ImGuiListClipper::ImGuiListClipper() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); @@ -2922,6 +2951,7 @@ void ImGuiListClipper::Begin(int items_count, float items_height) data->Reset(this); data->LossynessOffset = window->DC.CursorStartPosLossyness.y; TempData = data; + StartSeekOffsetY = data->LossynessOffset; } void ImGuiListClipper::End() @@ -2932,7 +2962,7 @@ void ImGuiListClipper::End() ImGuiContext& g = *Ctx; IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_CLIPPER("Clipper: End() in '%s'\n", g.CurrentWindow->Name); if (ItemsCount >= 0 && ItemsCount < INT_MAX && DisplayStart >= 0) - ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorForItem(this, ItemsCount); + SeekCursorForItem(ItemsCount); // Restore temporary buffer and fix back pointers which may be invalidated when nesting IM_ASSERT(data->ListClipper == this); @@ -2956,6 +2986,17 @@ void ImGuiListClipper::IncludeItemsByIndex(int item_begin, int item_end) data->Ranges.push_back(ImGuiListClipperRange::FromIndices(item_begin, item_end)); } +// This is already called while stepping. +// The ONLY reason you may want to call this is if you passed INT_MAX to ImGuiListClipper::Begin() because you couldn't step item count beforehand. +void ImGuiListClipper::SeekCursorForItem(int item_n) +{ + // - Perform the add and multiply with double to allow seeking through larger ranges. + // - StartPosY starts from ItemsFrozen, by adding SeekOffsetY we generally cancel that out (SeekOffsetY == LossynessOffset - ItemsFrozen * ItemsHeight). + // - The reason we store SeekOffsetY instead of inferring it, is because we want to allow user to perform Seek after the last step, where ImGuiListClipperData is already done. + float pos_y = (float)((double)StartPosY + StartSeekOffsetY + (double)item_n * ItemsHeight); + ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorAndSetupPrevLine(pos_y, ItemsHeight); +} + static bool ImGuiListClipper_StepInternal(ImGuiListClipper* clipper) { ImGuiContext& g = *clipper->Ctx; @@ -3019,6 +3060,9 @@ static bool ImGuiListClipper_StepInternal(ImGuiListClipper* clipper) const int already_submitted = clipper->DisplayEnd; if (calc_clipping) { + // Record seek offset, this is so ImGuiListClipper::Seek() can be called after ImGuiListClipperData is done + clipper->StartSeekOffsetY = (double)data->LossynessOffset - data->ItemsFrozen * (double)clipper->ItemsHeight; + if (g.LogEnabled) { // If logging is active, do not perform any clipping @@ -3039,9 +3083,27 @@ static bool ImGuiListClipper_StepInternal(ImGuiListClipper* clipper) data->Ranges.push_back(ImGuiListClipperRange::FromPositions(nav_rect_abs.Min.y, nav_rect_abs.Max.y, 0, 0)); // Add visible range + float min_y = window->ClipRect.Min.y; + float max_y = window->ClipRect.Max.y; + + // Add box selection range + ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = &g.BoxSelectState; + if (bs->IsActive && bs->Window == window) + { + // FIXME: Selectable() use of half-ItemSpacing isn't consistent in matter of layout, as ItemAdd(bb) stray above ItemSize()'s CursorPos. + // RangeSelect's BoxSelect relies on comparing overlap of previous and current rectangle and is sensitive to that. + // As a workaround we currently half ItemSpacing worth on each side. + min_y -= g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; + max_y += g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; + + // Box-select on 2D area requires different clipping. + if (bs->UnclipMode) + data->Ranges.push_back(ImGuiListClipperRange::FromPositions(bs->UnclipRect.Min.y, bs->UnclipRect.Max.y, 0, 0)); + } + const int off_min = (is_nav_request && g.NavMoveClipDir == ImGuiDir_Up) ? -1 : 0; const int off_max = (is_nav_request && g.NavMoveClipDir == ImGuiDir_Down) ? 1 : 0; - data->Ranges.push_back(ImGuiListClipperRange::FromPositions(window->ClipRect.Min.y, window->ClipRect.Max.y, off_min, off_max)); + data->Ranges.push_back(ImGuiListClipperRange::FromPositions(min_y, max_y, off_min, off_max)); } // Convert position ranges to item index ranges @@ -3066,7 +3128,7 @@ static bool ImGuiListClipper_StepInternal(ImGuiListClipper* clipper) clipper->DisplayStart = ImMax(data->Ranges[data->StepNo].Min, already_submitted); clipper->DisplayEnd = ImMin(data->Ranges[data->StepNo].Max, clipper->ItemsCount); if (clipper->DisplayStart > already_submitted) //-V1051 - ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorForItem(clipper, clipper->DisplayStart); + clipper->SeekCursorForItem(clipper->DisplayStart); data->StepNo++; if (clipper->DisplayStart == clipper->DisplayEnd && data->StepNo < data->Ranges.Size) continue; @@ -3076,7 +3138,7 @@ static bool ImGuiListClipper_StepInternal(ImGuiListClipper* clipper) // After the last step: Let the clipper validate that we have reached the expected Y position (corresponding to element DisplayEnd), // Advance the cursor to the end of the list and then returns 'false' to end the loop. if (clipper->ItemsCount < INT_MAX) - ImGuiListClipper_SeekCursorForItem(clipper, clipper->ItemsCount); + clipper->SeekCursorForItem(clipper->ItemsCount); return false; } @@ -3214,6 +3276,7 @@ static const ImGuiDataVarInfo GStyleVarInfo[] = { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, TabRounding) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_TabRounding { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, TabBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_TabBorderSize { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, TabBarBorderSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_TabBarBorderSize + { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, TabBarOverlineSize) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_TabBarOverlineSize { ImGuiDataType_Float, 1, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, TableAngledHeadersAngle)}, // ImGuiStyleVar_TableAngledHeadersAngle { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, TableAngledHeadersTextAlign)},// ImGuiStyleVar_TableAngledHeadersTextAlign { ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, (ImU32)offsetof(ImGuiStyle, ButtonTextAlign) }, // ImGuiStyleVar_ButtonTextAlign @@ -3317,11 +3380,13 @@ const char* ImGui::GetStyleColorName(ImGuiCol idx) case ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip: return "ResizeGrip"; case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered: return "ResizeGripHovered"; case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive: return "ResizeGripActive"; - case ImGuiCol_Tab: return "Tab"; case ImGuiCol_TabHovered: return "TabHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_TabActive: return "TabActive"; - case ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused: return "TabUnfocused"; - case ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive: return "TabUnfocusedActive"; + case ImGuiCol_Tab: return "Tab"; + case ImGuiCol_TabSelected: return "TabSelected"; + case ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline: return "TabSelectedOverline"; + case ImGuiCol_TabDimmed: return "TabDimmed"; + case ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected: return "TabDimmedSelected"; + case ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline: return "TabDimmedSelectedOverline"; case ImGuiCol_PlotLines: return "PlotLines"; case ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered: return "PlotLinesHovered"; case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram: return "PlotHistogram"; @@ -3331,6 +3396,7 @@ const char* ImGui::GetStyleColorName(ImGuiCol idx) case ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight: return "TableBorderLight"; case ImGuiCol_TableRowBg: return "TableRowBg"; case ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt: return "TableRowBgAlt"; + case ImGuiCol_TextLink: return "TextLink"; case ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg: return "TextSelectedBg"; case ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget: return "DragDropTarget"; case ImGuiCol_NavHighlight: return "NavHighlight"; @@ -3476,7 +3542,7 @@ void ImGui::RenderTextEllipsis(ImDrawList* draw_list, const ImVec2& pos_min, con const ImFont* font = draw_list->_Data->Font; const float font_size = draw_list->_Data->FontSize; - const float font_scale = font_size / font->FontSize; + const float font_scale = draw_list->_Data->FontScale; const char* text_end_ellipsis = NULL; const float ellipsis_width = font->EllipsisWidth * font_scale; @@ -3653,7 +3719,7 @@ void ImGui::DestroyContext(ImGuiContext* ctx) IM_DELETE(ctx); } -// IMPORTANT: ###xxx suffixes must be same in ALL languages +// IMPORTANT: ###xxx suffixes must be same in ALL languages to allow for automation. static const ImGuiLocEntry GLocalizationEntriesEnUS[] = { { ImGuiLocKey_VersionStr, "Dear ImGui " IMGUI_VERSION " (" IM_STRINGIFY(IMGUI_VERSION_NUM) ")" }, @@ -3664,6 +3730,7 @@ static const ImGuiLocEntry GLocalizationEntriesEnUS[] = { ImGuiLocKey_WindowingMainMenuBar, "(Main menu bar)" }, { ImGuiLocKey_WindowingPopup, "(Popup)" }, { ImGuiLocKey_WindowingUntitled, "(Untitled)" }, + { ImGuiLocKey_CopyLink, "Copy Link###CopyLink" }, }; void ImGui::Initialize() @@ -3692,7 +3759,8 @@ void ImGui::Initialize() g.IO.GetClipboardTextFn = GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; // Platform dependent default implementations g.IO.SetClipboardTextFn = SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; g.IO.ClipboardUserData = (void*)&g; // Default implementation use the ImGuiContext as user data (ideally those would be arguments to the function) - g.IO.SetPlatformImeDataFn = SetPlatformImeDataFn_DefaultImpl; + g.IO.PlatformOpenInShellFn = PlatformOpenInShellFn_DefaultImpl; + g.IO.PlatformSetImeDataFn = PlatformSetImeDataFn_DefaultImpl; // Create default viewport ImGuiViewportP* viewport = IM_NEW(ImGuiViewportP)(); @@ -3759,7 +3827,7 @@ void ImGui::Shutdown() g.FontStack.clear(); g.OpenPopupStack.clear(); g.BeginPopupStack.clear(); - g.NavTreeNodeStack.clear(); + g.TreeNodeStack.clear(); g.Viewports.clear_delete(); @@ -3773,6 +3841,9 @@ void ImGui::Shutdown() g.TablesTempData.clear_destruct(); g.DrawChannelsTempMergeBuffer.clear(); + g.MultiSelectStorage.Clear(); + g.MultiSelectTempData.clear_destruct(); + g.ClipboardHandlerData.clear(); g.MenusIdSubmittedThisFrame.clear(); g.InputTextState.ClearFreeMemory(); @@ -3873,6 +3944,7 @@ static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) if (window) { g.FontSize = g.DrawListSharedData.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize(); + g.FontScale = g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize; ImGui::NavUpdateCurrentWindowIsScrollPushableX(); } } @@ -3882,6 +3954,8 @@ void ImGui::GcCompactTransientMiscBuffers() ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; g.ItemFlagsStack.clear(); g.GroupStack.clear(); + g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked = 0; + g.MultiSelectTempData.clear_destruct(); TableGcCompactSettings(); } @@ -4006,7 +4080,7 @@ void ImGui::MarkItemEdited(ImGuiID id) // We accept a MarkItemEdited() on drag and drop targets (see https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/1875#issuecomment-978243343) // We accept 'ActiveIdPreviousFrame == id' for InputText() returning an edit after it has been taken ActiveId away (#4714) - IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropActive || g.ActiveId == id || g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == id); + IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropActive || g.ActiveId == id || g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == id || (g.CurrentMultiSelect != NULL && g.BoxSelectState.IsActive)); //IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId == id); g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Edited; @@ -4170,7 +4244,7 @@ bool ImGui::ItemHoverable(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiItemFlags item_flag // Done with rectangle culling so we can perform heavier checks now. if (!(item_flags & ImGuiItemFlags_NoWindowHoverableCheck) && !IsWindowContentHoverable(window, ImGuiHoveredFlags_None)) { - g.HoveredIdDisabled = true; + g.HoveredIdIsDisabled = true; return false; } @@ -4194,6 +4268,7 @@ bool ImGui::ItemHoverable(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiItemFlags item_flag } // Display shortcut (only works with mouse) + // (ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasShortcut in LastItemData denotes we want a tooltip) if (id == g.LastItemData.ID && (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasShortcut)) if (IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_ForTooltip | ImGuiHoveredFlags_DelayNormal)) SetTooltip("%s", GetKeyChordName(g.LastItemData.Shortcut)); @@ -4205,7 +4280,7 @@ bool ImGui::ItemHoverable(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiItemFlags item_flag // Release active id if turning disabled if (g.ActiveId == id && id != 0) ClearActiveID(); - g.HoveredIdDisabled = true; + g.HoveredIdIsDisabled = true; return false; } @@ -4237,7 +4312,7 @@ bool ImGui::IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id) ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; if (!bb.Overlaps(window->ClipRect)) if (id == 0 || (id != g.ActiveId && id != g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame && id != g.NavId && id != g.NavActivateId)) - if (!g.LogEnabled) + if (!g.ItemUnclipByLog) return true; return false; } @@ -4508,7 +4583,7 @@ void ImGui::UpdateMouseMovingWindowEndFrame() g.MovingWindow = NULL; // Cancel moving if clicked over an item which was disabled or inhibited by popups (note that we know HoveredId == 0 already) - if (g.HoveredIdDisabled) + if (g.HoveredIdIsDisabled) g.MovingWindow = NULL; } else if (root_window == NULL && g.NavWindow != NULL) @@ -4552,13 +4627,14 @@ void ImGui::UpdateHoveredWindowAndCaptureFlags() // - We also support the moved window toggling the NoInputs flag after moving has started in order to be able to detect windows below it, which is useful for e.g. docking mechanisms. bool clear_hovered_windows = false; FindHoveredWindowEx(g.IO.MousePos, false, &g.HoveredWindow, &g.HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow); + g.HoveredWindowBeforeClear = g.HoveredWindow; // Modal windows prevents mouse from hovering behind them. ImGuiWindow* modal_window = GetTopMostPopupModal(); if (modal_window && g.HoveredWindow && !IsWindowWithinBeginStackOf(g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow, modal_window)) clear_hovered_windows = true; - // Disabled mouse? + // Disabled mouse hovering (we don't currently clear MousePos, we could) if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse) clear_hovered_windows = true; @@ -4576,7 +4652,7 @@ void ImGui::UpdateHoveredWindowAndCaptureFlags() io.MouseDownOwnedUnlessPopupClose[i] = (g.HoveredWindow != NULL) || has_open_modal; } mouse_any_down |= io.MouseDown[i]; - if (io.MouseDown[i]) + if (io.MouseDown[i] || io.MouseReleased[i]) // Increase release frame for our evaluation of earliest button (#1392) if (mouse_earliest_down == -1 || io.MouseClickedTime[i] < io.MouseClickedTime[mouse_earliest_down]) mouse_earliest_down = i; } @@ -4702,7 +4778,7 @@ void ImGui::NewFrame() g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame = g.HoveredId; g.HoveredId = 0; g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; - g.HoveredIdDisabled = false; + g.HoveredIdIsDisabled = false; // Clear ActiveID if the item is not alive anymore. // In 1.87, the common most call to KeepAliveID() was moved from GetID() to ItemAdd(). @@ -4863,7 +4939,8 @@ void ImGui::NewFrame() g.CurrentWindowStack.resize(0); g.BeginPopupStack.resize(0); g.ItemFlagsStack.resize(0); - g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(ImGuiItemFlags_None); + g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups); // Default flags + g.CurrentItemFlags = g.ItemFlagsStack.back(); g.GroupStack.resize(0); // [DEBUG] Update debug features @@ -5112,11 +5189,11 @@ void ImGui::EndFrame() // Notify Platform/OS when our Input Method Editor cursor has moved (e.g. CJK inputs using Microsoft IME) ImGuiPlatformImeData* ime_data = &g.PlatformImeData; - if (g.IO.SetPlatformImeDataFn && memcmp(ime_data, &g.PlatformImeDataPrev, sizeof(ImGuiPlatformImeData)) != 0) + if (g.IO.PlatformSetImeDataFn != NULL && memcmp(ime_data, &g.PlatformImeDataPrev, sizeof(ImGuiPlatformImeData)) != 0) { - IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_IO("[io] Calling io.SetPlatformImeDataFn(): WantVisible: %d, InputPos (%.2f,%.2f)\n", ime_data->WantVisible, ime_data->InputPos.x, ime_data->InputPos.y); + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_IO("[io] Calling io.PlatformSetImeDataFn(): WantVisible: %d, InputPos (%.2f,%.2f)\n", ime_data->WantVisible, ime_data->InputPos.x, ime_data->InputPos.y); ImGuiViewport* viewport = GetMainViewport(); - g.IO.SetPlatformImeDataFn(viewport, ime_data); + g.IO.PlatformSetImeDataFn(&g, viewport, ime_data); } // Hide implicit/fallback "Debug" window if it hasn't been used @@ -5132,12 +5209,16 @@ void ImGui::EndFrame() if (g.DragDropActive) { bool is_delivered = g.DragDropPayload.Delivery; - bool is_elapsed = (g.DragDropPayload.DataFrameCount + 1 < g.FrameCount) && ((g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload) || !IsMouseDown(g.DragDropMouseButton)); + bool is_elapsed = (g.DragDropSourceFrameCount + 1 < g.FrameCount) && ((g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadAutoExpire) || g.DragDropMouseButton == -1 || !IsMouseDown(g.DragDropMouseButton)); if (is_delivered || is_elapsed) ClearDragDrop(); } - // Drag and Drop: Fallback for source tooltip. This is not ideal but better than nothing. + // Drag and Drop: Fallback for missing source tooltip. This is not ideal but better than nothing. + // If you want to handle source item disappearing: instead of submitting your description tooltip + // in the BeginDragDropSource() block of the dragged item, you can submit them from a safe single spot + // (e.g. end of your item loop, or before EndFrame) by reading payload data. + // In the typical case, the contents of drag tooltip should be possible to infer solely from payload data. if (g.DragDropActive && g.DragDropSourceFrameCount < g.FrameCount && !(g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoPreviewTooltip)) { g.DragDropWithinSource = true; @@ -5393,9 +5474,15 @@ bool ImGui::IsItemToggledOpen() return (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledOpen) ? true : false; } +// Call after a Selectable() or TreeNode() involved in multi-selection. +// Useful if you need the per-item information before reaching EndMultiSelect(), e.g. for rendering purpose. +// This is only meant to be called inside a BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() block. +// (Outside of multi-select, it would be misleading/ambiguous to report this signal, as widgets +// return e.g. a pressed event and user code is in charge of altering selection in ways we cannot predict.) bool ImGui::IsItemToggledSelection() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentMultiSelect != NULL); // Can only be used inside a BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() return (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection) ? true : false; } @@ -5455,7 +5542,8 @@ void ImGui::SetItemAllowOverlap() } #endif -// FIXME: It might be undesirable that this will likely disable KeyOwner-aware shortcuts systems. Consider a more fine-tuned version for the two users of this function. +// This is a shortcut for not taking ownership of 100+ keys, frequently used by drag operations. +// FIXME: It might be undesirable that this will likely disable KeyOwner-aware shortcuts systems. Consider a more fine-tuned version if needed? void ImGui::SetActiveIdUsingAllKeyboardKeys() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; @@ -5509,7 +5597,7 @@ bool ImGui::BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, I IM_ASSERT(id != 0); // Sanity check as it is likely that some user will accidentally pass ImGuiWindowFlags into the ImGuiChildFlags argument. - const ImGuiChildFlags ImGuiChildFlags_SupportedMask_ = ImGuiChildFlags_Border | ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeX | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY | ImGuiChildFlags_AutoResizeX | ImGuiChildFlags_AutoResizeY | ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle; + const ImGuiChildFlags ImGuiChildFlags_SupportedMask_ = ImGuiChildFlags_Border | ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeX | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY | ImGuiChildFlags_AutoResizeX | ImGuiChildFlags_AutoResizeY | ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle | ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened; IM_UNUSED(ImGuiChildFlags_SupportedMask_); IM_ASSERT((child_flags & ~ImGuiChildFlags_SupportedMask_) == 0 && "Illegal ImGuiChildFlags value. Did you pass ImGuiWindowFlags values instead of ImGuiChildFlags?"); IM_ASSERT((window_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) == 0 && "Cannot specify ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize for BeginChild(). Use ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysAutoResize!"); @@ -5521,6 +5609,8 @@ bool ImGui::BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, I #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS if (window_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding) child_flags |= ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding; + if (window_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) + child_flags |= ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened; #endif if (child_flags & ImGuiChildFlags_AutoResizeX) child_flags &= ~ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeX; @@ -5599,7 +5689,7 @@ bool ImGui::BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, I const ImGuiID temp_id_for_activation = ImHashStr("##Child", 0, id); if (g.ActiveId == temp_id_for_activation) ClearActiveID(); - if (g.NavActivateId == id && !(window_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) && (child_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask != 0 || child_window->DC.NavWindowHasScrollY)) + if (g.NavActivateId == id && !(child_flags & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened) && (child_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask != 0 || child_window->DC.NavWindowHasScrollY)) { FocusWindow(child_window); NavInitWindow(child_window, false); @@ -5625,7 +5715,8 @@ void ImGui::EndChild() ImGuiWindow* parent_window = g.CurrentWindow; ImRect bb(parent_window->DC.CursorPos, parent_window->DC.CursorPos + child_size); ItemSize(child_size); - if ((child_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask != 0 || child_window->DC.NavWindowHasScrollY) && !(child_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened)) + const bool nav_flattened = (child_window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened) != 0; + if ((child_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask != 0 || child_window->DC.NavWindowHasScrollY) && !nav_flattened) { ItemAdd(bb, child_window->ChildId); RenderNavHighlight(bb, child_window->ChildId); @@ -5642,7 +5733,7 @@ void ImGui::EndChild() ItemAdd(bb, child_window->ChildId, NULL, ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav); // But when flattened we directly reach items, adjust active layer mask accordingly - if (child_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) + if (nav_flattened) parent_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext |= child_window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext; } if (g.HoveredWindow == child_window) @@ -6111,12 +6202,13 @@ static int ImGui::UpdateWindowManualResize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& si border_target = ImClamp(border_target, clamp_min, clamp_max); if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) // Clamp resizing of childs within parent { - ImGuiWindowFlags parent_flags = window->ParentWindow->Flags; - ImRect border_limit_rect = window->ParentWindow->InnerRect; - border_limit_rect.Expand(ImVec2(-ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x, window->WindowBorderSize), -ImMax(window->WindowPadding.y, window->WindowBorderSize))); - if ((parent_flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar)) == 0 || (parent_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)) + ImGuiWindow* parent_window = window->ParentWindow; + ImGuiWindowFlags parent_flags = parent_window->Flags; + ImRect border_limit_rect = parent_window->InnerRect; + border_limit_rect.Expand(ImVec2(-ImMax(parent_window->WindowPadding.x, parent_window->WindowBorderSize), -ImMax(parent_window->WindowPadding.y, parent_window->WindowBorderSize))); + if ((axis == ImGuiAxis_X) && ((parent_flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar)) == 0 || (parent_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar))) border_target.x = ImClamp(border_target.x, border_limit_rect.Min.x, border_limit_rect.Max.x); - if (parent_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) + if ((axis == ImGuiAxis_Y) && (parent_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)) border_target.y = ImClamp(border_target.y, border_limit_rect.Min.y, border_limit_rect.Max.y); } if (!ignore_resize) @@ -6416,7 +6508,7 @@ void ImGui::UpdateWindowParentAndRootLinks(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiWindowFlags window->RootWindowPopupTree = parent_window->RootWindowPopupTree; if (parent_window && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) && (flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))) window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight = parent_window->RootWindowForTitleBarHighlight; - while (window->RootWindowForNav->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) + while (window->RootWindowForNav->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened) { IM_ASSERT(window->RootWindowForNav->ParentWindow != NULL); window->RootWindowForNav = window->RootWindowForNav->ParentWindow; @@ -6512,9 +6604,6 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs) == ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs) flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize; - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) - IM_ASSERT(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow); - const int current_frame = g.FrameCount; const bool first_begin_of_the_frame = (window->LastFrameActive != current_frame); window->IsFallbackWindow = (g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 0 && g.WithinFrameScopeWithImplicitWindow); @@ -6562,6 +6651,7 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) window_stack_data.Window = window; window_stack_data.ParentLastItemDataBackup = g.LastItemData; window_stack_data.StackSizesOnBegin.SetToContextState(&g); + window_stack_data.DisabledOverrideReenable = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) && (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled); g.CurrentWindowStack.push_back(window_stack_data); if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) g.BeginMenuDepth++; @@ -6578,7 +6668,7 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) } // Add to focus scope stack - PushFocusScope((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) ? g.CurrentFocusScopeId : window->ID); + PushFocusScope((window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened) ? g.CurrentFocusScopeId : window->ID); window->NavRootFocusScopeId = g.CurrentFocusScopeId; // Add to popup stacks: update OpenPopupStack[] data, push to BeginPopupStack[] @@ -6648,6 +6738,10 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) // [EXPERIMENTAL] Skip Refresh mode UpdateWindowSkipRefresh(window); + // Nested root windows (typically tooltips) override disabled state + if (window_stack_data.DisabledOverrideReenable && window->RootWindow == window) + BeginDisabledOverrideReenable(); + // We intentionally set g.CurrentWindow to NULL to prevent usage until when the viewport is set, then will call SetCurrentWindow() g.CurrentWindow = NULL; @@ -6921,7 +7015,7 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) window->ScrollbarY = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar) || ((needed_size_from_last_frame.y > size_y_for_scrollbars) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)); window->ScrollbarX = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar) || ((needed_size_from_last_frame.x > size_x_for_scrollbars - (window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f)) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar)); if (window->ScrollbarX && !window->ScrollbarY) - window->ScrollbarY = (needed_size_from_last_frame.y > size_y_for_scrollbars) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar); + window->ScrollbarY = (needed_size_from_last_frame.y > size_y_for_scrollbars - style.ScrollbarSize) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar); window->ScrollbarSizes = ImVec2(window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f, window->ScrollbarX ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f); // Amend the partially filled window->DecorationXXX values. @@ -7082,7 +7176,7 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false; window->DC.MenuColumns.Update(style.ItemSpacing.x, window_just_activated_by_user); window->DC.TreeDepth = 0; - window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask = 0x00; + window->DC.TreeHasStackDataDepthMask = 0x00; window->DC.ChildWindows.resize(0); window->DC.StateStorage = &window->StateStorage; window->DC.CurrentColumns = NULL; @@ -7170,7 +7264,7 @@ bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) // Child window can be out of sight and have "negative" clip windows. // Mark them as collapsed so commands are skipped earlier (we can't manually collapse them because they have no title bar). IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) != 0); - const bool nav_request = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened) && (g.NavAnyRequest && g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->RootWindowForNav == window->RootWindowForNav); + const bool nav_request = (window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened) && (g.NavAnyRequest && g.NavWindow && g.NavWindow->RootWindowForNav == window->RootWindowForNav); if (!g.LogEnabled && !nav_request) if (window->OuterRectClipped.Min.x >= window->OuterRectClipped.Max.x || window->OuterRectClipped.Min.y >= window->OuterRectClipped.Max.y) { @@ -7247,7 +7341,7 @@ void ImGui::End() IM_ASSERT_USER_ERROR(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 1, "Calling End() too many times!"); return; } - IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size > 0); + ImGuiWindowStackData& window_stack_data = g.CurrentWindowStack.back(); // Error checking: verify that user doesn't directly call End() on a child window. if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) @@ -7259,6 +7353,8 @@ void ImGui::End() if (!window->SkipRefresh) PopClipRect(); // Inner window clip rectangle PopFocusScope(); + if (window_stack_data.DisabledOverrideReenable && window->RootWindow == window) + EndDisabledOverrideReenable(); if (window->SkipRefresh) { @@ -7274,12 +7370,12 @@ void ImGui::End() ErrorCheckUsingSetCursorPosToExtendParentBoundaries(); // Pop from window stack - g.LastItemData = g.CurrentWindowStack.back().ParentLastItemDataBackup; + g.LastItemData = window_stack_data.ParentLastItemDataBackup; if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) g.BeginMenuDepth--; if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) g.BeginPopupStack.pop_back(); - g.CurrentWindowStack.back().StackSizesOnBegin.CompareWithContextState(&g); + window_stack_data.StackSizesOnBegin.CompareWithContextState(&g); g.CurrentWindowStack.pop_back(); SetCurrentWindow(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 0 ? NULL : g.CurrentWindowStack.back().Window); } @@ -7371,9 +7467,13 @@ void ImGui::FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiFocusRequestFlags flags) if ((flags & ImGuiFocusRequestFlags_UnlessBelowModal) && (g.NavWindow != window)) // Early out in common case. if (ImGuiWindow* blocking_modal = FindBlockingModal(window)) { + // This block would typically be reached in two situations: + // - API call to FocusWindow() with a window under a modal and ImGuiFocusRequestFlags_UnlessBelowModal flag. + // - User clicking on void or anything behind a modal while a modal is open (window == NULL) IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_FOCUS("[focus] FocusWindow(\"%s\", UnlessBelowModal): prevented by \"%s\".\n", window ? window->Name : "", blocking_modal->Name); if (window && window == window->RootWindow && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus) == 0) - BringWindowToDisplayBehind(window, blocking_modal); // Still bring to right below modal. + BringWindowToDisplayBehind(window, blocking_modal); // Still bring right under modal. (FIXME: Could move in focus list too?) + ClosePopupsOverWindow(GetTopMostPopupModal(), false); // Note how we need to use GetTopMostPopupModal() aad NOT blocking_modal, to handle nested modals return; } @@ -7459,12 +7559,14 @@ void ImGui::SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font) g.Font = font; g.FontBaseSize = ImMax(1.0f, g.IO.FontGlobalScale * g.Font->FontSize * g.Font->Scale); g.FontSize = g.CurrentWindow ? g.CurrentWindow->CalcFontSize() : 0.0f; + g.FontScale = g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize; ImFontAtlas* atlas = g.Font->ContainerAtlas; g.DrawListSharedData.TexUvWhitePixel = atlas->TexUvWhitePixel; g.DrawListSharedData.TexUvLines = atlas->TexUvLines; g.DrawListSharedData.Font = g.Font; g.DrawListSharedData.FontSize = g.FontSize; + g.DrawListSharedData.FontScale = g.FontScale; } void ImGui::PushFont(ImFont* font) @@ -7523,7 +7625,7 @@ void ImGui::BeginDisabled(bool disabled) } if (was_disabled || disabled) g.CurrentItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled; - g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(g.CurrentItemFlags); + g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(g.CurrentItemFlags); // FIXME-OPT: can we simply skip this and use DisabledStackSize? g.DisabledStackSize++; } @@ -7540,24 +7642,27 @@ void ImGui::EndDisabled() g.Style.Alpha = g.DisabledAlphaBackup; //PopStyleVar(); } -void ImGui::PushTabStop(bool tab_stop) -{ - PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, !tab_stop); -} - -void ImGui::PopTabStop() +// Could have been called BeginDisabledDisable() but it didn't want to be award nominated for most awkward function name. +// Ideally we would use a shared e.g. BeginDisabled()->BeginDisabledEx() but earlier needs to be optimal. +// The whole code for this is awkward, will reevaluate if we find a way to implement SetNextItemDisabled(). +void ImGui::BeginDisabledOverrideReenable() { - PopItemFlag(); -} - -void ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat) -{ - PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, repeat); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled); + g.Style.Alpha = g.DisabledAlphaBackup; + g.CurrentItemFlags &= ~ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled; + g.ItemFlagsStack.push_back(g.CurrentItemFlags); + g.DisabledStackSize++; } -void ImGui::PopButtonRepeat() +void ImGui::EndDisabledOverrideReenable() { - PopItemFlag(); + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.DisabledStackSize--; + IM_ASSERT(g.DisabledStackSize > 0); + g.ItemFlagsStack.pop_back(); + g.CurrentItemFlags = g.ItemFlagsStack.back(); + g.Style.Alpha = g.DisabledAlphaBackup * g.Style.DisabledAlpha; } void ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(float wrap_pos_x) @@ -7986,6 +8091,7 @@ void ImGui::SetWindowFontScale(float scale) ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); window->FontWindowScale = scale; g.FontSize = g.DrawListSharedData.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize(); + g.FontScale = g.DrawListSharedData.FontScale = g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize; } void ImGui::PushFocusScope(ImGuiID id) @@ -8870,7 +8976,7 @@ bool ImGui::IsMouseDown(ImGuiMouseButton button, ImGuiID owner_id) bool ImGui::IsMouseClicked(ImGuiMouseButton button, bool repeat) { - return IsMouseClicked(button, ImGuiKeyOwner_Any, repeat ? ImGuiInputFlags_Repeat : ImGuiInputFlags_None); + return IsMouseClicked(button, repeat ? ImGuiInputFlags_Repeat : ImGuiInputFlags_None, ImGuiKeyOwner_Any); } bool ImGui::IsMouseClicked(ImGuiMouseButton button, ImGuiInputFlags flags, ImGuiID owner_id) @@ -9079,6 +9185,9 @@ static void ImGui::UpdateKeyboardInputs() ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoKeyboard) + io.ClearInputKeys(); + // Import legacy keys or verify they are not used #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_KEYIO if (io.BackendUsingLegacyKeyArrays == 0) @@ -9525,6 +9634,8 @@ void ImGui::UpdateInputEvents(bool trickle_fast_inputs) else if (e->Type == ImGuiInputEventType_Key) { // Trickling Rule: Stop processing queued events if we got multiple action on the same button + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoKeyboard) + continue; ImGuiKey key = e->Key.Key; IM_ASSERT(key != ImGuiKey_None); ImGuiKeyData* key_data = GetKeyData(key); @@ -9545,6 +9656,8 @@ void ImGui::UpdateInputEvents(bool trickle_fast_inputs) } else if (e->Type == ImGuiInputEventType_Text) { + if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoKeyboard) + continue; // Trickling Rule: Stop processing queued events if keys/mouse have been interacted with if (trickle_fast_inputs && ((key_changed && trickle_interleaved_keys_and_text) || mouse_button_changed != 0 || mouse_moved || mouse_wheeled)) break; @@ -9589,7 +9702,10 @@ void ImGui::UpdateInputEvents(bool trickle_fast_inputs) // - we clear in EndFrame() and not now in order allow application/user code polling this flag // (e.g. custom backend may want to clear additional data, custom widgets may want to react with a "canceling" event). if (g.IO.AppFocusLost) + { g.IO.ClearInputKeys(); + g.IO.ClearInputMouse(); + } } ImGuiID ImGui::GetKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key) @@ -9692,10 +9808,15 @@ void ImGui::SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key, ImGuiInputFlags flags) } } +void ImGui::SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key) +{ + SetItemKeyOwner(key, ImGuiInputFlags_None); +} + // This is the only public API until we expose owner_id versions of the API as replacements. bool ImGui::IsKeyChordPressed(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord) { - return IsKeyChordPressed(key_chord, 0, ImGuiInputFlags_None); + return IsKeyChordPressed(key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags_None, ImGuiKeyOwner_Any); } // This is equivalent to comparing KeyMods + doing a IsKeyPressed() @@ -9724,12 +9845,15 @@ void ImGui::SetNextItemShortcut(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags flags) g.NextItemData.ShortcutFlags = flags; } +// Called from within ItemAdd: at this point we can read from NextItemData and write to LastItemData void ImGui::ItemHandleShortcut(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; ImGuiInputFlags flags = g.NextItemData.ShortcutFlags; IM_ASSERT((flags & ~ImGuiInputFlags_SupportedBySetNextItemShortcut) == 0); // Passing flags not supported by SetNextItemShortcut()! + if (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) + return; if (flags & ImGuiInputFlags_Tooltip) { g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasShortcut; @@ -9753,7 +9877,7 @@ bool ImGui::Shortcut(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags flags) bool ImGui::Shortcut(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags flags, ImGuiID owner_id) { - //ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("Shortcut(%s, flags=%X, owner_id=0x%08X)\n", GetKeyChordName(key_chord, g.TempBuffer.Data, g.TempBuffer.Size), flags, owner_id); // When using (owner_id == 0/Any): SetShortcutRouting() will use CurrentFocusScopeId and filter with this, so IsKeyPressed() is fine with he 0/Any. @@ -9765,6 +9889,9 @@ bool ImGui::Shortcut(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags flags, ImGuiID own if (owner_id == ImGuiKeyOwner_Any || owner_id == ImGuiKeyOwner_NoOwner) owner_id = GetRoutingIdFromOwnerId(owner_id); + if (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) + return false; + // Submit route if (!SetShortcutRouting(key_chord, flags, owner_id)) return false; @@ -9884,10 +10011,6 @@ static void ImGui::ErrorCheckNewFrameSanityChecks() if ((g.IO.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableKeyboard) && g.IO.BackendUsingLegacyKeyArrays == 1) IM_ASSERT(g.IO.KeyMap[ImGuiKey_Space] != -1 && "ImGuiKey_Space is not mapped, required for keyboard navigation."); #endif - - // Check: the io.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges option requires backend to honor mouse cursor changes and set the ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors flag accordingly. - if (g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges && !(g.IO.BackendFlags & ImGuiBackendFlags_HasMouseCursors)) - g.IO.ConfigWindowsResizeFromEdges = false; } static void ImGui::ErrorCheckEndFrameSanityChecks() @@ -9977,6 +10100,11 @@ void ImGui::ErrorCheckEndWindowRecover(ImGuiErrorLogCallback log_callback, vo if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndTabBar() in '%s'", window->Name); EndTabBar(); } + while (g.CurrentMultiSelect != NULL && g.CurrentMultiSelect->Storage->Window == window) + { + if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndMultiSelect() in '%s'", window->Name); + EndMultiSelect(); + } while (window->DC.TreeDepth > 0) { if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing TreePop() in '%s'", window->Name); @@ -9995,7 +10123,13 @@ void ImGui::ErrorCheckEndWindowRecover(ImGuiErrorLogCallback log_callback, vo while (g.DisabledStackSize > stack_sizes->SizeOfDisabledStack) //-V1044 { if (log_callback) log_callback(user_data, "Recovered from missing EndDisabled() in '%s'", window->Name); - EndDisabled(); + if (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) + EndDisabled(); + else + { + EndDisabledOverrideReenable(); + g.CurrentWindowStack.back().DisabledOverrideReenable = false; + } } while (g.ColorStack.Size > stack_sizes->SizeOfColorStack) { @@ -10084,6 +10218,7 @@ void ImGui::KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id) // Note that the size can be different than the one provided to ItemSize(). Typically, widgets that spread over available surface // declare their minimum size requirement to ItemSize() and provide a larger region to ItemAdd() which is used drawing/interaction. // THIS IS IN THE PERFORMANCE CRITICAL PATH (UNTIL THE CLIPPING TEST AND EARLY-RETURN) +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb_arg, ImGuiItemFlags extra_flags) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; @@ -10118,7 +10253,7 @@ bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb_arg, ImGu window->DC.NavLayersActiveMaskNext |= (1 << window->DC.NavLayerCurrent); if (g.NavId == id || g.NavAnyRequest) if (g.NavWindow->RootWindowForNav == window->RootWindowForNav) - if (window == g.NavWindow || ((window->Flags | g.NavWindow->Flags) & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened)) + if (window == g.NavWindow || ((window->ChildFlags | g.NavWindow->ChildFlags) & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened)) NavProcessItem(); } @@ -10136,15 +10271,12 @@ bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb_arg, ImGu #endif // Clipping test - // (this is a modified copy of IsClippedEx() so we can reuse the is_rect_visible value) - //const bool is_clipped = IsClippedEx(bb, id); - //if (is_clipped) - // return false; + // (this is an inline copy of IsClippedEx() so we can reuse the is_rect_visible value, otherwise we'd do 'if (IsClippedEx(bb, id)) return false') // g.NavActivateId is not necessarily == g.NavId, in the case of remote activation (e.g. shortcuts) const bool is_rect_visible = bb.Overlaps(window->ClipRect); if (!is_rect_visible) if (id == 0 || (id != g.ActiveId && id != g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame && id != g.NavId && id != g.NavActivateId)) - if (!g.LogEnabled) + if (!g.ItemUnclipByLog) return false; // [DEBUG] @@ -10171,7 +10303,7 @@ bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb_arg, ImGu g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect; return true; } - +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] LAYOUT @@ -10208,6 +10340,7 @@ bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const ImRect* nav_bb_arg, ImGu // Register minimum needed size so it can extend the bounding box used for auto-fit calculation. // See comments in ItemAdd() about how/why the size provided to ItemSize() vs ItemAdd() may often different. // THIS IS IN THE PERFORMANCE CRITICAL PATH. +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_baseline_y) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; @@ -10243,6 +10376,7 @@ void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_baseline_y) if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) SameLine(); } +IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE // Gets back to previous line and continue with horizontal layout // offset_from_start_x == 0 : follow right after previous item @@ -10552,11 +10686,11 @@ void ImGui::EndGroup() if (window->DC.IsSetPos) ErrorCheckUsingSetCursorPosToExtendParentBoundaries(); - ImRect group_bb(group_data.BackupCursorPos, ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, group_data.BackupCursorPos)); - + // Include LastItemData.Rect.Max as a workaround for e.g. EndTable() undershooting with CursorMaxPos report. (#7543) + ImRect group_bb(group_data.BackupCursorPos, ImMax(ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, g.LastItemData.Rect.Max), group_data.BackupCursorPos)); window->DC.CursorPos = group_data.BackupCursorPos; window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = group_data.BackupCursorPosPrevLine; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos); + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos, group_bb.Max); window->DC.Indent = group_data.BackupIndent; window->DC.GroupOffset = group_data.BackupGroupOffset; window->DC.CurrLineSize = group_data.BackupCurrLineSize; @@ -10571,7 +10705,7 @@ void ImGui::EndGroup() return; } - window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset, group_data.BackupCurrLineTextBaseOffset); // FIXME: Incorrect, we should grab the base offset from the *first line* of the group but it is hard to obtain now. + window->DC.CurrLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset, group_data.BackupCurrLineTextBaseOffset); // FIXME: Incorrect, we should grab the base offset from the *first line* of the group but it is hard to obtain now. ItemSize(group_bb.GetSize()); ItemAdd(group_bb, 0, NULL, ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop); @@ -11196,8 +11330,8 @@ void ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup() window->DC.NavHideHighlightOneFrame = true; } -// Attention! BeginPopup() adds default flags which BeginPopupEx()! -bool ImGui::BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) +// Attention! BeginPopup() adds default flags when calling BeginPopupEx()! +bool ImGui::BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_window_flags) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; if (!IsPopupOpen(id, ImGuiPopupFlags_None)) @@ -11207,13 +11341,12 @@ bool ImGui::BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) } char name[20]; - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) + if (extra_window_flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##Menu_%02d", g.BeginMenuDepth); // Recycle windows based on depth else ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##Popup_%08x", id); // Not recycling, so we can close/open during the same frame - flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup; - bool is_open = Begin(name, NULL, flags); + bool is_open = Begin(name, NULL, extra_window_flags | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup); if (!is_open) // NB: Begin can return false when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) EndPopup(); @@ -11609,7 +11742,7 @@ static bool ImGui::NavScoreItem(ImGuiNavItemData* result) // When entering through a NavFlattened border, we consider child window items as fully clipped for scoring if (window->ParentWindow == g.NavWindow) { - IM_ASSERT((window->Flags | g.NavWindow->Flags) & ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened); + IM_ASSERT((window->ChildFlags | g.NavWindow->ChildFlags) & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened); if (!window->ClipRect.Overlaps(cand)) return false; cand.ClipWithFull(window->ClipRect); // This allows the scored item to not overlap other candidates in the parent window @@ -11634,6 +11767,9 @@ static bool ImGui::NavScoreItem(ImGuiNavItemData* result) if (dbx != 0.0f || dby != 0.0f) { // For non-overlapping boxes, use distance between boxes + // FIXME-NAV: Quadrant may be incorrect because of (1) dbx bias and (2) curr.Max.y bias applied by NavBiasScoringRect() where typically curr.Max.y==curr.Min.y + // One typical case where this happens, with style.WindowMenuButtonPosition == ImGuiDir_Right, pressing Left to navigate from Close to Collapse tends to fail. + // Also see #6344. Calling ImGetDirQuadrantFromDelta() with unbiased values may be good but side-effects are plenty. dax = dbx; day = dby; dist_axial = dist_box; @@ -11912,6 +12048,7 @@ void ImGui::NavMoveRequestSubmit(ImGuiDir move_dir, ImGuiDir clip_dir, ImGuiNavM { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; IM_ASSERT(g.NavWindow != NULL); + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavMoveRequestSubmit: dir %c, window \"%s\"\n", "-WENS"[move_dir + 1], g.NavWindow->Name); if (move_flags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_IsTabbing) move_flags |= ImGuiNavMoveFlags_AllowCurrentNavId; @@ -11941,7 +12078,7 @@ void ImGui::NavMoveRequestResolveWithLastItem(ImGuiNavItemData* result) } // Called by TreePop() to implement ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere -void ImGui::NavMoveRequestResolveWithPastTreeNode(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImGuiNavTreeNodeData* tree_node_data) +void ImGui::NavMoveRequestResolveWithPastTreeNode(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImGuiTreeNodeStackData* tree_node_data) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; g.NavMoveScoringItems = false; @@ -12160,6 +12297,7 @@ static void ImGui::NavUpdate() // Process navigation init request (select first/default focus) g.NavJustMovedToId = 0; + g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = g.NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId = 0; if (g.NavInitResult.ID != 0) NavInitRequestApplyResult(); g.NavInitRequest = false; @@ -12312,9 +12450,12 @@ void ImGui::NavInitRequestApplyResult() ImGuiNavItemData* result = &g.NavInitResult; if (g.NavId != result->ID) { + g.NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId = g.NavFocusScopeId; g.NavJustMovedToId = result->ID; g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = result->FocusScopeId; g.NavJustMovedToKeyMods = 0; + g.NavJustMovedToIsTabbing = false; + g.NavJustMovedToHasSelectionData = (result->InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData) != 0; } // Apply result from previous navigation init request (will typically select the first item, unless SetItemDefaultFocus() has been called) @@ -12568,9 +12709,13 @@ void ImGui::NavMoveRequestApplyResult() // PageUp/PageDown however sets always set NavJustMovedTo (vs Home/End which doesn't) mimicking Windows behavior. if ((g.NavId != result->ID || (g.NavMoveFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_IsPageMove)) && (g.NavMoveFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_NoSelect) == 0) { + g.NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId = g.NavFocusScopeId; g.NavJustMovedToId = result->ID; g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = result->FocusScopeId; g.NavJustMovedToKeyMods = g.NavMoveKeyMods; + g.NavJustMovedToIsTabbing = (g.NavMoveFlags & ImGuiNavMoveFlags_IsTabbing) != 0; + g.NavJustMovedToHasSelectionData = (result->InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData) != 0; + //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_NAV("[nav] NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId = 0x%08X, NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = 0x%08X\n", g.NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId, g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId); } // Apply new NavID/Focus @@ -13067,6 +13212,8 @@ void ImGui::NavUpdateWindowingOverlay() SetNextWindowPos(viewport->GetCenter(), ImGuiCond_Always, ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f)); PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, g.Style.WindowPadding * 2.0f); Begin("###NavWindowingList", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings); + if (g.ContextName[0] != 0) + SeparatorText(g.ContextName); for (int n = g.WindowsFocusOrder.Size - 1; n >= 0; n--) { ImGuiWindow* window = g.WindowsFocusOrder[n]; @@ -13192,9 +13339,13 @@ bool ImGui::BeginDragDropSource(ImGuiDragDropFlags flags) } else { + // When ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern is set: window = NULL; source_id = ImHashStr("#SourceExtern"); source_drag_active = true; + mouse_button = g.IO.MouseDown[0] ? 0 : -1; + KeepAliveID(source_id); + SetActiveID(source_id, NULL); } IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropWithinTarget == false); // Can't nest BeginDragDropSource() and BeginDragDropTarget() @@ -13206,7 +13357,8 @@ bool ImGui::BeginDragDropSource(ImGuiDragDropFlags flags) { IM_ASSERT(source_id != 0); ClearDragDrop(); - IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_ACTIVEID("[dragdrop] BeginDragDropSource() DragDropActive = true, source_id = %08X\n", source_id); + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_ACTIVEID("[dragdrop] BeginDragDropSource() DragDropActive = true, source_id = 0x%08X%s\n", + source_id, (flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern) ? " (EXTERN)" : ""); ImGuiPayload& payload = g.DragDropPayload; payload.SourceId = source_id; payload.SourceParentId = source_parent_id; @@ -13265,7 +13417,7 @@ bool ImGui::SetDragDropPayload(const char* type, const void* data, size_t data_s IM_ASSERT(strlen(type) < IM_ARRAYSIZE(payload.DataType) && "Payload type can be at most 32 characters long"); IM_ASSERT((data != NULL && data_size > 0) || (data == NULL && data_size == 0)); IM_ASSERT(cond == ImGuiCond_Always || cond == ImGuiCond_Once); - IM_ASSERT(payload.SourceId != 0); // Not called between BeginDragDropSource() and EndDragDropSource() + IM_ASSERT(payload.SourceId != 0); // Not called between BeginDragDropSource() and EndDragDropSource() if (cond == ImGuiCond_Always || payload.DataFrameCount == -1) { @@ -13316,7 +13468,7 @@ bool ImGui::BeginDragDropTargetCustom(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id) IM_ASSERT(g.DragDropWithinTarget == false && g.DragDropWithinSource == false); // Can't nest BeginDragDropSource() and BeginDragDropTarget() g.DragDropTargetRect = bb; - g.DragDropTargetClipRect = window->ClipRect; // May want to be overriden by user depending on use case? + g.DragDropTargetClipRect = window->ClipRect; // May want to be overridden by user depending on use case? g.DragDropTargetId = id; g.DragDropWithinTarget = true; return true; @@ -13392,11 +13544,15 @@ const ImGuiPayload* ImGui::AcceptDragDropPayload(const char* type, ImGuiDragDrop RenderDragDropTargetRect(r, g.DragDropTargetClipRect); g.DragDropAcceptFrameCount = g.FrameCount; - payload.Delivery = was_accepted_previously && !IsMouseDown(g.DragDropMouseButton); // For extern drag sources affecting OS window focus, it's easier to just test !IsMouseDown() instead of IsMouseReleased() + if ((g.DragDropSourceFlags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern) && g.DragDropMouseButton == -1) + payload.Delivery = was_accepted_previously && (g.DragDropSourceFrameCount < g.FrameCount); + else + payload.Delivery = was_accepted_previously && !IsMouseDown(g.DragDropMouseButton); // For extern drag sources affecting OS window focus, it's easier to just test !IsMouseDown() instead of IsMouseReleased() if (!payload.Delivery && !(flags & ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery)) return NULL; - //IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG("AcceptDragDropPayload(): %08X: return payload\n", g.DragDropTargetId); + if (payload.Delivery) + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_ACTIVEID("[dragdrop] AcceptDragDropPayload(): 0x%08X: payload delivery\n", g.DragDropTargetId); return &payload; } @@ -13546,7 +13702,7 @@ void ImGui::LogBegin(ImGuiLogType type, int auto_open_depth) IM_ASSERT(g.LogEnabled == false); IM_ASSERT(g.LogFile == NULL); IM_ASSERT(g.LogBuffer.empty()); - g.LogEnabled = true; + g.LogEnabled = g.ItemUnclipByLog = true; g.LogType = type; g.LogNextPrefix = g.LogNextSuffix = NULL; g.LogDepthRef = window->DC.TreeDepth; @@ -13645,7 +13801,7 @@ void ImGui::LogFinish() break; } - g.LogEnabled = false; + g.LogEnabled = g.ItemUnclipByLog = false; g.LogType = ImGuiLogType_None; g.LogFile = NULL; g.LogBuffer.clear(); @@ -13665,10 +13821,10 @@ void ImGui::LogButtons() #endif const bool log_to_file = Button("Log To File"); SameLine(); const bool log_to_clipboard = Button("Log To Clipboard"); SameLine(); - PushTabStop(false); + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, true); SetNextItemWidth(80.0f); SliderInt("Default Depth", &g.LogDepthToExpandDefault, 0, 9, NULL); - PopTabStop(); + PopItemFlag(); PopID(); // Start logging at the end of the function so that the buttons don't appear in the log @@ -14106,6 +14262,10 @@ static void ImGui::UpdateViewportsNewFrame() //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] PLATFORM DEPENDENT HELPERS //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - Default clipboard handlers +// - Default shell function handlers +// - Default IME handlers +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- #if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS) @@ -14231,8 +14391,62 @@ static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data_ctx, const char* text g.ClipboardHandlerData[(int)(text_end - text)] = 0; } +#endif // Default clipboard handlers + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS +#if defined(__APPLE__) && TARGET_OS_IPHONE +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS #endif +#if defined(_WIN32) && defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) +#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS +#endif +#endif + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS +#ifdef _WIN32 +#include // ShellExecuteA() +#ifdef _MSC_VER +#pragma comment(lib, "shell32") +#endif +static bool PlatformOpenInShellFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext*, const char* path) +{ + return (INT_PTR)::ShellExecuteA(NULL, "open", path, NULL, NULL, SW_SHOWDEFAULT) > 32; +} +#else +#include +#include +static bool PlatformOpenInShellFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext*, const char* path) +{ +#if defined(__APPLE__) + const char* args[] { "open", "--", path, NULL }; +#else + const char* args[] { "xdg-open", path, NULL }; +#endif + pid_t pid = fork(); + if (pid < 0) + return false; + if (!pid) + { + execvp(args[0], const_cast(args)); + exit(-1); + } + else + { + int status; + waitpid(pid, &status, 0); + return WEXITSTATUS(status) == 0; + } +} +#endif +#else +static bool PlatformOpenInShellFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext*, const char*) { return false; } +#endif // Default shell handlers + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + // Win32 API IME support (for Asian languages, etc.) #if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS) @@ -14241,7 +14455,7 @@ static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data_ctx, const char* text #pragma comment(lib, "imm32") #endif -static void SetPlatformImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) +static void PlatformSetImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data) { // Notify OS Input Method Editor of text input position HWND hwnd = (HWND)viewport->PlatformHandleRaw; @@ -14267,9 +14481,9 @@ static void SetPlatformImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatf #else -static void SetPlatformImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeData*) {} +static void PlatformSetImeDataFn_DefaultImpl(ImGuiContext*, ImGuiViewport*, ImGuiPlatformImeData*) {} -#endif +#endif // Default IME handlers //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] METRICS/DEBUGGER WINDOW @@ -14516,6 +14730,11 @@ void ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open) // Basic info Text("Dear ImGui %s", GetVersion()); + if (g.ContextName[0] != 0) + { + SameLine(); + Text("(Context Name: \"%s\")", g.ContextName); + } Text("Application average %.3f ms/frame (%.1f FPS)", 1000.0f / io.Framerate, io.Framerate); Text("%d vertices, %d indices (%d triangles)", io.MetricsRenderVertices, io.MetricsRenderIndices, io.MetricsRenderIndices / 3); Text("%d visible windows, %d current allocations", io.MetricsRenderWindows, g.DebugAllocInfo.TotalAllocCount - g.DebugAllocInfo.TotalFreeCount); @@ -14787,6 +15006,17 @@ void ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open) TreePop(); } + // Details for MultiSelect + if (TreeNode("MultiSelect", "MultiSelect (%d)", g.MultiSelectStorage.GetAliveCount())) + { + ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = &g.BoxSelectState; + BulletText("BoxSelect ID=0x%08X, Starting = %d, Active %d", bs->ID, bs->IsStarting, bs->IsActive); + for (int n = 0; n < g.MultiSelectStorage.GetMapSize(); n++) + if (ImGuiMultiSelectState* state = g.MultiSelectStorage.TryGetMapData(n)) + DebugNodeMultiSelectState(state); + TreePop(); + } + // Details for Docking #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_DOCK if (TreeNode("Docking")) @@ -15377,8 +15607,11 @@ void ImGui::DebugNodeStorage(ImGuiStorage* storage, const char* label) { if (!TreeNode(label, "%s: %d entries, %d bytes", label, storage->Data.Size, storage->Data.size_in_bytes())) return; - for (const ImGuiStorage::ImGuiStoragePair& p : storage->Data) + for (const ImGuiStoragePair& p : storage->Data) + { BulletText("Key 0x%08X Value { i: %d }", p.key, p.val_i); // Important: we currently don't store a type, real value may not be integer. + DebugLocateItemOnHover(p.key); + } TreePop(); } @@ -15478,6 +15711,12 @@ void ImGui::DebugNodeWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, const char* label) (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? "Child " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) ? "Tooltip " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) ? "Popup " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) ? "Modal " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) ? "ChildMenu " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) ? "NoSavedSettings " : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs)? "NoMouseInputs":"", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs) ? "NoNavInputs" : "", (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) ? "AlwaysAutoResize" : ""); + if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) + BulletText("ChildFlags: 0x%08X (%s%s%s%s..)", window->ChildFlags, + (window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_Border) ? "Border " : "", + (window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeX) ? "ResizeX " : "", + (window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY) ? "ResizeY " : "", + (window->ChildFlags & ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened) ? "NavFlattened " : ""); BulletText("Scroll: (%.2f/%.2f,%.2f/%.2f) Scrollbar:%s%s", window->Scroll.x, window->ScrollMax.x, window->Scroll.y, window->ScrollMax.y, window->ScrollbarX ? "X" : "", window->ScrollbarY ? "Y" : ""); BulletText("Active: %d/%d, WriteAccessed: %d, BeginOrderWithinContext: %d", window->Active, window->WasActive, window->WriteAccessed, (window->Active || window->WasActive) ? window->BeginOrderWithinContext : -1); BulletText("Appearing: %d, Hidden: %d (CanSkip %d Cannot %d), SkipItems: %d", window->Appearing, window->Hidden, window->HiddenFramesCanSkipItems, window->HiddenFramesCannotSkipItems, window->SkipItems); @@ -15565,7 +15804,10 @@ void ImGui::DebugLogV(const char* fmt, va_list args) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; const int old_size = g.DebugLogBuf.size(); - g.DebugLogBuf.appendf("[%05d] ", g.FrameCount); + if (g.ContextName[0] != 0) + g.DebugLogBuf.appendf("[%s] [%05d] ", g.ContextName, g.FrameCount); + else + g.DebugLogBuf.appendf("[%05d] ", g.FrameCount); g.DebugLogBuf.appendfv(fmt, args); g.DebugLogIndex.append(g.DebugLogBuf.c_str(), old_size, g.DebugLogBuf.size()); if (g.DebugLogFlags & ImGuiDebugLogFlags_OutputToTTY) @@ -15585,7 +15827,7 @@ static void SameLineOrWrap(const ImVec2& size) ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; ImVec2 pos(window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x + g.Style.ItemSpacing.x, window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y); - if (window->ClipRect.Contains(ImRect(pos, pos + size))) + if (window->WorkRect.Contains(ImRect(pos, pos + size))) ImGui::SameLine(); } @@ -15623,7 +15865,7 @@ void ImGui::ShowDebugLogWindow(bool* p_open) ShowDebugLogFlag("IO", ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventIO); ShowDebugLogFlag("Nav", ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventNav); ShowDebugLogFlag("Popup", ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventPopup); - //ShowDebugLogFlag("Selection", ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventSelection); + ShowDebugLogFlag("Selection", ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventSelection); ShowDebugLogFlag("InputRouting", ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventInputRouting); if (SmallButton("Clear")) @@ -15634,6 +15876,22 @@ void ImGui::ShowDebugLogWindow(bool* p_open) SameLine(); if (SmallButton("Copy")) SetClipboardText(g.DebugLogBuf.c_str()); + SameLine(); + if (SmallButton("Configure Outputs..")) + OpenPopup("Outputs"); + if (BeginPopup("Outputs")) + { + CheckboxFlags("OutputToTTY", &g.DebugLogFlags, ImGuiDebugLogFlags_OutputToTTY); +#ifndef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + BeginDisabled(); +#endif + CheckboxFlags("OutputToTestEngine", &g.DebugLogFlags, ImGuiDebugLogFlags_OutputToTestEngine); +#ifndef IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE + EndDisabled(); +#endif + EndPopup(); + } + BeginChild("##log", ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), ImGuiChildFlags_Border, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar); const ImGuiDebugLogFlags backup_log_flags = g.DebugLogFlags; @@ -15663,7 +15921,7 @@ void ImGui::DebugTextUnformattedWithLocateItem(const char* line_begin, const cha for (const char* p = line_begin; p <= line_end - 10; p++) { ImGuiID id = 0; - if (p[0] != '0' || (p[1] != 'x' && p[1] != 'X') || sscanf(p + 2, "%X", &id) != 1) + if (p[0] != '0' || (p[1] != 'x' && p[1] != 'X') || sscanf(p + 2, "%X", &id) != 1 || ImCharIsXdigitA(p[10])) continue; ImVec2 p0 = CalcTextSize(line_begin, p); ImVec2 p1 = CalcTextSize(p, p + 10); @@ -15994,8 +16252,6 @@ void ImGui::DebugNodeWindowSettings(ImGuiWindowSettings*) {} void ImGui::DebugNodeWindowsList(ImVector*, const char*) {} void ImGui::DebugNodeViewport(ImGuiViewportP*) {} -void ImGui::DebugLog(const char*, ...) {} -void ImGui::DebugLogV(const char*, va_list) {} void ImGui::ShowDebugLogWindow(bool*) {} void ImGui::ShowIDStackToolWindow(bool*) {} void ImGui::DebugStartItemPicker() {} diff --git a/imgui_demo.cpp b/imgui_demo.cpp index 2f79f0a28a12..9272aa57d6c5 100644 --- a/imgui_demo.cpp +++ b/imgui_demo.cpp @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (demo code) // Help: @@ -11,7 +11,7 @@ // Get the latest version at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui // How to easily locate code? -// - Use the Item Picker to debug break in code by clicking any widgets: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Debug-Tools +// - Use Tools->Item Picker to debug break in code by clicking any widgets: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Debug-Tools // - Browse an online version the demo with code linked to hovered widgets: https://pthom.github.io/imgui_manual_online/manual/imgui_manual.html // - Find a visible string and search for it in the code! @@ -62,6 +62,7 @@ // - In Visual Studio: CTRL+comma ("Edit.GoToAll") can follow symbols inside comments, whereas CTRL+F12 ("Edit.GoToImplementation") cannot. // - In Visual Studio w/ Visual Assist installed: ALT+G ("VAssistX.GoToImplementation") can also follow symbols inside comments. // - In VS Code, CLion, etc.: CTRL+click can follow symbols inside comments. +// - You can search/grep for all sections listed in the index to find the section. /* @@ -69,13 +70,15 @@ Index of this file: // [SECTION] Forward Declarations // [SECTION] Helpers +// [SECTION] Helpers: ExampleTreeNode, ExampleMemberInfo (for use by Property Editor & Multi-Select demos) // [SECTION] Demo Window / ShowDemoWindow() -// - ShowDemoWindow() -// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowWidgets() -// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowLayout() -// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowPopups() -// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowTables() -// - sub section: ShowDemoWindowInputs() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowMenuBar() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowWidgets() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowMultiSelect() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowLayout() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowPopups() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowTables() +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowInputs() // [SECTION] About Window / ShowAboutWindow() // [SECTION] Style Editor / ShowStyleEditor() // [SECTION] User Guide / ShowUserGuide() @@ -92,6 +95,7 @@ Index of this file: // [SECTION] Example App: Manipulating window titles / ShowExampleAppWindowTitles() // [SECTION] Example App: Custom Rendering using ImDrawList API / ShowExampleAppCustomRendering() // [SECTION] Example App: Documents Handling / ShowExampleAppDocuments() +// [SECTION] Example App: Assets Browser / ShowExampleAppAssetsBrowser() */ @@ -189,13 +193,14 @@ Index of this file: #endif //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// [SECTION] Forward Declarations, Helpers +// [SECTION] Forward Declarations //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- #if !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_DEMO_WINDOWS) // Forward Declarations static void ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); +static void ShowExampleAppAssetsBrowser(bool* p_open); static void ShowExampleAppConsole(bool* p_open); static void ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(bool* p_open); static void ShowExampleAppDocuments(bool* p_open); @@ -211,8 +216,11 @@ static void ShowExampleAppWindowTitles(bool* p_open); static void ShowExampleMenuFile(); // We split the contents of the big ShowDemoWindow() function into smaller functions -// (because the link time of very large functions grow non-linearly) -static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets(); +// (because the link time of very large functions tends to grow non-linearly) +struct DemoWindowData; +static void ShowDemoWindowMenuBar(DemoWindowData* demo_data); +static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets(DemoWindowData* demo_data); +static void ShowDemoWindowMultiSelect(DemoWindowData* demo_data); static void ShowDemoWindowLayout(); static void ShowDemoWindowPopups(); static void ShowDemoWindowTables(); @@ -246,16 +254,113 @@ void* GImGuiDemoMarkerCallbackUserData = NULL; #define IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER(section) do { if (GImGuiDemoMarkerCallback != NULL) GImGuiDemoMarkerCallback(__FILE__, __LINE__, section, GImGuiDemoMarkerCallbackUserData); } while (0) //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// [SECTION] Demo Window / ShowDemoWindow() +// [SECTION] Helpers: ExampleTreeNode, ExampleMemberInfo (for use by Property Editor etc.) //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// - ShowDemoWindow() -// - ShowDemoWindowWidgets() -// - ShowDemoWindowLayout() -// - ShowDemoWindowPopups() -// - ShowDemoWindowTables() -// - ShowDemoWindowColumns() -// - ShowDemoWindowInputs() + +// Simple representation for a tree +// (this is designed to be simple to understand for our demos, not to be fancy or efficient etc.) +struct ExampleTreeNode +{ + // Tree structure + char Name[28]; + int UID = 0; + ExampleTreeNode* Parent = NULL; + ImVector Childs; + + // Leaf Data + bool HasData = false; // All leaves have data + bool DataMyBool = true; + int DataMyInt = 128; + ImVec2 DataMyVec2 = ImVec2(0.0f, 3.141592f); +}; + +// Simple representation of struct metadata/serialization data. +// (this is a minimal version of what a typical advanced application may provide) +struct ExampleMemberInfo +{ + const char* Name; // Member name + ImGuiDataType DataType; // Member type + int DataCount; // Member count (1 when scalar) + int Offset; // Offset inside parent structure +}; + +// Metadata description of ExampleTreeNode struct. +static const ExampleMemberInfo ExampleTreeNodeMemberInfos[] +{ + { "MyBool", ImGuiDataType_Bool, 1, offsetof(ExampleTreeNode, DataMyBool) }, + { "MyInt", ImGuiDataType_S32, 1, offsetof(ExampleTreeNode, DataMyInt) }, + { "MyVec2", ImGuiDataType_Float, 2, offsetof(ExampleTreeNode, DataMyVec2) }, +}; + +static ExampleTreeNode* ExampleTree_CreateNode(const char* name, int uid, ExampleTreeNode* parent) +{ + ExampleTreeNode* node = IM_NEW(ExampleTreeNode); + snprintf(node->Name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(node->Name), "%s", name); + node->UID = uid; + node->Parent = parent; + if (parent) + parent->Childs.push_back(node); + return node; +} + +// Create example tree data +// (this allocates _many_ more times than most other code in either Dear ImGui or others demo) +static ExampleTreeNode* ExampleTree_CreateDemoTree() +{ + static const char* root_names[] = { "Apple", "Banana", "Cherry", "Kiwi", "Mango", "Orange", "Pineapple", "Strawberry", "Watermelon" }; + char name_buf[32]; + int uid = 0; + ExampleTreeNode* node_L0 = ExampleTree_CreateNode("", ++uid, NULL); + for (int idx_L0 = 0; idx_L0 < IM_ARRAYSIZE(root_names) * 2; idx_L0++) + { + snprintf(name_buf, 32, "%s %d", root_names[idx_L0 / 2], idx_L0 % 2); + ExampleTreeNode* node_L1 = ExampleTree_CreateNode(name_buf, ++uid, node_L0); + const int number_of_childs = (int)strlen(node_L1->Name); + for (int idx_L1 = 0; idx_L1 < number_of_childs; idx_L1++) + { + snprintf(name_buf, 32, "Child %d", idx_L1); + ExampleTreeNode* node_L2 = ExampleTree_CreateNode(name_buf, ++uid, node_L1); + node_L2->HasData = true; + if (idx_L1 == 0) + { + snprintf(name_buf, 32, "Sub-child %d", 0); + ExampleTreeNode* node_L3 = ExampleTree_CreateNode(name_buf, ++uid, node_L2); + node_L3->HasData = true; + } + } + } + return node_L0; +} + //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Demo Window / ShowDemoWindow() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct DemoWindowData +{ + // Examples Apps (accessible from the "Examples" menu) + bool ShowMainMenuBar = false; + bool ShowAppAssetsBrowser = false; + bool ShowAppConsole = false; + bool ShowAppCustomRendering = false; + bool ShowAppDocuments = false; + bool ShowAppLog = false; + bool ShowAppLayout = false; + bool ShowAppPropertyEditor = false; + bool ShowAppSimpleOverlay = false; + bool ShowAppAutoResize = false; + bool ShowAppConstrainedResize = false; + bool ShowAppFullscreen = false; + bool ShowAppLongText = false; + bool ShowAppWindowTitles = false; + + // Dear ImGui Tools (accessible from the "Tools" menu) + bool ShowMetrics = false; + bool ShowDebugLog = false; + bool ShowIDStackTool = false; + bool ShowStyleEditor = false; + bool ShowAbout = false; +}; // Demonstrate most Dear ImGui features (this is big function!) // You may execute this function to experiment with the UI and understand what it does. @@ -269,56 +374,36 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) // Verify ABI compatibility between caller code and compiled version of Dear ImGui. This helps detects some build issues. IMGUI_CHECKVERSION(); + // Stored data + static DemoWindowData demo; + // Examples Apps (accessible from the "Examples" menu) - static bool show_app_main_menu_bar = false; - static bool show_app_console = false; - static bool show_app_custom_rendering = false; - static bool show_app_documents = false; - static bool show_app_log = false; - static bool show_app_layout = false; - static bool show_app_property_editor = false; - static bool show_app_simple_overlay = false; - static bool show_app_auto_resize = false; - static bool show_app_constrained_resize = false; - static bool show_app_fullscreen = false; - static bool show_app_long_text = false; - static bool show_app_window_titles = false; - - if (show_app_main_menu_bar) ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); - if (show_app_documents) ShowExampleAppDocuments(&show_app_documents); - if (show_app_console) ShowExampleAppConsole(&show_app_console); - if (show_app_custom_rendering) ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(&show_app_custom_rendering); - if (show_app_log) ShowExampleAppLog(&show_app_log); - if (show_app_layout) ShowExampleAppLayout(&show_app_layout); - if (show_app_property_editor) ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(&show_app_property_editor); - if (show_app_simple_overlay) ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay(&show_app_simple_overlay); - if (show_app_auto_resize) ShowExampleAppAutoResize(&show_app_auto_resize); - if (show_app_constrained_resize) ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(&show_app_constrained_resize); - if (show_app_fullscreen) ShowExampleAppFullscreen(&show_app_fullscreen); - if (show_app_long_text) ShowExampleAppLongText(&show_app_long_text); - if (show_app_window_titles) ShowExampleAppWindowTitles(&show_app_window_titles); + if (demo.ShowMainMenuBar) { ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); } + if (demo.ShowAppDocuments) { ShowExampleAppDocuments(&demo.ShowAppDocuments); } + if (demo.ShowAppAssetsBrowser) { ShowExampleAppAssetsBrowser(&demo.ShowAppAssetsBrowser); } + if (demo.ShowAppConsole) { ShowExampleAppConsole(&demo.ShowAppConsole); } + if (demo.ShowAppCustomRendering) { ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(&demo.ShowAppCustomRendering); } + if (demo.ShowAppLog) { ShowExampleAppLog(&demo.ShowAppLog); } + if (demo.ShowAppLayout) { ShowExampleAppLayout(&demo.ShowAppLayout); } + if (demo.ShowAppPropertyEditor) { ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(&demo.ShowAppPropertyEditor); } + if (demo.ShowAppSimpleOverlay) { ShowExampleAppSimpleOverlay(&demo.ShowAppSimpleOverlay); } + if (demo.ShowAppAutoResize) { ShowExampleAppAutoResize(&demo.ShowAppAutoResize); } + if (demo.ShowAppConstrainedResize) { ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(&demo.ShowAppConstrainedResize); } + if (demo.ShowAppFullscreen) { ShowExampleAppFullscreen(&demo.ShowAppFullscreen); } + if (demo.ShowAppLongText) { ShowExampleAppLongText(&demo.ShowAppLongText); } + if (demo.ShowAppWindowTitles) { ShowExampleAppWindowTitles(&demo.ShowAppWindowTitles); } // Dear ImGui Tools (accessible from the "Tools" menu) - static bool show_tool_metrics = false; - static bool show_tool_debug_log = false; - static bool show_tool_id_stack_tool = false; - static bool show_tool_style_editor = false; - static bool show_tool_about = false; - - if (show_tool_metrics) - ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(&show_tool_metrics); - if (show_tool_debug_log) - ImGui::ShowDebugLogWindow(&show_tool_debug_log); - if (show_tool_id_stack_tool) - ImGui::ShowIDStackToolWindow(&show_tool_id_stack_tool); - if (show_tool_style_editor) - { - ImGui::Begin("Dear ImGui Style Editor", &show_tool_style_editor); + if (demo.ShowMetrics) { ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(&demo.ShowMetrics); } + if (demo.ShowDebugLog) { ImGui::ShowDebugLogWindow(&demo.ShowDebugLog); } + if (demo.ShowIDStackTool) { ImGui::ShowIDStackToolWindow(&demo.ShowIDStackTool); } + if (demo.ShowAbout) { ImGui::ShowAboutWindow(&demo.ShowAbout); } + if (demo.ShowStyleEditor) + { + ImGui::Begin("Dear ImGui Style Editor", &demo.ShowStyleEditor); ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(); ImGui::End(); } - if (show_tool_about) - ImGui::ShowAboutWindow(&show_tool_about); // Demonstrate the various window flags. Typically you would just use the default! static bool no_titlebar = false; @@ -361,67 +446,11 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) } // Most "big" widgets share a common width settings by default. See 'Demo->Layout->Widgets Width' for details. - // e.g. Use 2/3 of the space for widgets and 1/3 for labels (right align) - //ImGui::PushItemWidth(-ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.35f); - // e.g. Leave a fixed amount of width for labels (by passing a negative value), the rest goes to widgets. - ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * -12); + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * -12); // e.g. Leave a fixed amount of width for labels (by passing a negative value), the rest goes to widgets. + //ImGui::PushItemWidth(-ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.35f); // e.g. Use 2/3 of the space for widgets and 1/3 for labels (right align) // Menu Bar - if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) - { - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu")) - { - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu/File"); - ShowExampleMenuFile(); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Examples")) - { - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu/Examples"); - ImGui::MenuItem("Main menu bar", NULL, &show_app_main_menu_bar); - - ImGui::SeparatorText("Mini apps"); - ImGui::MenuItem("Console", NULL, &show_app_console); - ImGui::MenuItem("Custom rendering", NULL, &show_app_custom_rendering); - ImGui::MenuItem("Documents", NULL, &show_app_documents); - ImGui::MenuItem("Log", NULL, &show_app_log); - ImGui::MenuItem("Property editor", NULL, &show_app_property_editor); - ImGui::MenuItem("Simple layout", NULL, &show_app_layout); - ImGui::MenuItem("Simple overlay", NULL, &show_app_simple_overlay); - - ImGui::SeparatorText("Concepts"); - ImGui::MenuItem("Auto-resizing window", NULL, &show_app_auto_resize); - ImGui::MenuItem("Constrained-resizing window", NULL, &show_app_constrained_resize); - ImGui::MenuItem("Fullscreen window", NULL, &show_app_fullscreen); - ImGui::MenuItem("Long text display", NULL, &show_app_long_text); - ImGui::MenuItem("Manipulating window titles", NULL, &show_app_window_titles); - - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - //if (ImGui::MenuItem("MenuItem")) {} // You can also use MenuItem() inside a menu bar! - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Tools")) - { - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu/Tools"); -#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEBUG_TOOLS - const bool has_debug_tools = true; -#else - const bool has_debug_tools = false; -#endif - ImGui::MenuItem("Metrics/Debugger", NULL, &show_tool_metrics, has_debug_tools); - ImGui::MenuItem("Debug Log", NULL, &show_tool_debug_log, has_debug_tools); - ImGui::MenuItem("ID Stack Tool", NULL, &show_tool_id_stack_tool, has_debug_tools); - ImGui::MenuItem("Style Editor", NULL, &show_tool_style_editor); - bool is_debugger_present = ImGui::GetIO().ConfigDebugIsDebuggerPresent; - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Item Picker", NULL, false, has_debug_tools && is_debugger_present)) - ImGui::DebugStartItemPicker(); - if (!is_debugger_present) - ImGui::SetItemTooltip("Requires io.ConfigDebugIsDebuggerPresent=true to be set.\n\nWe otherwise disable the menu option to avoid casual users crashing the application.\n\nYou can however always access the Item Picker in Metrics->Tools."); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::MenuItem("About Dear ImGui", NULL, &show_tool_about); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndMenuBar(); - } + ShowDemoWindowMenuBar(&demo); ImGui::Text("dear imgui says hello! (%s) (%d)", IMGUI_VERSION, IMGUI_VERSION_NUM); ImGui::Spacing(); @@ -439,7 +468,9 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) ImGui::BulletText("See the ShowDemoWindow() code in imgui_demo.cpp. <- you are here!"); ImGui::BulletText("See comments in imgui.cpp."); ImGui::BulletText("See example applications in the examples/ folder."); - ImGui::BulletText("Read the FAQ at https://www.dearimgui.com/faq/"); + ImGui::BulletText("Read the FAQ at "); + ImGui::SameLine(0, 0); + ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL("https://www.dearimgui.com/faq/"); ImGui::BulletText("Set 'io.ConfigFlags |= NavEnableKeyboard' for keyboard controls."); ImGui::BulletText("Set 'io.ConfigFlags |= NavEnableGamepad' for gamepad controls."); @@ -462,19 +493,26 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NavEnableSetMousePos", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct navigation to move the mouse cursor. See comment for ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos."); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NoMouse", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct dear imgui to disable mouse inputs and interactions."); + + // The "NoMouse" option can get us stuck with a disabled mouse! Let's provide an alternative way to fix it: if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse) { - // The "NoMouse" option can get us stuck with a disabled mouse! Let's provide an alternative way to fix it: if (fmodf((float)ImGui::GetTime(), 0.40f) < 0.20f) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("<>"); } - if (ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Space)) + // Prevent both being checked + if (ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Space) || (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NoKeyboard)) io.ConfigFlags &= ~ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse; } - ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NoMouseCursorChange", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange); + + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NoMouseCursorChange", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct backend to not alter mouse cursor shape and visibility."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("io.ConfigFlags: NoKeyboard", &io.ConfigFlags, ImGuiConfigFlags_NoKeyboard); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Instruct dear imgui to disable keyboard inputs and interactions."); + ImGui::Checkbox("io.ConfigInputTrickleEventQueue", &io.ConfigInputTrickleEventQueue); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable input queue trickling: some types of events submitted during the same frame (e.g. button down + up) will be spread over multiple frames, improving interactions with low framerates."); ImGui::Checkbox("io.MouseDrawCursor", &io.MouseDrawCursor); @@ -533,8 +571,9 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Configuration/Style"); if (ImGui::TreeNode("Style")) { + ImGui::Checkbox("Style Editor", &demo.ShowStyleEditor); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("The same contents can be accessed in 'Tools->Style Editor' or by calling the ShowStyleEditor() function."); - ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(); ImGui::TreePop(); ImGui::Spacing(); } @@ -580,7 +619,7 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) } // All demo contents - ShowDemoWindowWidgets(); + ShowDemoWindowWidgets(&demo); ShowDemoWindowLayout(); ShowDemoWindowPopups(); ShowDemoWindowTables(); @@ -591,9 +630,79 @@ void ImGui::ShowDemoWindow(bool* p_open) ImGui::End(); } -static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowMenuBar() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static void ShowDemoWindowMenuBar(DemoWindowData* demo_data) +{ + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu"); + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu")) + { + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu/File"); + ShowExampleMenuFile(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Examples")) + { + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu/Examples"); + ImGui::MenuItem("Main menu bar", NULL, &demo_data->ShowMainMenuBar); + + ImGui::SeparatorText("Mini apps"); + ImGui::MenuItem("Assets Browser", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppAssetsBrowser); + ImGui::MenuItem("Console", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppConsole); + ImGui::MenuItem("Custom rendering", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppCustomRendering); + ImGui::MenuItem("Documents", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppDocuments); + ImGui::MenuItem("Log", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppLog); + ImGui::MenuItem("Property editor", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppPropertyEditor); + ImGui::MenuItem("Simple layout", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppLayout); + ImGui::MenuItem("Simple overlay", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppSimpleOverlay); + + ImGui::SeparatorText("Concepts"); + ImGui::MenuItem("Auto-resizing window", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppAutoResize); + ImGui::MenuItem("Constrained-resizing window", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppConstrainedResize); + ImGui::MenuItem("Fullscreen window", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppFullscreen); + ImGui::MenuItem("Long text display", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppLongText); + ImGui::MenuItem("Manipulating window titles", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAppWindowTitles); + + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + //if (ImGui::MenuItem("MenuItem")) {} // You can also use MenuItem() inside a menu bar! + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Tools")) + { + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Menu/Tools"); +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEBUG_TOOLS + const bool has_debug_tools = true; +#else + const bool has_debug_tools = false; +#endif + ImGui::MenuItem("Metrics/Debugger", NULL, &demo_data->ShowMetrics, has_debug_tools); + ImGui::MenuItem("Debug Log", NULL, &demo_data->ShowDebugLog, has_debug_tools); + ImGui::MenuItem("ID Stack Tool", NULL, &demo_data->ShowIDStackTool, has_debug_tools); + ImGui::MenuItem("Style Editor", NULL, &demo_data->ShowStyleEditor); + bool is_debugger_present = ImGui::GetIO().ConfigDebugIsDebuggerPresent; + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Item Picker", NULL, false, has_debug_tools && is_debugger_present)) + ImGui::DebugStartItemPicker(); + if (!is_debugger_present) + ImGui::SetItemTooltip("Requires io.ConfigDebugIsDebuggerPresent=true to be set.\n\nWe otherwise disable the menu option to avoid casual users crashing the application.\n\nYou can however always access the Item Picker in Metrics->Tools."); + ImGui::Separator(); + ImGui::MenuItem("About Dear ImGui", NULL, &demo_data->ShowAbout); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } +} + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowWidgets() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets(DemoWindowData* demo_data) { IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets"); + //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); if (!ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Widgets")) return; @@ -652,11 +761,11 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Basic/Buttons (Repeating)"); static int counter = 0; float spacing = ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x; - ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(true); + ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, true); if (ImGui::ArrowButton("##left", ImGuiDir_Left)) { counter--; } ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); if (ImGui::ArrowButton("##right", ImGuiDir_Right)) { counter++; } - ImGui::PopButtonRepeat(); + ImGui::PopItemFlag(); ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d", counter); @@ -713,18 +822,19 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() { IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Basic/DragInt, DragFloat"); - static int i1 = 50, i2 = 42; + static int i1 = 50, i2 = 42, i3 = 128; ImGui::DragInt("drag int", &i1, 1); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker( "Click and drag to edit value.\n" "Hold SHIFT/ALT for faster/slower edit.\n" "Double-click or CTRL+click to input value."); - ImGui::DragInt("drag int 0..100", &i2, 1, 0, 100, "%d%%", ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp); + ImGui::DragInt("drag int wrap 100..200", &i3, 1, 100, 200, "%d", ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround); static float f1 = 1.00f, f2 = 0.0067f; ImGui::DragFloat("drag float", &f1, 0.005f); ImGui::DragFloat("drag small float", &f2, 0.0001f, 0.0f, 0.0f, "%.06f ns"); + //ImGui::DragFloat("drag wrap -1..1", &f3, 0.005f, -1.0f, 1.0f, NULL, ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround); } ImGui::SeparatorText("Sliders"); @@ -881,12 +991,11 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() // Using ImGuiHoveredFlags_ForTooltip will pull flags from 'style.HoverFlagsForTooltipMouse' or 'style.HoverFlagsForTooltipNav', // which default value include the ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenDisabled flag. - // As a result, Set ImGui::BeginDisabled(); ImGui::Button("Disabled item", sz); - ImGui::EndDisabled(); if (ImGui::IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_ForTooltip)) ImGui::SetTooltip("I am a a tooltip for a disabled item."); + ImGui::EndDisabled(); ImGui::TreePop(); } @@ -943,6 +1052,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAllColumns", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAllColumns); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("For use in Tables only."); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlap", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlap); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Draw frame with background (e.g. for CollapsingHeader)"); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere", &base_flags, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere); ImGui::Checkbox("Align label with current X position", &align_label_with_current_x_position); ImGui::Checkbox("Test tree node as drag source", &test_drag_and_drop); ImGui::Text("Hello!"); @@ -975,7 +1085,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::Text("This is a drag and drop source"); ImGui::EndDragDropSource(); } - if (i == 2) + if (i == 2 && (base_flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanTextWidth)) { // Item 2 has an additional inline button to help demonstrate SpanTextWidth. ImGui::SameLine(); @@ -984,6 +1094,8 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() if (node_open) { ImGui::BulletText("Blah blah\nBlah Blah"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::SmallButton("Button"); ImGui::TreePop(); } } @@ -1336,6 +1448,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() } IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selectables"); + //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selectables")) { // Selectable() has 2 overloads: @@ -1357,37 +1470,6 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::TreePop(); } - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selectables/Single Selection"); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selection State: Single Selection")) - { - static int selected = -1; - for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) - { - char buf[32]; - sprintf(buf, "Object %d", n); - if (ImGui::Selectable(buf, selected == n)) - selected = n; - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selectables/Multiple Selection"); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selection State: Multiple Selection")) - { - HelpMarker("Hold CTRL and click to select multiple items."); - static bool selection[5] = { false, false, false, false, false }; - for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) - { - char buf[32]; - sprintf(buf, "Object %d", n); - if (ImGui::Selectable(buf, selection[n])) - { - if (!ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) // Clear selection when CTRL is not held - memset(selection, 0, sizeof(selection)); - selection[n] ^= 1; - } - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selectables/Rendering more items on the same line"); if (ImGui::TreeNode("Rendering more items on the same line")) { @@ -1495,6 +1577,8 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::TreePop(); } + ShowDemoWindowMultiSelect(demo_data); + // To wire InputText() with std::string or any other custom string type, // see the "Text Input > Resize Callback" section of this demo, and the misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h file. IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Text Input"); @@ -1730,6 +1814,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_AutoSelectNewTabs); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_TabListPopupButton); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline); if ((tab_bar_flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_) == 0) tab_bar_flags |= ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_; if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown", &tab_bar_flags, ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown)) @@ -1738,11 +1823,13 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() tab_bar_flags &= ~(ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ ^ ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll); // Tab Bar + ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); + ImGui::Text("Opened:"); const char* names[4] = { "Artichoke", "Beetroot", "Celery", "Daikon" }; static bool opened[4] = { true, true, true, true }; // Persistent user state for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(opened); n++) { - if (n > 0) { ImGui::SameLine(); } + ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Checkbox(names[n], &opened[n]); } @@ -2135,6 +2222,8 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable rounding underlying value to match precision of the format string (e.g. %.3f values are rounded to those 3 digits)."); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput", &flags, ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Disable CTRL+Click or Enter key allowing to input text directly into the widget."); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround", &flags, ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Enable wrapping around from max to min and from min to max (only supported by DragXXX() functions)"); // Drags static float drag_f = 0.5f; @@ -2149,9 +2238,10 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() // Sliders static float slider_f = 0.5f; static int slider_i = 50; + const ImGuiSliderFlags flags_for_sliders = flags & ~ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround; ImGui::Text("Underlying float value: %f", slider_f); - ImGui::SliderFloat("SliderFloat (0 -> 1)", &slider_f, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.3f", flags); - ImGui::SliderInt("SliderInt (0 -> 100)", &slider_i, 0, 100, "%d", flags); + ImGui::SliderFloat("SliderFloat (0 -> 1)", &slider_f, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.3f", flags_for_sliders); + ImGui::SliderInt("SliderInt (0 -> 100)", &slider_i, 0, 100, "%d", flags_for_sliders); ImGui::TreePop(); } @@ -2273,20 +2363,24 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Data Types/Inputs"); static bool inputs_step = true; + static ImGuiInputTextFlags flags = ImGuiInputTextFlags_None; ImGui::SeparatorText("Inputs"); ImGui::Checkbox("Show step buttons", &inputs_step); - ImGui::InputScalar("input s8", ImGuiDataType_S8, &s8_v, inputs_step ? &s8_one : NULL, NULL, "%d"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input u8", ImGuiDataType_U8, &u8_v, inputs_step ? &u8_one : NULL, NULL, "%u"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input s16", ImGuiDataType_S16, &s16_v, inputs_step ? &s16_one : NULL, NULL, "%d"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input u16", ImGuiDataType_U16, &u16_v, inputs_step ? &u16_one : NULL, NULL, "%u"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input s32", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, inputs_step ? &s32_one : NULL, NULL, "%d"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input s32 hex", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, inputs_step ? &s32_one : NULL, NULL, "%04X"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input u32", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, inputs_step ? &u32_one : NULL, NULL, "%u"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input u32 hex", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, inputs_step ? &u32_one : NULL, NULL, "%08X"); - ImGui::InputScalar("input s64", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, inputs_step ? &s64_one : NULL); - ImGui::InputScalar("input u64", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, inputs_step ? &u64_one : NULL); - ImGui::InputScalar("input float", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, inputs_step ? &f32_one : NULL); - ImGui::InputScalar("input double", ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, inputs_step ? &f64_one : NULL); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly", &flags, ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal", &flags, ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiInputTextFlags_DisplayEmptyRefVal", &flags, ImGuiInputTextFlags_DisplayEmptyRefVal); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s8", ImGuiDataType_S8, &s8_v, inputs_step ? &s8_one : NULL, NULL, "%d", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u8", ImGuiDataType_U8, &u8_v, inputs_step ? &u8_one : NULL, NULL, "%u", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s16", ImGuiDataType_S16, &s16_v, inputs_step ? &s16_one : NULL, NULL, "%d", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u16", ImGuiDataType_U16, &u16_v, inputs_step ? &u16_one : NULL, NULL, "%u", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s32", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, inputs_step ? &s32_one : NULL, NULL, "%d", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s32 hex", ImGuiDataType_S32, &s32_v, inputs_step ? &s32_one : NULL, NULL, "%04X", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u32", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, inputs_step ? &u32_one : NULL, NULL, "%u", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u32 hex", ImGuiDataType_U32, &u32_v, inputs_step ? &u32_one : NULL, NULL, "%08X", flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input s64", ImGuiDataType_S64, &s64_v, inputs_step ? &s64_one : NULL, NULL, NULL, flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input u64", ImGuiDataType_U64, &u64_v, inputs_step ? &u64_one : NULL, NULL, NULL, flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input float", ImGuiDataType_Float, &f32_v, inputs_step ? &f32_one : NULL, NULL, NULL, flags); + ImGui::InputScalar("input double", ImGuiDataType_Double, &f64_v, inputs_step ? &f64_one : NULL, NULL, NULL, flags); ImGui::TreePop(); } @@ -2558,7 +2652,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::BeginDisabled(true); if (item_type == 0) { ImGui::Text("ITEM: Text"); } // Testing text items with no identifier/interaction if (item_type == 1) { ret = ImGui::Button("ITEM: Button"); } // Testing button - if (item_type == 2) { ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(true); ret = ImGui::Button("ITEM: Button"); ImGui::PopButtonRepeat(); } // Testing button (with repeater) + if (item_type == 2) { ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, true); ret = ImGui::Button("ITEM: Button"); ImGui::PopItemFlag(); } // Testing button (with repeater) if (item_type == 3) { ret = ImGui::Checkbox("ITEM: Checkbox", &b); } // Testing checkbox if (item_type == 4) { ret = ImGui::SliderFloat("ITEM: SliderFloat", &col4f[0], 0.0f, 1.0f); } // Testing basic item if (item_type == 5) { ret = ImGui::InputText("ITEM: InputText", &str[0], IM_ARRAYSIZE(str)); } // Testing input text (which handles tabbing) @@ -2727,40 +2821,809 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowWidgets() ImGui::TreePop(); } - // Demonstrate BeginDisabled/EndDisabled using a checkbox located at the bottom of the section (which is a bit odd: - // logically we'd have this checkbox at the top of the section, but we don't want this feature to steal that space) - if (disable_all) - ImGui::EndDisabled(); + // Demonstrate BeginDisabled/EndDisabled using a checkbox located at the bottom of the section (which is a bit odd: + // logically we'd have this checkbox at the top of the section, but we don't want this feature to steal that space) + if (disable_all) + ImGui::EndDisabled(); + + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Disable Block"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Disable block")) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Disable entire section above", &disable_all); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Demonstrate using BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled() across this section."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Text Filter"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Text Filter")) + { + // Helper class to easy setup a text filter. + // You may want to implement a more feature-full filtering scheme in your own application. + HelpMarker("Not a widget per-se, but ImGuiTextFilter is a helper to perform simple filtering on text strings."); + static ImGuiTextFilter filter; + ImGui::Text("Filter usage:\n" + " \"\" display all lines\n" + " \"xxx\" display lines containing \"xxx\"\n" + " \"xxx,yyy\" display lines containing \"xxx\" or \"yyy\"\n" + " \"-xxx\" hide lines containing \"xxx\""); + filter.Draw(); + const char* lines[] = { "aaa1.c", "bbb1.c", "ccc1.c", "aaa2.cpp", "bbb2.cpp", "ccc2.cpp", "abc.h", "hello, world" }; + for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(lines); i++) + if (filter.PassFilter(lines[i])) + ImGui::BulletText("%s", lines[i]); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } +} + +static const char* ExampleNames[] = +{ + "Artichoke", "Arugula", "Asparagus", "Avocado", "Bamboo Shoots", "Bean Sprouts", "Beans", "Beet", "Belgian Endive", "Bell Pepper", + "Bitter Gourd", "Bok Choy", "Broccoli", "Brussels Sprouts", "Burdock Root", "Cabbage", "Calabash", "Capers", "Carrot", "Cassava", + "Cauliflower", "Celery", "Celery Root", "Celcuce", "Chayote", "Chinese Broccoli", "Corn", "Cucumber" +}; + +// Extra functions to add deletion support to ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage +struct ExampleSelectionWithDeletion : ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage +{ + // Find which item should be Focused after deletion. + // Call _before_ item submission. Retunr an index in the before-deletion item list, your item loop should call SetKeyboardFocusHere() on it. + // The subsequent ApplyDeletionPostLoop() code will use it to apply Selection. + // - We cannot provide this logic in core Dear ImGui because we don't have access to selection data. + // - We don't actually manipulate the ImVector<> here, only in ApplyDeletionPostLoop(), but using similar API for consistency and flexibility. + // - Important: Deletion only works if the underlying ImGuiID for your items are stable: aka not depend on their index, but on e.g. item id/ptr. + // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Doesn't take account of the possibility focus target will be moved during deletion. Need refocus or scroll offset. + int ApplyDeletionPreLoop(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io, int items_count) + { + if (Size == 0) + return -1; + + // If focused item is not selected... + const int focused_idx = (int)ms_io->NavIdItem; // Index of currently focused item + if (ms_io->NavIdSelected == false) // This is merely a shortcut, == Contains(adapter->IndexToStorage(items, focused_idx)) + { + ms_io->RangeSrcReset = true; // Request to recover RangeSrc from NavId next frame. Would be ok to reset even when NavIdSelected==true, but it would take an extra frame to recover RangeSrc when deleting a selected item. + return focused_idx; // Request to focus same item after deletion. + } + + // If focused item is selected: land on first unselected item after focused item. + for (int idx = focused_idx + 1; idx < items_count; idx++) + if (!Contains(GetStorageIdFromIndex(idx))) + return idx; + + // If focused item is selected: otherwise return last unselected item before focused item. + for (int idx = IM_MIN(focused_idx, items_count) - 1; idx >= 0; idx--) + if (!Contains(GetStorageIdFromIndex(idx))) + return idx; + + return -1; + } + + // Rewrite item list (delete items) + update selection. + // - Call after EndMultiSelect() + // - We cannot provide this logic in core Dear ImGui because we don't have access to your items, nor to selection data. + template + void ApplyDeletionPostLoop(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io, ImVector& items, int item_curr_idx_to_select) + { + // Rewrite item list (delete items) + convert old selection index (before deletion) to new selection index (after selection). + // If NavId was not part of selection, we will stay on same item. + ImVector new_items; + new_items.reserve(items.Size - Size); + int item_next_idx_to_select = -1; + for (int idx = 0; idx < items.Size; idx++) + { + if (!Contains(GetStorageIdFromIndex(idx))) + new_items.push_back(items[idx]); + if (item_curr_idx_to_select == idx) + item_next_idx_to_select = new_items.Size - 1; + } + items.swap(new_items); + + // Update selection + Clear(); + if (item_next_idx_to_select != -1 && ms_io->NavIdSelected) + SetItemSelected(GetStorageIdFromIndex(item_next_idx_to_select), true); + } +}; + +// Example: Implement dual list box storage and interface +struct ExampleDualListBox +{ + ImVector Items[2]; // ID is index into ExampleName[] + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage Selections[2]; // Store ExampleItemId into selection + bool OptKeepSorted = true; + + void MoveAll(int src, int dst) + { + IM_ASSERT((src == 0 && dst == 1) || (src == 1 && dst == 0)); + for (ImGuiID item_id : Items[src]) + Items[dst].push_back(item_id); + Items[src].clear(); + SortItems(dst); + Selections[src].Swap(Selections[dst]); + Selections[src].Clear(); + } + void MoveSelected(int src, int dst) + { + for (int src_n = 0; src_n < Items[src].Size; src_n++) + { + ImGuiID item_id = Items[src][src_n]; + if (!Selections[src].Contains(item_id)) + continue; + Items[src].erase(&Items[src][src_n]); // FIXME-OPT: Could be implemented more optimally (rebuild src items and swap) + Items[dst].push_back(item_id); + src_n--; + } + if (OptKeepSorted) + SortItems(dst); + Selections[src].Swap(Selections[dst]); + Selections[src].Clear(); + } + void ApplySelectionRequests(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io, int side) + { + // In this example we store item id in selection (instead of item index) + Selections[side].UserData = Items[side].Data; + Selections[side].AdapterIndexToStorageId = [](ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* self, int idx) { ImGuiID* items = (ImGuiID*)self->UserData; return items[idx]; }; + Selections[side].ApplyRequests(ms_io); + } + static int IMGUI_CDECL CompareItemsByValue(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) + { + const int* a = (const int*)lhs; + const int* b = (const int*)rhs; + return (*a - *b) > 0 ? +1 : -1; + } + void SortItems(int n) + { + qsort(Items[n].Data, (size_t)Items[n].Size, sizeof(Items[n][0]), CompareItemsByValue); + } + void Show() + { + //ImGui::Checkbox("Sorted", &OptKeepSorted); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("split", 3, ImGuiTableFlags_None)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch); // Left side + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); // Buttons + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch); // Right side + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + + int request_move_selected = -1; + int request_move_all = -1; + float child_height_0 = 0.0f; + for (int side = 0; side < 2; side++) + { + // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Dual List Box: Add context menus + // FIXME-NAV: Using ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened exhibit many issues. + ImVector& items = Items[side]; + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage& selection = Selections[side]; + + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex((side == 0) ? 0 : 2); + ImGui::Text("%s (%d)", (side == 0) ? "Available" : "Basket", items.Size); + + // Submit scrolling range to avoid glitches on moving/deletion + const float items_height = ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(0.0f, items.Size * items_height)); + + bool child_visible; + if (side == 0) + { + // Left child is resizable + ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0.0f, ImGui::GetFrameHeightWithSpacing() * 4), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX)); + child_visible = ImGui::BeginChild("0", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20), ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY); + child_height_0 = ImGui::GetWindowSize().y; + } + else + { + // Right child use same height as left one + child_visible = ImGui::BeginChild("1", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, child_height_0), ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle); + } + if (child_visible) + { + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_None; + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, selection.Size, items.Size); + ApplySelectionRequests(ms_io, side); + + for (int item_n = 0; item_n < items.Size; item_n++) + { + ImGuiID item_id = items[item_n]; + bool item_is_selected = selection.Contains(item_id); + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(item_n); + ImGui::Selectable(ExampleNames[item_id], item_is_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick); + if (ImGui::IsItemFocused()) + { + // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Dual List Box: Transfer focus + if (ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Enter) || ImGui::IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_KeypadEnter)) + request_move_selected = side; + if (ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(0)) // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Double-click on multi-selection? + request_move_selected = side; + } + } + + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + ApplySelectionRequests(ms_io, side); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + } + + // Buttons columns + ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); + ImGui::NewLine(); + //ImVec2 button_sz = { ImGui::CalcTextSize(">>").x + ImGui::GetStyle().FramePadding.x * 2.0f, ImGui::GetFrameHeight() + padding.y * 2.0f }; + ImVec2 button_sz = { ImGui::GetFrameHeight(), ImGui::GetFrameHeight() }; + + // (Using BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled() works but feels distracting given how it is currently visualized) + if (ImGui::Button(">>", button_sz)) + request_move_all = 0; + if (ImGui::Button(">", button_sz)) + request_move_selected = 0; + if (ImGui::Button("<", button_sz)) + request_move_selected = 1; + if (ImGui::Button("<<", button_sz)) + request_move_all = 1; + + // Process requests + if (request_move_all != -1) + MoveAll(request_move_all, request_move_all ^ 1); + if (request_move_selected != -1) + MoveSelected(request_move_selected, request_move_selected ^ 1); + + // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Support action from outside + /* + if (OptKeepSorted == false) + { + ImGui::NewLine(); + if (ImGui::ArrowButton("MoveUp", ImGuiDir_Up)) {} + if (ImGui::ArrowButton("MoveDown", ImGuiDir_Down)) {} + } + */ + + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + } +}; + +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowMultiSelect() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Multi-selection demos +// Also read: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Multi-Select +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static void ShowDemoWindowMultiSelect(DemoWindowData* demo_data) +{ + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State & Multi-Select"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selection State & Multi-Select")) + { + HelpMarker("Selections can be built using Selectable(), TreeNode() or other widgets. Selection state is owned by application code/data."); + + // Without any fancy API: manage single-selection yourself. + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Single-Select"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Single-Select")) + { + static int selected = -1; + for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Object %d", n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(buf, selected == n)) + selected = n; + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate implementation a most-basic form of multi-selection manually + // This doesn't support the SHIFT modifier which requires BeginMultiSelect()! + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (manual/simplified, without BeginMultiSelect)"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (manual/simplified, without BeginMultiSelect)")) + { + HelpMarker("Hold CTRL and click to select multiple items."); + static bool selection[5] = { false, false, false, false, false }; + for (int n = 0; n < 5; n++) + { + char buf[32]; + sprintf(buf, "Object %d", n); + if (ImGui::Selectable(buf, selection[n])) + { + if (!ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) // Clear selection when CTRL is not held + memset(selection, 0, sizeof(selection)); + selection[n] ^= 1; // Toggle current item + } + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate handling proper multi-selection using the BeginMultiSelect/EndMultiSelect API. + // SHIFT+Click w/ CTRL and other standard features are supported. + // We use the ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage helper which you may freely reimplement. + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select")) + { + ImGui::Text("Supported features:"); + ImGui::BulletText("Keyboard navigation (arrows, page up/down, home/end, space)."); + ImGui::BulletText("Ctrl modifier to preserve and toggle selection."); + ImGui::BulletText("Shift modifier for range selection."); + ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+A to select all."); + ImGui::BulletText("Escape to clear selection."); + ImGui::BulletText("Click and drag to box-select."); + ImGui::Text("Tip: Use 'Demo->Tools->Debug Log->Selection' to see selection requests as they happen."); + + // Use default selection.Adapter: Pass index to SetNextItemSelectionUserData(), store index in Selection + const int ITEMS_COUNT = 50; + static ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage selection; + ImGui::Text("Selection: %d/%d", selection.Size, ITEMS_COUNT); + + // The BeginChild() has no purpose for selection logic, other that offering a scrolling region. + if (ImGui::BeginChild("##Basket", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20), ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY)) + { + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d; + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, selection.Size, ITEMS_COUNT); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + + for (int n = 0; n < ITEMS_COUNT; n++) + { + char label[64]; + sprintf(label, "Object %05d: %s", n, ExampleNames[n % IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames)]); + bool item_is_selected = selection.Contains((ImGuiID)n); + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(n); + ImGui::Selectable(label, item_is_selected); + } + + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate using the clipper with BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (with clipper)"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (with clipper)")) + { + // Use default selection.Adapter: Pass index to SetNextItemSelectionUserData(), store index in Selection + static ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage selection; + + ImGui::Text("Added features:"); + ImGui::BulletText("Using ImGuiListClipper."); + + const int ITEMS_COUNT = 10000; + ImGui::Text("Selection: %d/%d", selection.Size, ITEMS_COUNT); + if (ImGui::BeginChild("##Basket", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20), ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY)) + { + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d; + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, selection.Size, ITEMS_COUNT); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(ITEMS_COUNT); + if (ms_io->RangeSrcItem != -1) + clipper.IncludeItemByIndex((int)ms_io->RangeSrcItem); // Ensure RangeSrc item is not clipped. + while (clipper.Step()) + { + for (int n = clipper.DisplayStart; n < clipper.DisplayEnd; n++) + { + char label[64]; + sprintf(label, "Object %05d: %s", n, ExampleNames[n % IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames)]); + bool item_is_selected = selection.Contains((ImGuiID)n); + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(n); + ImGui::Selectable(label, item_is_selected); + } + } + + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate dynamic item list + deletion support using the BeginMultiSelect/EndMultiSelect API. + // In order to support Deletion without any glitches you need to: + // - (1) If items are submitted in their own scrolling area, submit contents size SetNextWindowContentSize() ahead of time to prevent one-frame readjustment of scrolling. + // - (2) Items needs to have persistent ID Stack identifier = ID needs to not depends on their index. PushID(index) = KO. PushID(item_id) = OK. This is in order to focus items reliably after a selection. + // - (3) BeginXXXX process + // - (4) Focus process + // - (5) EndXXXX process + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (with deletion)"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (with deletion)")) + { + // Storing items data separately from selection data. + // (you may decide to store selection data inside your item (aka intrusive storage) if you don't need multiple views over same items) + // Use a custom selection.Adapter: store item identifier in Selection (instead of index) + static ImVector items; + static ExampleSelectionWithDeletion selection; + selection.UserData = (void*)&items; + selection.AdapterIndexToStorageId = [](ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* self, int idx) { ImVector* p_items = (ImVector*)self->UserData; return (*p_items)[idx]; }; // Index -> ID + + ImGui::Text("Added features:"); + ImGui::BulletText("Dynamic list with Delete key support."); + ImGui::Text("Selection size: %d/%d", selection.Size, items.Size); + + // Initialize default list with 50 items + button to add/remove items. + static ImGuiID items_next_id = 0; + if (items_next_id == 0) + for (ImGuiID n = 0; n < 50; n++) + items.push_back(items_next_id++); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Add 20 items")) { for (int n = 0; n < 20; n++) { items.push_back(items_next_id++); } } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::SmallButton("Remove 20 items")) { for (int n = IM_MIN(20, items.Size); n > 0; n--) { selection.SetItemSelected(items.back(), false); items.pop_back(); } } + + // (1) Extra to support deletion: Submit scrolling range to avoid glitches on deletion + const float items_height = ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(0.0f, items.Size * items_height)); + + if (ImGui::BeginChild("##Basket", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20), ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY)) + { + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d; + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, selection.Size, items.Size); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + + const bool want_delete = ImGui::Shortcut(ImGuiKey_Delete, ImGuiInputFlags_Repeat) && (selection.Size > 0); + const int item_curr_idx_to_focus = want_delete ? selection.ApplyDeletionPreLoop(ms_io, items.Size) : -1; + + for (int n = 0; n < items.Size; n++) + { + const ImGuiID item_id = items[n]; + char label[64]; + sprintf(label, "Object %05u: %s", item_id, ExampleNames[item_id % IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames)]); + + bool item_is_selected = selection.Contains(item_id); + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(n); + ImGui::Selectable(label, item_is_selected); + if (item_curr_idx_to_focus == n) + ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(-1); + } + + // Apply multi-select requests + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + if (want_delete) + selection.ApplyDeletionPostLoop(ms_io, items, item_curr_idx_to_focus); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Implement a Dual List Box (#6648) + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (dual list box)"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (dual list box)")) + { + // Init default state + static ExampleDualListBox dlb; + if (dlb.Items[0].Size == 0 && dlb.Items[1].Size == 0) + for (int item_id = 0; item_id < IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames); item_id++) + dlb.Items[0].push_back((ImGuiID)item_id); + + // Show + dlb.Show(); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (checkboxes)"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (checkboxes)")) + { + ImGui::Text("In a list of checkboxes (not selectable):"); + ImGui::BulletText("Using _NoAutoSelect + _NoAutoClear flags."); + ImGui::BulletText("Shift+Click to check multiple boxes."); + ImGui::BulletText("Shift+Keyboard to copy current value to other boxes."); + + // If you have an array of checkboxes, you may want to use NoAutoSelect + NoAutoClear and the ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage helper. + static bool items[20] = {}; + static ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d); // Cannot use ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d as checkboxes are varying width. + + if (ImGui::BeginChild("##Basket", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20), ImGuiChildFlags_Border | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY)) + { + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, -1, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); + ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage storage_wrapper; + storage_wrapper.UserData = (void*)items; + storage_wrapper.AdapterSetItemSelected = [](ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage* self, int n, bool selected) { bool* array = (bool*)self->UserData; array[n] = selected; }; + storage_wrapper.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + for (int n = 0; n < 20; n++) + { + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "Item %d", n); + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(n); + ImGui::Checkbox(label, &items[n]); + } + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + storage_wrapper.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Demonstrate individual selection scopes in same window + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (multiple scopes)"); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (multiple scopes)")) + { + // Use default select: Pass index to SetNextItemSelectionUserData(), store index in Selection + const int SCOPES_COUNT = 3; + const int ITEMS_COUNT = 8; // Per scope + static ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage selections_data[SCOPES_COUNT]; + + // Use ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect to not affect other selections in same window. + static ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape;// | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid; + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow)) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect; + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect)) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow; + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d); + + for (int selection_scope_n = 0; selection_scope_n < SCOPES_COUNT; selection_scope_n++) + { + ImGui::PushID(selection_scope_n); + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* selection = &selections_data[selection_scope_n]; + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, selection->Size, ITEMS_COUNT); + selection->ApplyRequests(ms_io); + + ImGui::SeparatorText("Selection scope"); + ImGui::Text("Selection size: %d/%d", selection->Size, ITEMS_COUNT); + + for (int n = 0; n < ITEMS_COUNT; n++) + { + char label[64]; + sprintf(label, "Object %05d: %s", n, ExampleNames[n % IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames)]); + bool item_is_selected = selection->Contains((ImGuiID)n); + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(n); + ImGui::Selectable(label, item_is_selected); + } + + // Apply multi-select requests + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + selection->ApplyRequests(ms_io); + ImGui::PopID(); + } + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // See ShowExampleAppAssetsBrowser() + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (tiled assets browser)")) + { + ImGui::Checkbox("Assets Browser", &demo_data->ShowAppAssetsBrowser); + ImGui::Text("(also access from 'Examples->Assets Browser' in menu)"); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Advanced demonstration of BeginMultiSelect() + // - Showcase clipping. + // - Showcase deletion. + // - Showcase basic drag and drop. + // - Showcase TreeNode variant (note that tree node don't expand in the demo: supporting expanding tree nodes + clipping a separate thing). + // - Showcase using inside a table. + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Selection State/Multi-Select (advanced)"); + //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-Select (advanced)")) + { + // Options + enum WidgetType { WidgetType_Selectable, WidgetType_TreeNode }; + static bool use_clipper = true; + static bool use_deletion = true; + static bool use_drag_drop = true; + static bool show_in_table = false; + static bool show_color_button = false; + static ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d; + static WidgetType widget_type = WidgetType_Selectable; + + if (ImGui::TreeNode("Options")) + { + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Selectables", widget_type == WidgetType_Selectable)) { widget_type = WidgetType_Selectable; } + ImGui::SameLine(); + if (ImGui::RadioButton("Tree nodes", widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode)) { widget_type = WidgetType_TreeNode; } + ImGui::SameLine(); + HelpMarker("TreeNode() is technically supported but... using this correctly is more complicated (you need some sort of linear/random access to your tree, which is suited to advanced trees setups already implementing filters and clipper. We will work toward simplifying and demoing this.\n\nFor now the tree demo is actually a little bit meaningless because it is an empty tree with only root nodes."); + ImGui::Checkbox("Enable clipper", &use_clipper); + ImGui::Checkbox("Enable deletion", &use_deletion); + ImGui::Checkbox("Enable drag & drop", &use_drag_drop); + ImGui::Checkbox("Show in a table", &show_in_table); + ImGui::Checkbox("Show color button", &show_color_button); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoSelectAll", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoSelectAll); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClearOnReselect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClearOnReselect); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelectNoScroll", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelectNoScroll); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape); + ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid); + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow)) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect; + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect)) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow; + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClick", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClick) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClick)) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease; + if (ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease", &flags, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease)) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClick; + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Allow dragging an unselected item without altering selection."); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + + // Initialize default list with 1000 items. + // Use default selection.Adapter: Pass index to SetNextItemSelectionUserData(), store index in Selection + static ImVector items; + static int items_next_id = 0; + if (items_next_id == 0) { for (int n = 0; n < 1000; n++) { items.push_back(items_next_id++); } } + static ExampleSelectionWithDeletion selection; + static bool request_deletion_from_menu = false; // Queue deletion triggered from context menu + + ImGui::Text("Selection size: %d/%d", selection.Size, items.Size); + + const float items_height = (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode) ? ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() : ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(0.0f, items.Size * items_height)); + if (ImGui::BeginChild("##Basket", ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, ImGui::GetFontSize() * 20), ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle | ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeY)) + { + ImVec2 color_button_sz(ImGui::GetFontSize(), ImGui::GetFontSize()); + if (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode) + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.x, 0.0f)); + + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(flags, selection.Size, items.Size); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + + const bool want_delete = (ImGui::Shortcut(ImGuiKey_Delete, ImGuiInputFlags_Repeat) && (selection.Size > 0)) || request_deletion_from_menu; + const int item_curr_idx_to_focus = want_delete ? selection.ApplyDeletionPreLoop(ms_io, items.Size) : -1; + request_deletion_from_menu = false; + + if (show_in_table) + { + if (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode) + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_CellPadding, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); + ImGui::BeginTable("##Split", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_NoSavedSettings | ImGuiTableFlags_NoPadOuterX); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, 0.70f); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, 0.30f); + //ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.x, 0.0f)); + } + + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + if (use_clipper) + { + clipper.Begin(items.Size); + if (item_curr_idx_to_focus != -1) + clipper.IncludeItemByIndex(item_curr_idx_to_focus); // Ensure focused item is not clipped. + if (ms_io->RangeSrcItem != -1) + clipper.IncludeItemByIndex((int)ms_io->RangeSrcItem); // Ensure RangeSrc item is not clipped. + } + + while (!use_clipper || clipper.Step()) + { + const int item_begin = use_clipper ? clipper.DisplayStart : 0; + const int item_end = use_clipper ? clipper.DisplayEnd : items.Size; + for (int n = item_begin; n < item_end; n++) + { + if (show_in_table) + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + + const int item_id = items[n]; + const char* item_category = ExampleNames[item_id % IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames)]; + char label[64]; + sprintf(label, "Object %05d: %s", item_id, item_category); + + // IMPORTANT: for deletion refocus to work we need object ID to be stable, + // aka not depend on their index in the list. Here we use our persistent item_id + // instead of index to build a unique ID that will persist. + // (If we used PushID(index) instead, focus wouldn't be restored correctly after deletion). + ImGui::PushID(item_id); + + // Emit a color button, to test that Shift+LeftArrow landing on an item that is not part + // of the selection scope doesn't erroneously alter our selection. + if (show_color_button) + { + ImU32 dummy_col = (ImU32)((unsigned int)n * 0xC250B74B) | IM_COL32_A_MASK; + ImGui::ColorButton("##", ImColor(dummy_col), ImGuiColorEditFlags_NoTooltip, color_button_sz); + ImGui::SameLine(); + } + + // Submit item + bool item_is_selected = selection.Contains((ImGuiID)n); + bool item_is_open = false; + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(n); + if (widget_type == WidgetType_Selectable) + { + ImGui::Selectable(label, item_is_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags_None); + } + else if (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode) + { + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags tree_node_flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick; + if (item_is_selected) + tree_node_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected; + item_is_open = ImGui::TreeNodeEx(label, tree_node_flags); + } + + // Focus (for after deletion) + if (item_curr_idx_to_focus == n) + ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(-1); + + // Drag and Drop + if (use_drag_drop && ImGui::BeginDragDropSource()) + { + // Create payload with full selection OR single unselected item. + // (the later is only possible when using ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease) + if (ImGui::GetDragDropPayload() == NULL) + { + ImVector payload_items; + void* it = NULL; + ImGuiID id = 0; + if (!item_is_selected) + payload_items.push_back(item_id); + else + while (selection.GetNextSelectedItem(&it, &id)) + payload_items.push_back((int)id); + ImGui::SetDragDropPayload("MULTISELECT_DEMO_ITEMS", payload_items.Data, (size_t)payload_items.size_in_bytes()); + } + + // Display payload content in tooltip + const ImGuiPayload* payload = ImGui::GetDragDropPayload(); + const int* payload_items = (int*)payload->Data; + const int payload_count = (int)payload->DataSize / (int)sizeof(int); + if (payload_count == 1) + ImGui::Text("Object %05d: %s", payload_items[0], ExampleNames[payload_items[0] % IM_ARRAYSIZE(ExampleNames)]); + else + ImGui::Text("Dragging %d objects", payload_count); + + ImGui::EndDragDropSource(); + } + + if (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode && item_is_open) + ImGui::TreePop(); + + // Right-click: context menu + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem()) + { + ImGui::BeginDisabled(!use_deletion || selection.Size == 0); + sprintf(label, "Delete %d item(s)###DeleteSelected", selection.Size); + if (ImGui::Selectable(label)) + request_deletion_from_menu = true; + ImGui::EndDisabled(); + ImGui::Selectable("Close"); + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + // Demo content within a table + if (show_in_table) + { + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(0, 0)); + ImGui::InputText("###NoLabel", (char*)(void*)item_category, strlen(item_category), ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } + + ImGui::PopID(); + } + if (!use_clipper) + break; + } + + if (show_in_table) + { + ImGui::EndTable(); + if (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode) + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Disable Block"); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Disable block")) - { - ImGui::Checkbox("Disable entire section above", &disable_all); - ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Demonstrate using BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled() across this section."); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } + // Apply multi-select requests + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + if (want_delete) + selection.ApplyDeletionPostLoop(ms_io, items, item_curr_idx_to_focus); - IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Widgets/Text Filter"); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Text Filter")) - { - // Helper class to easy setup a text filter. - // You may want to implement a more feature-full filtering scheme in your own application. - HelpMarker("Not a widget per-se, but ImGuiTextFilter is a helper to perform simple filtering on text strings."); - static ImGuiTextFilter filter; - ImGui::Text("Filter usage:\n" - " \"\" display all lines\n" - " \"xxx\" display lines containing \"xxx\"\n" - " \"xxx,yyy\" display lines containing \"xxx\" or \"yyy\"\n" - " \"-xxx\" hide lines containing \"xxx\""); - filter.Draw(); - const char* lines[] = { "aaa1.c", "bbb1.c", "ccc1.c", "aaa2.cpp", "bbb2.cpp", "ccc2.cpp", "abc.h", "hello, world" }; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(lines); i++) - if (filter.PassFilter(lines[i])) - ImGui::BulletText("%s", lines[i]); + if (widget_type == WidgetType_TreeNode) + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } ImGui::TreePop(); } } +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowLayout() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + static void ShowDemoWindowLayout() { IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Layout"); @@ -3620,6 +4483,10 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowLayout() } } +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowPopups() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + static void ShowDemoWindowPopups() { IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Popups"); @@ -3875,7 +4742,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowPopups() static int item = 1; static float color[4] = { 0.4f, 0.7f, 0.0f, 0.5f }; ImGui::Combo("Combo", &item, "aaaa\0bbbb\0cccc\0dddd\0eeee\0\0"); - ImGui::ColorEdit4("color", color); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("Color", color); if (ImGui::Button("Add another modal..")) ImGui::OpenPopup("Stacked 2"); @@ -3887,6 +4754,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowPopups() if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Stacked 2", &unused_open)) { ImGui::Text("Hello from Stacked The Second!"); + ImGui::ColorEdit4("Color", color); // Allow opening another nested popup if (ImGui::Button("Close")) ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); ImGui::EndPopup(); @@ -4079,6 +4947,10 @@ static void ShowTableColumnsStatusFlags(ImGuiTableColumnFlags flags) ImGui::CheckboxFlags("_IsHovered", &flags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered); } +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowTables() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + static void ShowDemoWindowTables() { //ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(true, ImGuiCond_Once); @@ -4197,7 +5069,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowTables() PushStyleCompact(); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_Borders); - ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders\n = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("ImGuiTableFlags_Borders\n = ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterV\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersInnerH\n | ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuterH"); ImGui::Indent(); ImGui::CheckboxFlags("ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH", &flags, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersH); @@ -5851,7 +6723,6 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowTables() // Show data // FIXME-TABLE FIXME-NAV: How we can get decent up/down even though we have the buttons here? - ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(true); #if 1 // Demonstrate using clipper for large vertical lists ImGuiListClipper clipper; @@ -5936,7 +6807,6 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowTables() ImGui::PopID(); } } - ImGui::PopButtonRepeat(); // Store some info to display debug details below table_scroll_cur = ImVec2(ImGui::GetScrollX(), ImGui::GetScrollY()); @@ -6174,6 +7044,10 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowColumns() ImGui::TreePop(); } +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] ShowDemoWindowInputs() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + static void ShowDemoWindowInputs() { IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Inputs & Focus"); @@ -6295,7 +7169,7 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowInputs() ImGui::RadioButton("ImGuiInputFlags_RouteAlways", &route_type, ImGuiInputFlags_RouteAlways); ImGuiInputFlags flags = route_type | route_options; // Merged flags if (route_type != ImGuiInputFlags_RouteGlobal) - route_options &= ~(ImGuiInputFlags_RouteOverFocused | ImGuiInputFlags_RouteOverActive | ImGuiInputFlags_RouteUnlessBgFocused); + flags &= ~(ImGuiInputFlags_RouteOverFocused | ImGuiInputFlags_RouteOverActive | ImGuiInputFlags_RouteUnlessBgFocused); ImGui::SeparatorText("Using SetNextItemShortcut()"); ImGui::Text("Ctrl+S"); @@ -6399,10 +7273,10 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowInputs() ImGui::InputText("1", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); ImGui::InputText("2", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); ImGui::InputText("3", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - ImGui::PushTabStop(false); + ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, true); ImGui::InputText("4 (tab skip)", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Item won't be cycled through when using TAB or Shift+Tab."); - ImGui::PopTabStop(); + ImGui::PopItemFlag(); ImGui::InputText("5", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); ImGui::TreePop(); } @@ -6424,12 +7298,12 @@ static void ShowDemoWindowInputs() ImGui::InputText("2", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 2; - ImGui::PushTabStop(false); + ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, true); if (focus_3) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); ImGui::InputText("3 (tab skip)", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 3; ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Item won't be cycled through when using TAB or Shift+Tab."); - ImGui::PopTabStop(); + ImGui::PopItemFlag(); if (has_focus) ImGui::Text("Item with focus: %d", has_focus); @@ -6494,6 +7368,17 @@ void ImGui::ShowAboutWindow(bool* p_open) } IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Tools/About Dear ImGui"); ImGui::Text("Dear ImGui %s (%d)", IMGUI_VERSION, IMGUI_VERSION_NUM); + + ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL("Homepage", "https://github.com/ocornut/imgui"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL("FAQ", "https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/blob/master/docs/FAQ.md"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL("Wiki", "https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL("Releases", "https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases"); + ImGui::SameLine(); + ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL("Funding", "https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Funding"); + ImGui::Separator(); ImGui::Text("By Omar Cornut and all Dear ImGui contributors."); ImGui::Text("Dear ImGui is licensed under the MIT License, see LICENSE for more information."); @@ -6749,6 +7634,8 @@ void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref) ImGui::SliderFloat("FrameBorderSize", &style.FrameBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); ImGui::SliderFloat("TabBorderSize", &style.TabBorderSize, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.0f"); ImGui::SliderFloat("TabBarBorderSize", &style.TabBarBorderSize, 0.0f, 2.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("TabBarOverlineSize", &style.TabBarOverlineSize, 0.0f, 2.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Overline is only drawn over the selected tab when ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline is set."); ImGui::SeparatorText("Rounding"); ImGui::SliderFloat("WindowRounding", &style.WindowRounding, 0.0f, 12.0f, "%.0f"); @@ -6836,7 +7723,7 @@ void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref) "Right-click to open edit options menu."); ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0.0f, ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * 10), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX)); - ImGui::BeginChild("##colors", ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiChildFlags_Border, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened); + ImGui::BeginChild("##colors", ImVec2(0, 0), ImGuiChildFlags_Border | ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar); ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * -12); for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) { @@ -6917,10 +7804,10 @@ void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref) ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos()); if (show_samples && ImGui::BeginTooltip()) { - ImGui::TextUnformatted("(R = radius, N = number of segments)"); + ImGui::TextUnformatted("(R = radius, N = approx number of segments)"); ImGui::Spacing(); ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); - const float min_widget_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("N: MMM\nR: MMM").x; + const float min_widget_width = ImGui::CalcTextSize("R: MMM\nN: MMM").x; for (int n = 0; n < 8; n++) { const float RAD_MIN = 5.0f; @@ -6929,6 +7816,7 @@ void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref) ImGui::BeginGroup(); + // N is not always exact here due to how PathArcTo() function work internally ImGui::Text("R: %.f\nN: %d", rad, draw_list->_CalcCircleAutoSegmentCount(rad)); const float canvas_width = IM_MAX(min_widget_width, rad * 2.0f); @@ -7236,7 +8124,7 @@ struct ExampleAppConsole // Reserve enough left-over height for 1 separator + 1 input text const float footer_height_to_reserve = ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y + ImGui::GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(); - if (ImGui::BeginChild("ScrollingRegion", ImVec2(0, -footer_height_to_reserve), ImGuiChildFlags_None, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar | ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened)) + if (ImGui::BeginChild("ScrollingRegion", ImVec2(0, -footer_height_to_reserve), ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar)) { if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow()) { @@ -7712,56 +8600,128 @@ static void ShowExampleAppLayout(bool* p_open) //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Example App: Property Editor / ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor() //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Some of the interactions are a bit lack-luster: +// - We would want pressing validating or leaving the filter to somehow restore focus. +// - We may want more advanced filtering (child nodes) and clipper support: both will need extra work. +// - We would want to customize some keyboard interactions to easily keyboard navigate between the tree and the properties. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -static void ShowPlaceholderObject(const char* prefix, int uid) +struct ExampleAppPropertyEditor { - // Use object uid as identifier. Most commonly you could also use the object pointer as a base ID. - ImGui::PushID(uid); - - // Text and Tree nodes are less high than framed widgets, using AlignTextToFramePadding() we add vertical spacing to make the tree lines equal high. - ImGui::TableNextRow(); - ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); - ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); - bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode("Object", "%s_%u", prefix, uid); - ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); - ImGui::Text("my sailor is rich"); + ImGuiTextFilter Filter; + ExampleTreeNode* VisibleNode = NULL; - if (node_open) + void Draw(ExampleTreeNode* root_node) { - static float placeholder_members[8] = { 0.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f, 3.1416f, 100.0f, 999.0f }; - for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++) + // Left side: draw tree + // - Currently using a table to benefit from RowBg feature + if (ImGui::BeginChild("##tree", ImVec2(300, 0), ImGuiChildFlags_ResizeX | ImGuiChildFlags_Border | ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened)) { - ImGui::PushID(i); // Use field index as identifier. - if (i < 2) + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::SetNextItemShortcut(ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiKey_F, ImGuiInputFlags_Tooltip); + ImGui::PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus, true); + if (ImGui::InputTextWithHint("##Filter", "incl,-excl", Filter.InputBuf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(Filter.InputBuf), ImGuiInputTextFlags_EscapeClearsAll)) + Filter.Build(); + ImGui::PopItemFlag(); + + if (ImGui::BeginTable("##bg", 1, ImGuiTableFlags_RowBg)) { - ShowPlaceholderObject("Child", 424242); + for (ExampleTreeNode* node : root_node->Childs) + if (Filter.PassFilter(node->Name)) // Filter root node + DrawTreeNode(node); + ImGui::EndTable(); } - else - { - // Here we use a TreeNode to highlight on hover (we could use e.g. Selectable as well) - ImGui::TableNextRow(); - ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(0); - ImGui::AlignTextToFramePadding(); - ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet; - ImGui::TreeNodeEx("Field", flags, "Field_%d", i); + } + ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::TableSetColumnIndex(1); - ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); - if (i >= 5) - ImGui::InputFloat("##value", &placeholder_members[i], 1.0f); - else - ImGui::DragFloat("##value", &placeholder_members[i], 0.01f); - ImGui::NextColumn(); + // Right side: draw properties + ImGui::SameLine(); + + ImGui::BeginGroup(); // Lock X position + if (ExampleTreeNode* node = VisibleNode) + { + ImGui::Text("%s", node->Name); + ImGui::TextDisabled("UID: 0x%08X", node->UID); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::BeginTable("##properties", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY)) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthFixed); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("", ImGuiTableColumnFlags_WidthStretch, 2.0f); // Default twice larger + if (node->HasData) + { + // In a typical application, the structure description would be derived from a data-driven system. + // - We try to mimic this with our ExampleMemberInfo structure and the ExampleTreeNodeMemberInfos[] array. + // - Limits and some details are hard-coded to simplify the demo. + for (const ExampleMemberInfo& field_desc : ExampleTreeNodeMemberInfos) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::PushID(field_desc.Name); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::TextUnformatted(field_desc.Name); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + void* field_ptr = (void*)(((unsigned char*)node) + field_desc.Offset); + switch (field_desc.DataType) + { + case ImGuiDataType_Bool: + { + IM_ASSERT(field_desc.DataCount == 1); + ImGui::Checkbox("##Editor", (bool*)field_ptr); + break; + } + case ImGuiDataType_S32: + { + int v_min = INT_MIN, v_max = INT_MAX; + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::DragScalarN("##Editor", field_desc.DataType, field_ptr, field_desc.DataCount, 1.0f, &v_min, &v_max); + break; + } + case ImGuiDataType_Float: + { + float v_min = 0.0f, v_max = 1.0f; + ImGui::SetNextItemWidth(-FLT_MIN); + ImGui::SliderScalarN("##Editor", field_desc.DataType, field_ptr, field_desc.DataCount, &v_min, &v_max); + break; + } + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } + } + ImGui::EndTable(); } - ImGui::PopID(); } - ImGui::TreePop(); + ImGui::EndGroup(); } - ImGui::PopID(); -} -// Demonstrate create a simple property editor. -// This demo is a bit lackluster nowadays, would be nice to improve. + void DrawTreeNode(ExampleTreeNode* node) + { + ImGui::TableNextRow(); + ImGui::TableNextColumn(); + ImGui::PushID(node->UID); + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags tree_flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None; + tree_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick; // Standard opening mode as we are likely to want to add selection afterwards + tree_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere; // Left arrow support + if (node == VisibleNode) + tree_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected; + if (node->Childs.Size == 0) + tree_flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet; + if (node->DataMyBool == false) + ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, ImGui::GetStyle().Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); + bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNodeEx("", tree_flags, "%s", node->Name); + if (node->DataMyBool == false) + ImGui::PopStyleColor(); + if (ImGui::IsItemFocused()) + VisibleNode = node; + if (node_open) + { + for (ExampleTreeNode* child : node->Childs) + DrawTreeNode(child); + ImGui::TreePop(); + } + ImGui::PopID(); + } +}; + +// Demonstrate creating a simple property editor. static void ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(bool* p_open) { ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(430, 450), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); @@ -7772,25 +8732,10 @@ static void ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(bool* p_open) } IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Examples/Property Editor"); - HelpMarker( - "This example shows how you may implement a property editor using two columns.\n" - "All objects/fields data are dummies here.\n"); + static ExampleAppPropertyEditor property_editor; + static ExampleTreeNode* tree_data = ExampleTree_CreateDemoTree(); + property_editor.Draw(tree_data); - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(2, 2)); - if (ImGui::BeginTable("##split", 2, ImGuiTableFlags_BordersOuter | ImGuiTableFlags_Resizable | ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY)) - { - ImGui::TableSetupScrollFreeze(0, 1); - ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Object"); - ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Contents"); - ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); - - // Iterate placeholder objects (all the same data) - for (int obj_i = 0; obj_i < 4; obj_i++) - ShowPlaceholderObject("Object", obj_i); - - ImGui::EndTable(); - } - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); ImGui::End(); } @@ -8612,6 +9557,7 @@ void ShowExampleAppDocuments(bool* p_open) // Submit Tab Bar and Tabs { ImGuiTabBarFlags tab_bar_flags = (opt_fitting_flags) | (opt_reorderable ? ImGuiTabBarFlags_Reorderable : 0); + tab_bar_flags |= ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline; if (ImGui::BeginTabBar("##tabs", tab_bar_flags)) { if (opt_reorderable) @@ -8739,6 +9685,404 @@ void ShowExampleAppDocuments(bool* p_open) ImGui::End(); } +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Example App: Assets Browser / ShowExampleAppAssetsBrowser() +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +//#include "imgui_internal.h" // NavMoveRequestTryWrapping() + +struct ExampleAsset +{ + ImGuiID ID; + int Type; + + ExampleAsset(ImGuiID id, int type) { ID = id; Type = type; } + + static const ImGuiTableSortSpecs* s_current_sort_specs; + + static void SortWithSortSpecs(ImGuiTableSortSpecs* sort_specs, ExampleAsset* items, int items_count) + { + s_current_sort_specs = sort_specs; // Store in variable accessible by the sort function. + if (items_count > 1) + qsort(items, (size_t)items_count, sizeof(items[0]), ExampleAsset::CompareWithSortSpecs); + s_current_sort_specs = NULL; + } + + // Compare function to be used by qsort() + static int IMGUI_CDECL CompareWithSortSpecs(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) + { + const ExampleAsset* a = (const ExampleAsset*)lhs; + const ExampleAsset* b = (const ExampleAsset*)rhs; + for (int n = 0; n < s_current_sort_specs->SpecsCount; n++) + { + const ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs* sort_spec = &s_current_sort_specs->Specs[n]; + int delta = 0; + if (sort_spec->ColumnIndex == 0) + delta = ((int)a->ID - (int)b->ID); + else if (sort_spec->ColumnIndex == 1) + delta = (a->Type - b->Type); + if (delta > 0) + return (sort_spec->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? +1 : -1; + if (delta < 0) + return (sort_spec->SortDirection == ImGuiSortDirection_Ascending) ? -1 : +1; + } + return ((int)a->ID - (int)b->ID); + } +}; +const ImGuiTableSortSpecs* ExampleAsset::s_current_sort_specs = NULL; + +struct ExampleAssetsBrowser +{ + // Options + bool ShowTypeOverlay = true; + bool AllowSorting = true; + bool AllowDragUnselected = false; + bool AllowBoxSelect = true; + float IconSize = 32.0f; + int IconSpacing = 10; + int IconHitSpacing = 4; // Increase hit-spacing if you want to make it possible to clear or box-select from gaps. Some spacing is required to able to amend with Shift+box-select. Value is small in Explorer. + bool StretchSpacing = true; + + // State + ImVector Items; // Our items + ExampleSelectionWithDeletion Selection; // Our selection (ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage + helper funcs to handle deletion) + ImGuiID NextItemId = 0; // Unique identifier when creating new items + bool RequestDelete = false; // Deferred deletion request + bool RequestSort = false; // Deferred sort request + float ZoomWheelAccum = 0.0f; // Mouse wheel accumulator to handle smooth wheels better + + // Calculated sizes for layout, output of UpdateLayoutSizes(). Could be locals but our code is simpler this way. + ImVec2 LayoutItemSize; + ImVec2 LayoutItemStep; // == LayoutItemSize + LayoutItemSpacing + float LayoutItemSpacing = 0.0f; + float LayoutSelectableSpacing = 0.0f; + float LayoutOuterPadding = 0.0f; + int LayoutColumnCount = 0; + int LayoutLineCount = 0; + + // Functions + ExampleAssetsBrowser() + { + AddItems(10000); + } + void AddItems(int count) + { + if (Items.Size == 0) + NextItemId = 0; + Items.reserve(Items.Size + count); + for (int n = 0; n < count; n++, NextItemId++) + Items.push_back(ExampleAsset(NextItemId, (NextItemId % 20) < 15 ? 0 : (NextItemId % 20) < 18 ? 1 : 2)); + RequestSort = true; + } + void ClearItems() + { + Items.clear(); + Selection.Clear(); + } + + // Logic would be written in the main code BeginChild() and outputing to local variables. + // We extracted it into a function so we can call it easily from multiple places. + void UpdateLayoutSizes(float avail_width) + { + // Layout: when not stretching: allow extending into right-most spacing. + LayoutItemSpacing = (float)IconSpacing; + if (StretchSpacing == false) + avail_width += floorf(LayoutItemSpacing * 0.5f); + + // Layout: calculate number of icon per line and number of lines + LayoutItemSize = ImVec2(floorf(IconSize), floorf(IconSize)); + LayoutColumnCount = IM_MAX((int)(avail_width / (LayoutItemSize.x + LayoutItemSpacing)), 1); + LayoutLineCount = (Items.Size + LayoutColumnCount - 1) / LayoutColumnCount; + + // Layout: when stretching: allocate remaining space to more spacing. Round before division, so item_spacing may be non-integer. + if (StretchSpacing && LayoutColumnCount > 1) + LayoutItemSpacing = floorf(avail_width - LayoutItemSize.x * LayoutColumnCount) / LayoutColumnCount; + + LayoutItemStep = ImVec2(LayoutItemSize.x + LayoutItemSpacing, LayoutItemSize.y + LayoutItemSpacing); + LayoutSelectableSpacing = IM_MAX(floorf(LayoutItemSpacing) - IconHitSpacing, 0.0f); + LayoutOuterPadding = floorf(LayoutItemSpacing * 0.5f); + } + + void Draw(const char* title, bool* p_open) + { + ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(IconSize * 25, IconSize * 15), ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver); + if (!ImGui::Begin(title, p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) + { + ImGui::End(); + return; + } + + // Menu bar + if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) + { + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Add 10000 items")) + AddItems(10000); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Clear items")) + ClearItems(); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close", NULL, false, p_open != NULL)) + *p_open = false; + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Edit")) + { + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Delete", "Del", false, Selection.Size > 0)) + RequestDelete = true; + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Options")) + { + ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetFontSize() * 10); + + ImGui::SeparatorText("Contents"); + ImGui::Checkbox("Show Type Overlay", &ShowTypeOverlay); + ImGui::Checkbox("Allow Sorting", &AllowSorting); + + ImGui::SeparatorText("Selection Behavior"); + ImGui::Checkbox("Allow dragging unselected item", &AllowDragUnselected); + ImGui::Checkbox("Allow box-selection", &AllowBoxSelect); + + ImGui::SeparatorText("Layout"); + ImGui::SliderFloat("Icon Size", &IconSize, 16.0f, 128.0f, "%.0f"); + ImGui::SameLine(); HelpMarker("Use CTRL+Wheel to zoom"); + ImGui::SliderInt("Icon Spacing", &IconSpacing, 0, 32); + ImGui::SliderInt("Icon Hit Spacing", &IconHitSpacing, 0, 32); + ImGui::Checkbox("Stretch Spacing", &StretchSpacing); + ImGui::PopItemWidth(); + ImGui::EndMenu(); + } + ImGui::EndMenuBar(); + } + + // Show a table with ONLY one header row to showcase the idea/possibility of using this to provide a sorting UI + if (AllowSorting) + { + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(0, 0)); + ImGuiTableFlags table_flags_for_sort_specs = ImGuiTableFlags_Sortable | ImGuiTableFlags_SortMulti | ImGuiTableFlags_SizingFixedFit | ImGuiTableFlags_Borders; + if (ImGui::BeginTable("for_sort_specs_only", 2, table_flags_for_sort_specs, ImVec2(0.0f, ImGui::GetFrameHeight()))) + { + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Index"); + ImGui::TableSetupColumn("Type"); + ImGui::TableHeadersRow(); + if (ImGuiTableSortSpecs* sort_specs = ImGui::TableGetSortSpecs()) + if (sort_specs->SpecsDirty || RequestSort) + { + ExampleAsset::SortWithSortSpecs(sort_specs, Items.Data, Items.Size); + sort_specs->SpecsDirty = RequestSort = false; + } + ImGui::EndTable(); + } + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); + } + + ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); + ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(ImVec2(0.0f, LayoutOuterPadding + LayoutLineCount * (LayoutItemSize.x + LayoutItemSpacing))); + if (ImGui::BeginChild("Assets", ImVec2(0.0f, -ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()), ImGuiChildFlags_Border, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove)) + { + ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); + + const float avail_width = ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail().x; + UpdateLayoutSizes(avail_width); + + // Calculate and store start position. + ImVec2 start_pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); + start_pos = ImVec2(start_pos.x + LayoutOuterPadding, start_pos.y + LayoutOuterPadding); + ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(start_pos); + + // Multi-select + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags ms_flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid; + + // - Enable box-select (in 2D mode, so that changing box-select rectangle X1/X2 boundaries will affect clipped items) + if (AllowBoxSelect) + ms_flags |= ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d; + + // - This feature allows dragging an unselected item without selecting it (rarely used) + if (AllowDragUnselected) + ms_flags |= ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease; + + // - Enable keyboard wrapping on X axis + // (FIXME-MULTISELECT: We haven't designed/exposed a general nav wrapping api yet, so this flag is provided as a courtesy to avoid doing: + // ImGui::NavMoveRequestTryWrapping(ImGui::GetCurrentWindow(), ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX); + // When we finish implementing a more general API for this, we will obsolete this flag in favor of the new system) + ms_flags |= ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NavWrapX; + + ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io = ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(ms_flags, Selection.Size, Items.Size); + + // Use custom selection adapter: store ID in selection (recommended) + Selection.UserData = this; + Selection.AdapterIndexToStorageId = [](ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* self_, int idx) { ExampleAssetsBrowser* self = (ExampleAssetsBrowser*)self_->UserData; return self->Items[idx].ID; }; + Selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + + const bool want_delete = (ImGui::Shortcut(ImGuiKey_Delete, ImGuiInputFlags_Repeat) && (Selection.Size > 0)) || RequestDelete; + const int item_curr_idx_to_focus = want_delete ? Selection.ApplyDeletionPreLoop(ms_io, Items.Size) : -1; + RequestDelete = false; + + // Push LayoutSelectableSpacing (which is LayoutItemSpacing minus hit-spacing, if we decide to have hit gaps between items) + // Altering style ItemSpacing may seem unnecessary as we position every items using SetCursorScreenPos()... + // But it is necessary for two reasons: + // - Selectables uses it by default to visually fill the space between two items. + // - The vertical spacing would be measured by Clipper to calculate line height if we didn't provide it explicitly (here we do). + ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(LayoutSelectableSpacing, LayoutSelectableSpacing)); + + // Rendering parameters + const ImU32 icon_type_overlay_colors[3] = { 0, IM_COL32(200, 70, 70, 255), IM_COL32(70, 170, 70, 255) }; + const ImU32 icon_bg_color = ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg); + const ImVec2 icon_type_overlay_size = ImVec2(4.0f, 4.0f); + const bool display_label = (LayoutItemSize.x >= ImGui::CalcTextSize("999").x); + + const int column_count = LayoutColumnCount; + ImGuiListClipper clipper; + clipper.Begin(LayoutLineCount, LayoutItemStep.y); + if (item_curr_idx_to_focus != -1) + clipper.IncludeItemByIndex(item_curr_idx_to_focus / column_count); // Ensure focused item line is not clipped. + if (ms_io->RangeSrcItem != -1) + clipper.IncludeItemByIndex((int)ms_io->RangeSrcItem / column_count); // Ensure RangeSrc item line is not clipped. + while (clipper.Step()) + { + for (int line_idx = clipper.DisplayStart; line_idx < clipper.DisplayEnd; line_idx++) + { + const int item_min_idx_for_current_line = line_idx * column_count; + const int item_max_idx_for_current_line = IM_MIN((line_idx + 1) * column_count, Items.Size); + for (int item_idx = item_min_idx_for_current_line; item_idx < item_max_idx_for_current_line; ++item_idx) + { + ExampleAsset* item_data = &Items[item_idx]; + ImGui::PushID((int)item_data->ID); + + // Position item + ImVec2 pos = ImVec2(start_pos.x + (item_idx % column_count) * LayoutItemStep.x, start_pos.y + line_idx * LayoutItemStep.y); + ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(pos); + + ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(item_idx); + bool item_is_selected = Selection.Contains((ImGuiID)item_data->ID); + bool item_is_visible = ImGui::IsRectVisible(LayoutItemSize); + ImGui::Selectable("", item_is_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags_None, LayoutItemSize); + + // Update our selection state immediately (without waiting for EndMultiSelect() requests) + // because we use this to alter the color of our text/icon. + if (ImGui::IsItemToggledSelection()) + item_is_selected = !item_is_selected; + + // Focus (for after deletion) + if (item_curr_idx_to_focus == item_idx) + ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(-1); + + // Drag and drop + if (ImGui::BeginDragDropSource()) + { + // Create payload with full selection OR single unselected item. + // (the later is only possible when using ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease) + if (ImGui::GetDragDropPayload() == NULL) + { + ImVector payload_items; + void* it = NULL; + ImGuiID id = 0; + if (!item_is_selected) + payload_items.push_back(item_data->ID); + else + while (Selection.GetNextSelectedItem(&it, &id)) + payload_items.push_back(id); + ImGui::SetDragDropPayload("ASSETS_BROWSER_ITEMS", payload_items.Data, (size_t)payload_items.size_in_bytes()); + } + + // Display payload content in tooltip, by extracting it from the payload data + // (we could read from selection, but it is more correct and reusable to read from payload) + const ImGuiPayload* payload = ImGui::GetDragDropPayload(); + const int payload_count = (int)payload->DataSize / (int)sizeof(ImGuiID); + ImGui::Text("%d assets", payload_count); + + ImGui::EndDragDropSource(); + } + + // Render icon (a real app would likely display an image/thumbnail here) + // Because we use ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d, clipping vertical may occasionally be larger, so we coarse-clip our rendering as well. + if (item_is_visible) + { + ImVec2 box_min(pos.x - 1, pos.y - 1); + ImVec2 box_max(box_min.x + LayoutItemSize.x + 2, box_min.y + LayoutItemSize.y + 2); // Dubious + draw_list->AddRectFilled(box_min, box_max, icon_bg_color); // Background color + if (ShowTypeOverlay && item_data->Type != 0) + { + ImU32 type_col = icon_type_overlay_colors[item_data->Type % IM_ARRAYSIZE(icon_type_overlay_colors)]; + draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(box_max.x - 2 - icon_type_overlay_size.x, box_min.y + 2), ImVec2(box_max.x - 2, box_min.y + 2 + icon_type_overlay_size.y), type_col); + } + if (display_label) + { + ImU32 label_col = ImGui::GetColorU32(item_is_selected ? ImGuiCol_Text : ImGuiCol_TextDisabled); + char label[32]; + sprintf(label, "%d", item_data->ID); + draw_list->AddText(ImVec2(box_min.x, box_max.y - ImGui::GetFontSize()), label_col, label); + } + } + + ImGui::PopID(); + } + } + } + clipper.End(); + ImGui::PopStyleVar(); // ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing + + // Context menu + if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow()) + { + ImGui::Text("Selection: %d items", Selection.Size); + ImGui::Separator(); + if (ImGui::MenuItem("Delete", "Del", false, Selection.Size > 0)) + RequestDelete = true; + ImGui::EndPopup(); + } + + ms_io = ImGui::EndMultiSelect(); + Selection.ApplyRequests(ms_io); + if (want_delete) + Selection.ApplyDeletionPostLoop(ms_io, Items, item_curr_idx_to_focus); + + // Zooming with CTRL+Wheel + if (ImGui::IsWindowAppearing()) + ZoomWheelAccum = 0.0f; + if (ImGui::IsWindowHovered() && io.MouseWheel != 0.0f && ImGui::IsKeyDown(ImGuiMod_Ctrl) && ImGui::IsAnyItemActive() == false) + { + ZoomWheelAccum += io.MouseWheel; + if (fabsf(ZoomWheelAccum) >= 1.0f) + { + // Calculate hovered item index from mouse location + // FIXME: Locking aiming on 'hovered_item_idx' (with a cool-down timer) would ensure zoom keeps on it. + const float hovered_item_nx = (io.MousePos.x - start_pos.x + LayoutItemSpacing * 0.5f) / LayoutItemStep.x; + const float hovered_item_ny = (io.MousePos.y - start_pos.y + LayoutItemSpacing * 0.5f) / LayoutItemStep.y; + const int hovered_item_idx = ((int)hovered_item_ny * LayoutColumnCount) + (int)hovered_item_nx; + //ImGui::SetTooltip("%f,%f -> item %d", hovered_item_nx, hovered_item_ny, hovered_item_idx); // Move those 4 lines in block above for easy debugging + + // Zoom + IconSize *= powf(1.1f, (float)(int)ZoomWheelAccum); + IconSize = IM_CLAMP(IconSize, 16.0f, 128.0f); + ZoomWheelAccum -= (int)ZoomWheelAccum; + UpdateLayoutSizes(avail_width); + + // Manipulate scroll to that we will land at the same Y location of currently hovered item. + // - Calculate next frame position of item under mouse + // - Set new scroll position to be used in next ImGui::BeginChild() call. + float hovered_item_rel_pos_y = ((float)(hovered_item_idx / LayoutColumnCount) + fmodf(hovered_item_ny, 1.0f)) * LayoutItemStep.y; + hovered_item_rel_pos_y += ImGui::GetStyle().WindowPadding.y; + float mouse_local_y = io.MousePos.y - ImGui::GetWindowPos().y; + ImGui::SetScrollY(hovered_item_rel_pos_y - mouse_local_y); + } + } + } + ImGui::EndChild(); + + ImGui::Text("Selected: %d/%d items", Selection.Size, Items.Size); + ImGui::End(); + } +}; + +void ShowExampleAppAssetsBrowser(bool* p_open) +{ + IMGUI_DEMO_MARKER("Examples/Assets Browser"); + static ExampleAssetsBrowser assets_browser; + assets_browser.Draw("Example: Assets Browser", p_open); +} + // End of Demo code #else diff --git a/imgui_draw.cpp b/imgui_draw.cpp index d2d9395c581d..d3ed044b5e1e 100644 --- a/imgui_draw.cpp +++ b/imgui_draw.cpp @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (drawing and font code) /* @@ -211,11 +211,13 @@ void ImGui::StyleColorsDark(ImGuiStyle* dst) colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.20f); colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.67f); colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.95f); - colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.80f); colors[ImGuiCol_TabHovered] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; - colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); - colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); - colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelected] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmed] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelected], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline] = ImVec4(0.50f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(0.61f, 0.61f, 0.61f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.43f, 0.35f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); @@ -225,6 +227,7 @@ void ImGui::StyleColorsDark(ImGuiStyle* dst) colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] = ImVec4(0.23f, 0.23f, 0.25f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.06f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextLink] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.35f); colors[ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 0.00f, 0.90f); colors[ImGuiCol_NavHighlight] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 1.00f); @@ -271,11 +274,13 @@ void ImGui::StyleColorsClassic(ImGuiStyle* dst) colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.10f); colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(0.78f, 0.82f, 1.00f, 0.60f); colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(0.78f, 0.82f, 1.00f, 0.90f); - colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.80f); colors[ImGuiCol_TabHovered] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; - colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); - colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); - colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelected] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmed] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelected], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); @@ -285,6 +290,7 @@ void ImGui::StyleColorsClassic(ImGuiStyle* dst) colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.26f, 0.28f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.07f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextLink] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 1.00f, 0.35f); colors[ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 0.00f, 0.90f); colors[ImGuiCol_NavHighlight] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; @@ -332,11 +338,13 @@ void ImGui::StyleColorsLight(ImGuiStyle* dst) colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(0.35f, 0.35f, 0.35f, 0.17f); colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.67f); colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.95f); - colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.90f); colors[ImGuiCol_TabHovered] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; - colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); - colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); - colors[ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_Tab] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Header], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.90f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelected] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive], 0.60f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmed] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_Tab], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.80f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected] = ImLerp(colors[ImGuiCol_TabSelected], colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg], 0.40f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 1.00f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(0.39f, 0.39f, 0.39f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.43f, 0.35f, 1.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); @@ -346,6 +354,7 @@ void ImGui::StyleColorsLight(ImGuiStyle* dst) colors[ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight] = ImVec4(0.68f, 0.68f, 0.74f, 1.00f); // Prefer using Alpha=1.0 here colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); colors[ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt] = ImVec4(0.30f, 0.30f, 0.30f, 0.09f); + colors[ImGuiCol_TextLink] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive]; colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.35f); colors[ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget] = ImVec4(0.26f, 0.59f, 0.98f, 0.95f); colors[ImGuiCol_NavHighlight] = colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered]; diff --git a/imgui_tables.cpp b/imgui_tables.cpp index 0a49bebcfc1d..09ca35f29828 100644 --- a/imgui_tables.cpp +++ b/imgui_tables.cpp @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (tables and columns code) /* @@ -412,8 +412,8 @@ bool ImGui::BeginTableEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, int columns_count, ImG SetNextWindowScroll(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); // Create scrolling region (without border and zero window padding) - ImGuiWindowFlags child_flags = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar : ImGuiWindowFlags_None; - BeginChildEx(name, instance_id, outer_rect.GetSize(), false, child_flags); + ImGuiWindowFlags child_window_flags = (flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar : ImGuiWindowFlags_None; + BeginChildEx(name, instance_id, outer_rect.GetSize(), ImGuiChildFlags_None, child_window_flags); table->InnerWindow = g.CurrentWindow; table->WorkRect = table->InnerWindow->WorkRect; table->OuterRect = table->InnerWindow->Rect(); @@ -437,6 +437,7 @@ bool ImGui::BeginTableEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, int columns_count, ImG // For non-scrolling tables, WorkRect == OuterRect == InnerRect. // But at this point we do NOT have a correct value for .Max.y (unless a height has been explicitly passed in). It will only be updated in EndTable(). table->WorkRect = table->OuterRect = table->InnerRect = outer_rect; + table->HasScrollbarYPrev = table->HasScrollbarYCurr = false; } // Push a standardized ID for both child-using and not-child-using tables @@ -1490,9 +1491,13 @@ void ImGui::EndTable() } else if (temp_data->UserOuterSize.x <= 0.0f) { - const float decoration_size = table->TempData->AngledHeadersExtraWidth + ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? inner_window->ScrollbarSizes.x : 0.0f); - outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x = ImMax(outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x, table->OuterRect.Min.x + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth + decoration_size - temp_data->UserOuterSize.x); - outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.x, ImMin(table->OuterRect.Max.x, table->OuterRect.Min.x + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth)); + // Some references for this: #7651 + tests "table_reported_size", "table_reported_size_outer" equivalent Y block + // - Checking for ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX/ScrollY flag makes us a frame ahead when disabling those flags. + // - FIXME-TABLE: Would make sense to pre-compute expected scrollbar visibility/sizes to generally save a frame of feedback. + const float inner_content_max_x = table->OuterRect.Min.x + table->ColumnsAutoFitWidth; // Slightly misleading name but used for code symmetry with inner_content_max_y + const float decoration_size = table->TempData->AngledHeadersExtraWidth + ((table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY) ? inner_window->ScrollbarSizes.x : 0.0f); + outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x = ImMax(outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.x, inner_content_max_x + decoration_size - temp_data->UserOuterSize.x); + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.x, ImMin(table->OuterRect.Max.x, inner_content_max_x + decoration_size)); } else { @@ -1500,9 +1505,9 @@ void ImGui::EndTable() } if (temp_data->UserOuterSize.y <= 0.0f) { - const float decoration_size = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollY) ? inner_window->ScrollbarSizes.y : 0.0f; + const float decoration_size = (table->Flags & ImGuiTableFlags_ScrollX) ? inner_window->ScrollbarSizes.y : 0.0f; outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.y = ImMax(outer_window->DC.IdealMaxPos.y, inner_content_max_y + decoration_size - temp_data->UserOuterSize.y); - outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.y, ImMin(table->OuterRect.Max.y, inner_content_max_y)); + outer_window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(backup_outer_max_pos.y, ImMin(table->OuterRect.Max.y, inner_content_max_y + decoration_size)); } else { @@ -3264,7 +3269,7 @@ void ImGui::TableAngledHeadersRowEx(ImGuiID row_id, float angle, float max_label ButtonBehavior(row_r, row_id, NULL, NULL); KeepAliveID(row_id); - const float ascent_scaled = g.Font->Ascent * (g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize); // FIXME: Standardize those scaling factors better + const float ascent_scaled = g.Font->Ascent * g.FontScale; // FIXME: Standardize those scaling factors better const float line_off_for_ascent_x = (ImMax((g.FontSize - ascent_scaled) * 0.5f, 0.0f) / -sin_a) * (flip_label ? -1.0f : 1.0f); const ImVec2 padding = g.Style.CellPadding; // We will always use swapped component const ImVec2 align = g.Style.TableAngledHeadersTextAlign; @@ -3466,7 +3471,7 @@ void ImGui::TableDrawDefaultContextMenu(ImGuiTable* table, ImGuiTableFlags flags Separator(); want_separator = true; - PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup, true); + PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups, false); for (int other_column_n = 0; other_column_n < table->ColumnsCount; other_column_n++) { ImGuiTableColumn* other_column = &table->Columns[other_column_n]; diff --git a/imgui_widgets.cpp b/imgui_widgets.cpp index 42a0c13af4c4..d57d39529cd3 100644 --- a/imgui_widgets.cpp +++ b/imgui_widgets.cpp @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (widgets code) /* @@ -19,7 +19,9 @@ Index of this file: // [SECTION] Widgets: TreeNode, CollapsingHeader, etc. // [SECTION] Widgets: Selectable // [SECTION] Widgets: Typing-Select support +// [SECTION] Widgets: Box-Select support // [SECTION] Widgets: Multi-Select support +// [SECTION] Widgets: Multi-Select helpers // [SECTION] Widgets: ListBox // [SECTION] Widgets: PlotLines, PlotHistogram // [SECTION] Widgets: Value helpers @@ -70,6 +72,7 @@ Index of this file: #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning: comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants (typically 0.0f) is ok. #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning: format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code. #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning: implicit conversion changes signedness +#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-macros" // warning: macro is not used // we define snprintf/vsnprintf on Windows so they are available, but not always used. #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant" // warning: zero as null pointer constant // some standard header variations use #define NULL 0 #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function // using printf() is a misery with this as C++ va_arg ellipsis changes float to double. #pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wenum-enum-conversion" // warning: bitwise operation between different enumeration types ('XXXFlags_' and 'XXXFlagsPrivate_') @@ -422,6 +425,7 @@ void ImGui::BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) // - RadioButton() // - ProgressBar() // - Bullet() +// - Hyperlink() //------------------------------------------------------------------------- // The ButtonBehavior() function is key to many interactions and used by many/most widgets. @@ -488,7 +492,7 @@ bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool // Default only reacts to left mouse button if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMask_) == 0) - flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_; + flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft; // Default behavior requires click + release inside bounding box if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnMask_) == 0) @@ -563,8 +567,14 @@ bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool SetActiveID(id, window); g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked; if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus)) + { SetFocusID(id, window); - FocusWindow(window); + FocusWindow(window); + } + else + { + FocusWindow(window, ImGuiFocusRequestFlags_RestoreFocusedChild); // Still need to focus and bring to front, but try to avoid losing NavId when navigating a child + } } if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) || ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseClickedCount[mouse_button_clicked] == 2)) { @@ -573,10 +583,16 @@ bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool ClearActiveID(); else SetActiveID(id, window); // Hold on ID + g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked; if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoNavFocus)) + { SetFocusID(id, window); - g.ActiveIdMouseButton = mouse_button_clicked; - FocusWindow(window); + FocusWindow(window); + } + else + { + FocusWindow(window, ImGuiFocusRequestFlags_RestoreFocusedChild); // Still need to focus and bring to front, but try to avoid losing NavId when navigating a child + } } } if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease) @@ -834,17 +850,15 @@ bool ImGui::CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos) return pressed; // Render - // FIXME: Clarify this mess - ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered); - ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter(); + ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered); if (hovered) - window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, ImMax(2.0f, g.FontSize * 0.5f + 1.0f), col); - - float cross_extent = g.FontSize * 0.5f * 0.7071f - 1.0f; + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, bb.Max, bg_col); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_Compact); ImU32 cross_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); - center -= ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f); - window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent, +cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent, -cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f); - window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent, -cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent, +cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f); + ImVec2 cross_center = bb.GetCenter() - ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f); + float cross_extent = g.FontSize * 0.5f * 0.7071f - 1.0f; + window->DrawList->AddLine(cross_center + ImVec2(+cross_extent, +cross_extent), cross_center + ImVec2(-cross_extent, -cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f); + window->DrawList->AddLine(cross_center + ImVec2(+cross_extent, -cross_extent), cross_center + ImVec2(-cross_extent, +cross_extent), cross_col, 1.0f); return pressed; } @@ -865,7 +879,8 @@ bool ImGui::CollapseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos) ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); if (hovered || held) - window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(bb.GetCenter() + ImVec2(0.0f, -0.5f), g.FontSize * 0.5f + 1.0f, bg_col); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, bb.Max, bg_col); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_Compact); RenderArrow(window->DrawList, bb.Min, text_col, window->Collapsed ? ImGuiDir_Right : ImGuiDir_Down, 1.0f); // Switch to moving the window after mouse is moved beyond the initial drag threshold @@ -1132,42 +1147,60 @@ bool ImGui::Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v) const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; const ImRect total_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f), label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, id)) - { - IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (*v ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0)); - return false; - } + const bool is_visible = ItemAdd(total_bb, id); + const bool is_multi_select = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_IsMultiSelect) != 0; + if (!is_visible) + if (!is_multi_select || !g.BoxSelectState.UnclipMode || !g.BoxSelectState.UnclipRect.Overlaps(total_bb)) // Extra layer of "no logic clip" for box-select support + { + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (*v ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0)); + return false; + } + + // Range-Selection/Multi-selection support (header) + bool checked = *v; + if (is_multi_select) + MultiSelectItemHeader(id, &checked, NULL); bool hovered, held; bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held); - if (pressed) + + // Range-Selection/Multi-selection support (footer) + if (is_multi_select) + MultiSelectItemFooter(id, &checked, &pressed); + else if (pressed) + checked = !checked; + + if (*v != checked) { - *v = !(*v); + *v = checked; + pressed = true; // return value MarkItemEdited(id); } const ImRect check_bb(pos, pos + ImVec2(square_sz, square_sz)); - RenderNavHighlight(total_bb, id); - RenderFrame(check_bb.Min, check_bb.Max, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - ImU32 check_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark); - bool mixed_value = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue) != 0; - if (mixed_value) - { - // Undocumented tristate/mixed/indeterminate checkbox (#2644) - // This may seem awkwardly designed because the aim is to make ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue supported by all widgets (not just checkbox) - ImVec2 pad(ImMax(1.0f, IM_TRUNC(square_sz / 3.6f)), ImMax(1.0f, IM_TRUNC(square_sz / 3.6f))); - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(check_bb.Min + pad, check_bb.Max - pad, check_col, style.FrameRounding); - } - else if (*v) - { - const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, IM_TRUNC(square_sz / 6.0f)); - RenderCheckMark(window->DrawList, check_bb.Min + ImVec2(pad, pad), check_col, square_sz - pad * 2.0f); + const bool mixed_value = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue) != 0; + if (is_visible) + { + RenderNavHighlight(total_bb, id); + RenderFrame(check_bb.Min, check_bb.Max, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); + ImU32 check_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark); + if (mixed_value) + { + // Undocumented tristate/mixed/indeterminate checkbox (#2644) + // This may seem awkwardly designed because the aim is to make ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue supported by all widgets (not just checkbox) + ImVec2 pad(ImMax(1.0f, IM_TRUNC(square_sz / 3.6f)), ImMax(1.0f, IM_TRUNC(square_sz / 3.6f))); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(check_bb.Min + pad, check_bb.Max - pad, check_col, style.FrameRounding); + } + else if (*v) + { + const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, IM_TRUNC(square_sz / 6.0f)); + RenderCheckMark(window->DrawList, check_bb.Min + ImVec2(pad, pad), check_col, square_sz - pad * 2.0f); + } } - - ImVec2 label_pos = ImVec2(check_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, check_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y); + const ImVec2 label_pos = ImVec2(check_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, check_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y); if (g.LogEnabled) LogRenderedText(&label_pos, mixed_value ? "[~]" : *v ? "[x]" : "[ ]"); - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) + if (is_visible && label_size.x > 0.0f) RenderText(label_pos, label); IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checkable | (*v ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Checked : 0)); @@ -1367,6 +1400,76 @@ void ImGui::Bullet() SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f); } +// This is provided as a convenience for being an often requested feature. +// FIXME-STYLE: we delayed adding as there is a larger plan to revamp the styling system. +// Because of this we currently don't provide many styling options for this widget +// (e.g. hovered/active colors are automatically inferred from a single color). +bool ImGui::TextLink(const char* label) +{ + ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); + if (window->SkipItems) + return false; + + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + const char* label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); + + ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; + ImVec2 size = CalcTextSize(label, label_end, true); + ImRect bb(pos, pos + size); + ItemSize(size, 0.0f); + if (!ItemAdd(bb, id)) + return false; + + bool hovered, held; + bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_None); + + ImVec4 text_colf = g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextLink]; + ImVec4 line_colf = text_colf; + { + // FIXME-STYLE: Read comments above. This widget is NOT written in the same style as some earlier widgets, + // as we are currently experimenting/planning a different styling system. + float h, s, v; + ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(text_colf.x, text_colf.y, text_colf.z, h, s, v); + if (held || hovered) + { + v = ImSaturate(v + (held ? 0.4f : 0.3f)); + h = ImFmod(h + 0.02f, 1.0f); + } + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, text_colf.x, text_colf.y, text_colf.z); + v = ImSaturate(v - 0.20f); + ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, line_colf.x, line_colf.y, line_colf.z); + } + + float line_y = bb.Max.y + ImFloor(g.Font->Descent * g.FontScale * 0.20f); + window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, line_y), ImVec2(bb.Max.x, line_y), GetColorU32(line_colf)); // FIXME-TEXT: Underline mode. + + PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GetColorU32(text_colf)); + RenderText(bb.Min, label, label_end); + PopStyleColor(); + + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); + return pressed; +} + +void ImGui::TextLinkOpenURL(const char* label, const char* url) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + if (url == NULL) + url = label; + if (TextLink(label)) + if (g.IO.PlatformOpenInShellFn != NULL) + g.IO.PlatformOpenInShellFn(&g, url); + SetItemTooltip("%s", url); // It is more reassuring for user to _always_ display URL when we same as label + if (BeginPopupContextItem()) + { + if (MenuItem(LocalizeGetMsg(ImGuiLocKey_CopyLink))) + SetClipboardText(url); + EndPopup(); + } +} + //------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Widgets: Low-level Layout helpers //------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -2057,6 +2160,7 @@ static const ImGuiDataTypeInfo GDataTypeInfo[] = #endif { sizeof(float), "float", "%.3f","%f" }, // ImGuiDataType_Float (float are promoted to double in va_arg) { sizeof(double), "double","%f", "%lf" }, // ImGuiDataType_Double + { sizeof(bool), "bool", "%d", "%d" }, // ImGuiDataType_Bool }; IM_STATIC_ASSERT(IM_ARRAYSIZE(GDataTypeInfo) == ImGuiDataType_COUNT); @@ -2141,17 +2245,24 @@ void ImGui::DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* output, const // User can input math operators (e.g. +100) to edit a numerical values. // NB: This is _not_ a full expression evaluator. We should probably add one and replace this dumb mess.. -bool ImGui::DataTypeApplyFromText(const char* buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format) +bool ImGui::DataTypeApplyFromText(const char* buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format, void* p_data_when_empty) { + // Copy the value in an opaque buffer so we can compare at the end of the function if it changed at all. + const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* type_info = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type); + ImGuiDataTypeStorage data_backup; + memcpy(&data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size); + while (ImCharIsBlankA(*buf)) buf++; if (!buf[0]) + { + if (p_data_when_empty != NULL) + { + memcpy(p_data, p_data_when_empty, type_info->Size); + return memcmp(&data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size) != 0; + } return false; - - // Copy the value in an opaque buffer so we can compare at the end of the function if it changed at all. - const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* type_info = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type); - ImGuiDataTypeTempStorage data_backup; - memcpy(&data_backup, p_data, type_info->Size); + } // Sanitize format // - For float/double we have to ignore format with precision (e.g. "%.2f") because sscanf doesn't take them in, so force them into %f and %lf @@ -2298,12 +2409,13 @@ bool ImGui::DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, float v_speed, const { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; const ImGuiAxis axis = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical) ? ImGuiAxis_Y : ImGuiAxis_X; - const bool is_clamped = (v_min < v_max); + const bool is_bounded = (v_min < v_max); + const bool is_wrapped = is_bounded && (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround); const bool is_logarithmic = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic) != 0; const bool is_floating_point = (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) || (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Double); // Default tweak speed - if (v_speed == 0.0f && is_clamped && (v_max - v_min < FLT_MAX)) + if (v_speed == 0.0f && is_bounded && (v_max - v_min < FLT_MAX)) v_speed = (float)((v_max - v_min) * g.DragSpeedDefaultRatio); // Inputs accumulates into g.DragCurrentAccum, which is flushed into the current value as soon as it makes a difference with our precision settings @@ -2337,8 +2449,8 @@ bool ImGui::DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, float v_speed, const // Clear current value on activation // Avoid altering values and clamping when we are _already_ past the limits and heading in the same direction, so e.g. if range is 0..255, current value is 300 and we are pushing to the right side, keep the 300. - bool is_just_activated = g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated; - bool is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward = is_clamped && ((*v >= v_max && adjust_delta > 0.0f) || (*v <= v_min && adjust_delta < 0.0f)); + const bool is_just_activated = g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated; + const bool is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward = is_bounded && !is_wrapped && ((*v >= v_max && adjust_delta > 0.0f) || (*v <= v_min && adjust_delta < 0.0f)); if (is_just_activated || is_already_past_limits_and_pushing_outward) { g.DragCurrentAccum = 0.0f; @@ -2396,13 +2508,24 @@ bool ImGui::DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, float v_speed, const if (v_cur == (TYPE)-0) v_cur = (TYPE)0; - // Clamp values (+ handle overflow/wrap-around for integer types) - if (*v != v_cur && is_clamped) + if (*v != v_cur && is_bounded) { - if (v_cur < v_min || (v_cur > *v && adjust_delta < 0.0f && !is_floating_point)) - v_cur = v_min; - if (v_cur > v_max || (v_cur < *v && adjust_delta > 0.0f && !is_floating_point)) - v_cur = v_max; + if (is_wrapped) + { + // Wrap values + if (v_cur < v_min) + v_cur += v_max - v_min + (is_floating_point ? 0 : 1); + if (v_cur > v_max) + v_cur -= v_max - v_min + (is_floating_point ? 0 : 1); + } + else + { + // Clamp values + handle overflow/wrap-around for integer types. + if (v_cur < v_min || (v_cur > *v && adjust_delta < 0.0f && !is_floating_point)) + v_cur = v_min; + if (v_cur > v_max || (v_cur < *v && adjust_delta > 0.0f && !is_floating_point)) + v_cur = v_max; + } } // Apply result @@ -2415,7 +2538,7 @@ bool ImGui::DragBehaviorT(ImGuiDataType data_type, TYPE* v, float v_speed, const bool ImGui::DragBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) { // Read imgui.cpp "API BREAKING CHANGES" section for 1.78 if you hit this assert. - IM_ASSERT((flags == 1 || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_) == 0) && "Invalid ImGuiSliderFlags flags! Has the 'float power' argument been mistakenly cast to flags? Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead."); + IM_ASSERT((flags == 1 || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_) == 0) && "Invalid ImGuiSliderFlags flags! Has the legacy 'float power' argument been mistakenly cast to flags? Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead."); ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; if (g.ActiveId == id) @@ -3008,7 +3131,8 @@ bool ImGui::SliderBehaviorT(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_typ bool ImGui::SliderBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb) { // Read imgui.cpp "API BREAKING CHANGES" section for 1.78 if you hit this assert. - IM_ASSERT((flags == 1 || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_) == 0) && "Invalid ImGuiSliderFlags flag! Has the 'float power' argument been mistakenly cast to flags? Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead."); + IM_ASSERT((flags == 1 || (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_) == 0) && "Invalid ImGuiSliderFlags flags! Has the legacy 'float power' argument been mistakenly cast to flags? Call function with ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic flags instead."); + IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround) == 0); // Not supported by SliderXXX(), only by DragXXX() switch (data_type) { @@ -3471,11 +3595,11 @@ bool ImGui::TempInputScalar(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImG { // Backup old value size_t data_type_size = type_info->Size; - ImGuiDataTypeTempStorage data_backup; + ImGuiDataTypeStorage data_backup; memcpy(&data_backup, p_data, data_type_size); // Apply new value (or operations) then clamp - DataTypeApplyFromText(data_buf, data_type, p_data, format); + DataTypeApplyFromText(data_buf, data_type, p_data, format, NULL); if (p_clamp_min || p_clamp_max) { if (p_clamp_min && p_clamp_max && DataTypeCompare(data_type, p_clamp_min, p_clamp_max) > 0) @@ -3491,6 +3615,13 @@ bool ImGui::TempInputScalar(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImG return value_changed; } +void ImGui::SetNextItemRefVal(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + g.NextItemData.Flags |= ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasRefVal; + memcpy(&g.NextItemData.RefVal, p_data, DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->Size); +} + // Note: p_data, p_step, p_step_fast are _pointers_ to a memory address holding the data. For an Input widget, p_step and p_step_fast are optional. // Read code of e.g. InputFloat(), InputInt() etc. or examples in 'Demo->Widgets->Data Types' to understand how to use this function directly. bool ImGui::InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_step, const void* p_step_fast, const char* format, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags) @@ -3505,8 +3636,13 @@ bool ImGui::InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data if (format == NULL) format = DataTypeGetInfo(data_type)->PrintFmt; + void* p_data_default = (g.NextItemData.Flags & ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasRefVal) ? &g.NextItemData.RefVal : &g.DataTypeZeroValue; + char buf[64]; - DataTypeFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), data_type, p_data, format); + if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_DisplayEmptyRefVal) && DataTypeCompare(data_type, p_data, p_data_default) == 0) + buf[0] = 0; + else + DataTypeFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), data_type, p_data, format); flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll | (ImGuiInputTextFlags)ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoMarkEdited; // We call MarkItemEdited() ourselves by comparing the actual data rather than the string. flags |= (ImGuiInputTextFlags)ImGuiInputTextFlags_LocalizeDecimalPoint; @@ -3515,7 +3651,7 @@ bool ImGui::InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data if (p_step == NULL) { if (InputText(label, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), flags)) - value_changed = DataTypeApplyFromText(buf, data_type, p_data, format); + value_changed = DataTypeApplyFromText(buf, data_type, p_data, format, (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal) ? p_data_default : NULL); } else { @@ -3525,7 +3661,7 @@ bool ImGui::InputScalar(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data PushID(label); SetNextItemWidth(ImMax(1.0f, CalcItemWidth() - (button_size + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * 2)); if (InputText("", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), flags)) // PushId(label) + "" gives us the expected ID from outside point of view - value_changed = DataTypeApplyFromText(buf, data_type, p_data, format); + value_changed = DataTypeApplyFromText(buf, data_type, p_data, format, (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal) ? p_data_default : NULL); IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(g.LastItemData.ID, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Inputable); // Step buttons @@ -3743,7 +3879,7 @@ namespace ImStb static int STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(const ImGuiInputTextState* obj) { return obj->CurLenW; } static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(const ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int idx) { IM_ASSERT(idx <= obj->CurLenW); return obj->TextW[idx]; } -static float STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int line_start_idx, int char_idx) { ImWchar c = obj->TextW[line_start_idx + char_idx]; if (c == '\n') return IMSTB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE; ImGuiContext& g = *obj->Ctx; return g.Font->GetCharAdvance(c) * (g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize); } +static float STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int line_start_idx, int char_idx) { ImWchar c = obj->TextW[line_start_idx + char_idx]; if (c == '\n') return IMSTB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE; ImGuiContext& g = *obj->Ctx; return g.Font->GetCharAdvance(c) * g.FontScale; } static int STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(int key) { return key >= 0x200000 ? 0 : key; } static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE = '\n'; static void STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(StbTexteditRow* r, ImGuiInputTextState* obj, int line_start_idx) @@ -4177,7 +4313,7 @@ bool ImGui::InputTextEx(const char* label, const char* hint, char* buf, int buf_ PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildRounding, style.FrameRounding); PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildBorderSize, style.FrameBorderSize); PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, ImVec2(0, 0)); // Ensure no clip rect so mouse hover can reach FramePadding edges - bool child_visible = BeginChildEx(label, id, frame_bb.GetSize(), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); + bool child_visible = BeginChildEx(label, id, frame_bb.GetSize(), ImGuiChildFlags_Border, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove); g.NavActivateId = backup_activate_id; PopStyleVar(3); PopStyleColor(); @@ -6089,7 +6225,8 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* label) ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); if (window->SkipItems) return false; - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), 0, label, NULL); + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + return TreeNodeBehavior(id, id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_None, label, NULL); } bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) @@ -6107,8 +6244,8 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); if (window->SkipItems) return false; - - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags, label, NULL); + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + return TreeNodeBehavior(id, id, flags, label, NULL); } bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) @@ -6135,9 +6272,10 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char if (window->SkipItems) return false; + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); const char* label, *label_end; ImFormatStringToTempBufferV(&label, &label_end, fmt, args); - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(str_id), flags, label, label_end); + return TreeNodeBehavior(id, id, flags, label, label_end); } bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) @@ -6146,24 +6284,32 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char if (window->SkipItems) return false; + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(ptr_id); const char* label, *label_end; ImFormatStringToTempBufferV(&label, &label_end, fmt, args); - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(ptr_id), flags, label, label_end); + return TreeNodeBehavior(id, id, flags, label, label_end); +} + +bool ImGui::TreeNodeGetOpen(ImGuiID storage_id) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiStorage* storage = g.CurrentWindow->DC.StateStorage; + return storage->GetInt(storage_id, 0) != 0; } -void ImGui::TreeNodeSetOpen(ImGuiID id, bool open) +void ImGui::TreeNodeSetOpen(ImGuiID storage_id, bool open) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; ImGuiStorage* storage = g.CurrentWindow->DC.StateStorage; - storage->SetInt(id, open ? 1 : 0); + storage->SetInt(storage_id, open ? 1 : 0); } -bool ImGui::TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) +bool ImGui::TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID storage_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) { if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf) return true; - // We only write to the tree storage if the user clicks (or explicitly use the SetNextItemOpen function) + // We only write to the tree storage if the user clicks, or explicitly use the SetNextItemOpen function ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; ImGuiStorage* storage = window->DC.StateStorage; @@ -6174,16 +6320,16 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) if (g.NextItemData.OpenCond & ImGuiCond_Always) { is_open = g.NextItemData.OpenVal; - TreeNodeSetOpen(id, is_open); + TreeNodeSetOpen(storage_id, is_open); } else { // We treat ImGuiCond_Once and ImGuiCond_FirstUseEver the same because tree node state are not saved persistently. - const int stored_value = storage->GetInt(id, -1); + const int stored_value = storage->GetInt(storage_id, -1); if (stored_value == -1) { is_open = g.NextItemData.OpenVal; - TreeNodeSetOpen(id, is_open); + TreeNodeSetOpen(storage_id, is_open); } else { @@ -6193,7 +6339,7 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) } else { - is_open = storage->GetInt(id, (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen) ? 1 : 0) != 0; + is_open = storage->GetInt(storage_id, (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen) ? 1 : 0) != 0; } // When logging is enabled, we automatically expand tree nodes (but *NOT* collapsing headers.. seems like sensible behavior). @@ -6204,7 +6350,24 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) return is_open; } -bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end) +// Store ImGuiTreeNodeStackData for just submitted node. +// Currently only supports 32 level deep and we are fine with (1 << Depth) overflowing into a zero, easy to increase. +static void TreeNodeStoreStackData(ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + g.TreeNodeStack.resize(g.TreeNodeStack.Size + 1); + ImGuiTreeNodeStackData* tree_node_data = &g.TreeNodeStack.back(); + tree_node_data->ID = g.LastItemData.ID; + tree_node_data->TreeFlags = flags; + tree_node_data->InFlags = g.LastItemData.InFlags; + tree_node_data->NavRect = g.LastItemData.NavRect; + window->DC.TreeHasStackDataDepthMask |= (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth); +} + +// When using public API, currently 'id == storage_id' is always true, but we separate the values to facilitate advanced user code doing storage queries outside of UI loop. +bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiID storage_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end) { ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); if (window->SkipItems) @@ -6233,10 +6396,9 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* l frame_bb.Max.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y + frame_height; if (display_frame) { - // Framed header expand a little outside the default padding, to the edge of InnerClipRect - // (FIXME: May remove this at some point and make InnerClipRect align with WindowPadding.x instead of WindowPadding.x*0.5f) - frame_bb.Min.x -= IM_TRUNC(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f - 1.0f); - frame_bb.Max.x += IM_TRUNC(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); + const float outer_extend = IM_TRUNC(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); // Framed header expand a little outside of current limits + frame_bb.Min.x -= outer_extend; + frame_bb.Max.x += outer_extend; } ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x + text_offset_x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + text_offset_y); @@ -6247,46 +6409,45 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* l if ((flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanTextWidth | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAllColumns)) == 0) interact_bb.Max.x = frame_bb.Min.x + text_width + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemSpacing.x * 2.0f : 0.0f); - // Modify ClipRect for the ItemAdd(), faster than doing a PushColumnsBackground/PushTableBackgroundChannel for every Selectable.. - const float backup_clip_rect_min_x = window->ClipRect.Min.x; - const float backup_clip_rect_max_x = window->ClipRect.Max.x; - if (span_all_columns) - { - window->ClipRect.Min.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Min.x; - window->ClipRect.Max.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Max.x; - } - // Compute open and multi-select states before ItemAdd() as it clear NextItem data. - bool is_open = TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(id, flags); - bool item_add = ItemAdd(interact_bb, id); - g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDisplayRect; - g.LastItemData.DisplayRect = frame_bb; + bool is_open = TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(storage_id, flags); + bool is_visible; if (span_all_columns) { + // Modify ClipRect for the ItemAdd(), faster than doing a PushColumnsBackground/PushTableBackgroundChannel for every Selectable.. + const float backup_clip_rect_min_x = window->ClipRect.Min.x; + const float backup_clip_rect_max_x = window->ClipRect.Max.x; + window->ClipRect.Min.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Min.x; + window->ClipRect.Max.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Max.x; + is_visible = ItemAdd(interact_bb, id); window->ClipRect.Min.x = backup_clip_rect_min_x; window->ClipRect.Max.x = backup_clip_rect_max_x; } + else + { + is_visible = ItemAdd(interact_bb, id); + } + g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HasDisplayRect; + g.LastItemData.DisplayRect = frame_bb; // If a NavLeft request is happening and ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere enabled: // Store data for the current depth to allow returning to this node from any child item. // For this purpose we essentially compare if g.NavIdIsAlive went from 0 to 1 between TreeNode() and TreePop(). // It will become tempting to enable ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere by default or move it to ImGuiStyle. - // Currently only supports 32 level deep and we are fine with (1 << Depth) overflowing into a zero, easy to increase. - if (is_open && !g.NavIdIsAlive && (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere) && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) - if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet()) - { - g.NavTreeNodeStack.resize(g.NavTreeNodeStack.Size + 1); - ImGuiNavTreeNodeData* nav_tree_node_data = &g.NavTreeNodeStack.back(); - nav_tree_node_data->ID = id; - nav_tree_node_data->InFlags = g.LastItemData.InFlags; - nav_tree_node_data->NavRect = g.LastItemData.NavRect; - window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask |= (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth); - } + bool store_tree_node_stack_data = false; + if (!(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) + { + if ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere) && is_open && !g.NavIdIsAlive) + if (g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet()) + store_tree_node_stack_data = true; + } const bool is_leaf = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf) != 0; - if (!item_add) + if (!is_visible) { + if (store_tree_node_stack_data && is_open) + TreeNodeStoreStackData(flags); // Call before TreePushOverrideID() if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) TreePushOverrideID(id); IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(g.LastItemData.ID, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | (is_leaf ? 0 : ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable) | (is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0)); @@ -6312,8 +6473,6 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* l const float arrow_hit_x1 = (text_pos.x - text_offset_x) - style.TouchExtraPadding.x; const float arrow_hit_x2 = (text_pos.x - text_offset_x) + (g.FontSize + padding.x * 2.0f) + style.TouchExtraPadding.x; const bool is_mouse_x_over_arrow = (g.IO.MousePos.x >= arrow_hit_x1 && g.IO.MousePos.x < arrow_hit_x2); - if (window != g.HoveredWindow || !is_mouse_x_over_arrow) - button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers; // Open behaviors can be altered with the _OpenOnArrow and _OnOnDoubleClick flags. // Some alteration have subtle effects (e.g. toggle on MouseUp vs MouseDown events) due to requirements for multi-selection and drag and drop support. @@ -6334,6 +6493,24 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* l bool selected = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected) != 0; const bool was_selected = selected; + // Multi-selection support (header) + const bool is_multi_select = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_IsMultiSelect) != 0; + if (is_multi_select) + { + // Handle multi-select + alter button flags for it + MultiSelectItemHeader(id, &selected, &button_flags); + if (is_mouse_x_over_arrow) + button_flags = (button_flags | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) & ~ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease; + + // We absolutely need to distinguish open vs select so comes by default + flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow; + } + else + { + if (window != g.HoveredWindow || !is_mouse_x_over_arrow) + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers; + } + bool hovered, held; bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(interact_bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); bool toggled = false; @@ -6341,7 +6518,7 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* l { if (pressed && g.DragDropHoldJustPressedId != id) { - if ((flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)) == 0 || (g.NavActivateId == id)) + if ((flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)) == 0 || (g.NavActivateId == id && !is_multi_select)) toggled = true; if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow) toggled |= is_mouse_x_over_arrow && !g.NavDisableMouseHover; // Lightweight equivalent of IsMouseHoveringRect() since ButtonBehavior() already did the job @@ -6371,64 +6548,78 @@ bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* l if (toggled) { is_open = !is_open; - window->DC.StateStorage->SetInt(id, is_open); + window->DC.StateStorage->SetInt(storage_id, is_open); g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledOpen; } } - // In this branch, TreeNodeBehavior() cannot toggle the selection so this will never trigger. - if (selected != was_selected) //-V547 + // Multi-selection support (footer) + if (is_multi_select) + { + bool pressed_copy = pressed && !toggled; + MultiSelectItemFooter(id, &selected, &pressed_copy); + if (pressed) + SetNavID(id, window->DC.NavLayerCurrent, g.CurrentFocusScopeId, interact_bb); + } + + if (selected != was_selected) g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection; // Render - const ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); - ImGuiNavHighlightFlags nav_highlight_flags = ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_Compact; - if (display_frame) { - // Framed type - const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, true, style.FrameRounding); - RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) - RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.60f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); - else if (!is_leaf) - RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y), text_col, is_open ? ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_UpsideDownArrow) ? ImGuiDir_Up : ImGuiDir_Down) : ImGuiDir_Right, 1.0f); - else // Leaf without bullet, left-adjusted text - text_pos.x -= text_offset_x -padding.x; - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton) - frame_bb.Max.x -= g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x; - - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogSetNextTextDecoration("###", "###"); - } - else - { - // Unframed typed for tree nodes - if (hovered || selected) + const ImU32 text_col = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text); + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags nav_highlight_flags = ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_Compact; + if (is_multi_select) + nav_highlight_flags |= ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_AlwaysDraw; // Always show the nav rectangle + if (display_frame) { + // Framed type const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, false); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, true, style.FrameRounding); + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.60f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); + else if (!is_leaf) + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y), text_col, is_open ? ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_UpsideDownArrow) ? ImGuiDir_Up : ImGuiDir_Down) : ImGuiDir_Right, 1.0f); + else // Leaf without bullet, left-adjusted text + text_pos.x -= text_offset_x - padding.x; + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton) + frame_bb.Max.x -= g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x; + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration("###", "###"); + } + else + { + // Unframed typed for tree nodes + if (hovered || selected) + { + const ImU32 bg_col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); + RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, bg_col, false); + } + RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); + if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) + RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.5f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); + else if (!is_leaf) + RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.15f), text_col, is_open ? ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_UpsideDownArrow) ? ImGuiDir_Up : ImGuiDir_Down) : ImGuiDir_Right, 0.70f); + if (g.LogEnabled) + LogSetNextTextDecoration(">", NULL); } - RenderNavHighlight(frame_bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) - RenderBullet(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x * 0.5f, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.5f), text_col); - else if (!is_leaf) - RenderArrow(window->DrawList, ImVec2(text_pos.x - text_offset_x + padding.x, text_pos.y + g.FontSize * 0.15f), text_col, is_open ? ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_UpsideDownArrow) ? ImGuiDir_Up : ImGuiDir_Down) : ImGuiDir_Right, 0.70f); - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogSetNextTextDecoration(">", NULL); - } - if (span_all_columns) - TablePopBackgroundChannel(); + if (span_all_columns) + TablePopBackgroundChannel(); - // Label - if (display_frame) - RenderTextClipped(text_pos, frame_bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size); - else - RenderText(text_pos, label, label_end, false); + // Label + if (display_frame) + RenderTextClipped(text_pos, frame_bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size); + else + RenderText(text_pos, label, label_end, false); + } + if (store_tree_node_stack_data && is_open) + TreeNodeStoreStackData(flags); // Call before TreePushOverrideID() if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) - TreePushOverrideID(id); + TreePushOverrideID(id); // Could use TreePush(label) but this avoid computing twice + IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags | (is_leaf ? 0 : ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Openable) | (is_open ? ImGuiItemStatusFlags_Opened : 0)); return is_open; } @@ -6467,16 +6658,19 @@ void ImGui::TreePop() window->DC.TreeDepth--; ImU32 tree_depth_mask = (1 << window->DC.TreeDepth); - // Handle Left arrow to move to parent tree node (when ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere is enabled) - if (window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask & tree_depth_mask) // Only set during request + if (window->DC.TreeHasStackDataDepthMask & tree_depth_mask) // Only set during request { - ImGuiNavTreeNodeData* nav_tree_node_data = &g.NavTreeNodeStack.back(); - IM_ASSERT(nav_tree_node_data->ID == window->IDStack.back()); - if (g.NavIdIsAlive && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet()) - NavMoveRequestResolveWithPastTreeNode(&g.NavMoveResultLocal, nav_tree_node_data); - g.NavTreeNodeStack.pop_back(); + ImGuiTreeNodeStackData* data = &g.TreeNodeStack.back(); + IM_ASSERT(data->ID == window->IDStack.back()); + if (data->TreeFlags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere) + { + // Handle Left arrow to move to parent tree node (when ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere is enabled) + if (g.NavIdIsAlive && g.NavMoveDir == ImGuiDir_Left && g.NavWindow == window && NavMoveRequestButNoResultYet()) + NavMoveRequestResolveWithPastTreeNode(&g.NavMoveResultLocal, data); + } + g.TreeNodeStack.pop_back(); + window->DC.TreeHasStackDataDepthMask &= ~tree_depth_mask; } - window->DC.TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask &= tree_depth_mask - 1; IM_ASSERT(window->IDStack.Size > 1); // There should always be 1 element in the IDStack (pushed during window creation). If this triggers you called TreePop/PopID too much. PopID(); @@ -6497,7 +6691,7 @@ void ImGui::SetNextItemOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiCond cond) return; g.NextItemData.Flags |= ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen; g.NextItemData.OpenVal = is_open; - g.NextItemData.OpenCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always; + g.NextItemData.OpenCond = (ImU8)(cond ? cond : ImGuiCond_Always); } // CollapsingHeader returns true when opened but do not indent nor push into the ID stack (because of the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen flag). @@ -6507,8 +6701,8 @@ bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); if (window->SkipItems) return false; - - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader, label); + ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); + return TreeNodeBehavior(id, id, flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader, label); } // p_visible == NULL : regular collapsing header @@ -6528,7 +6722,7 @@ bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_visible, ImGuiTreeNodeFl flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader; if (p_visible) flags |= ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlap | (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags)ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton; - bool is_open = TreeNodeBehavior(id, flags, label); + bool is_open = TreeNodeBehavior(id, id, flags, label); if (p_visible != NULL) { // Create a small overlapping close button @@ -6588,6 +6782,7 @@ bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags fl const ImVec2 text_max(min_x + size.x, pos.y + size.y); // Selectables are meant to be tightly packed together with no click-gap, so we extend their box to cover spacing between selectable. + // FIXME: Not part of layout so not included in clipper calculation, but ItemSize currently doesn't allow offsetting CursorPos. ImRect bb(min_x, pos.y, text_max.x, text_max.y); if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoPadWithHalfSpacing) == 0) { @@ -6602,25 +6797,29 @@ bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags fl } //if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) { GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); } - // Modify ClipRect for the ItemAdd(), faster than doing a PushColumnsBackground/PushTableBackgroundChannel for every Selectable.. - const float backup_clip_rect_min_x = window->ClipRect.Min.x; - const float backup_clip_rect_max_x = window->ClipRect.Max.x; + const bool disabled_item = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) != 0; + const ImGuiItemFlags extra_item_flags = disabled_item ? (ImGuiItemFlags)ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled : ImGuiItemFlags_None; + bool is_visible; if (span_all_columns) { + // Modify ClipRect for the ItemAdd(), faster than doing a PushColumnsBackground/PushTableBackgroundChannel for every Selectable.. + const float backup_clip_rect_min_x = window->ClipRect.Min.x; + const float backup_clip_rect_max_x = window->ClipRect.Max.x; window->ClipRect.Min.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Min.x; window->ClipRect.Max.x = window->ParentWorkRect.Max.x; - } - - const bool disabled_item = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) != 0; - const bool item_add = ItemAdd(bb, id, NULL, disabled_item ? ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled : ImGuiItemFlags_None); - if (span_all_columns) - { + is_visible = ItemAdd(bb, id, NULL, extra_item_flags); window->ClipRect.Min.x = backup_clip_rect_min_x; window->ClipRect.Max.x = backup_clip_rect_max_x; } + else + { + is_visible = ItemAdd(bb, id, NULL, extra_item_flags); + } - if (!item_add) - return false; + const bool is_multi_select = (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_IsMultiSelect) != 0; + if (!is_visible) + if (!is_multi_select || !g.BoxSelectState.UnclipMode || !g.BoxSelectState.UnclipRect.Overlaps(bb)) // Extra layer of "no logic clip" for box-select support (would be more overhead to add to ItemAdd) + return false; const bool disabled_global = (g.CurrentItemFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled) != 0; if (disabled_item && !disabled_global) // Only testing this as an optimization @@ -6647,20 +6846,35 @@ bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags fl if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick; } if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowOverlap) || (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_AllowOverlap)) { button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlap; } + // Multi-selection support (header) const bool was_selected = selected; + if (is_multi_select) + { + // Handle multi-select + alter button flags for it + MultiSelectItemHeader(id, &selected, &button_flags); + } + bool hovered, held; bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); - // Auto-select when moved into - // - This will be more fully fleshed in the range-select branch - // - This is not exposed as it won't nicely work with some user side handling of shift/control - // - We cannot do 'if (g.NavJustMovedToId != id) { selected = false; pressed = was_selected; }' for two reasons - // - (1) it would require focus scope to be set, need exposing PushFocusScope() or equivalent (e.g. BeginSelection() calling PushFocusScope()) - // - (2) usage will fail with clipped items - // The multi-select API aim to fix those issues, e.g. may be replaced with a BeginSelection() API. - if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnNav) && g.NavJustMovedToId != 0 && g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId == g.CurrentFocusScopeId) - if (g.NavJustMovedToId == id) - selected = pressed = true; + // Multi-selection support (footer) + if (is_multi_select) + { + MultiSelectItemFooter(id, &selected, &pressed); + } + else + { + // Auto-select when moved into + // - This will be more fully fleshed in the range-select branch + // - This is not exposed as it won't nicely work with some user side handling of shift/control + // - We cannot do 'if (g.NavJustMovedToId != id) { selected = false; pressed = was_selected; }' for two reasons + // - (1) it would require focus scope to be set, need exposing PushFocusScope() or equivalent (e.g. BeginSelection() calling PushFocusScope()) + // - (2) usage will fail with clipped items + // The multi-select API aim to fix those issues, e.g. may be replaced with a BeginSelection() API. + if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnNav) && g.NavJustMovedToId != 0 && g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId == g.CurrentFocusScopeId) + if (g.NavJustMovedToId == id) + selected = pressed = true; + } // Update NavId when clicking or when Hovering (this doesn't happen on most widgets), so navigation can be resumed with gamepad/keyboard if (pressed || (hovered && (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SetNavIdOnHover))) @@ -6674,18 +6888,30 @@ bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags fl if (pressed) MarkItemEdited(id); - // In this branch, Selectable() cannot toggle the selection so this will never trigger. - if (selected != was_selected) //-V547 + if (selected != was_selected) g.LastItemData.StatusFlags |= ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ToggledSelection; // Render - if (hovered || selected) + if (is_visible) { - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, false, 0.0f); + if (hovered || selected) + { + // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Styling: Color for 'selected' elements? ImGuiCol_HeaderSelected + ImU32 col; + if (selected && !hovered) + col = GetColorU32(ImLerp(GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_Header), GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered), 0.5f)); + else + col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); + RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, false, 0.0f); + } + if (g.NavId == id) + { + ImGuiNavHighlightFlags nav_highlight_flags = ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_Compact | ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding; + if (is_multi_select) + nav_highlight_flags |= ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_AlwaysDraw; // Always show the nav rectangle + RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, nav_highlight_flags); + } } - if (g.NavId == id) - RenderNavHighlight(bb, id, ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_Compact | ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_NoRounding); if (span_all_columns) { @@ -6695,15 +6921,19 @@ bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags fl PopColumnsBackground(); } - RenderTextClipped(text_min, text_max, label, NULL, &label_size, style.SelectableTextAlign, &bb); + if (is_visible) + RenderTextClipped(text_min, text_max, label, NULL, &label_size, style.SelectableTextAlign, &bb); // Automatically close popups - if (pressed && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups) && !(g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup)) + if (pressed && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoAutoClosePopups) && (g.LastItemData.InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups)) CloseCurrentPopup(); if (disabled_item && !disabled_global) EndDisabled(); + // Selectable() always returns a pressed state! + // Users of BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() scope: you may call ImGui::IsItemToggledSelection() to retrieve + // selection toggle, only useful if you need that state updated (e.g. for rendering purpose) before reaching EndMultiSelect(). IMGUI_TEST_ENGINE_ITEM_INFO(id, label, g.LastItemData.StatusFlags); return pressed; //-V1020 } @@ -6839,7 +7069,7 @@ static int ImStrimatchlen(const char* s1, const char* s1_end, const char* s2) // When SingleCharMode is set: // - it is better to NOT display a tooltip of other on-screen display indicator. // - the index of the currently focused item is required. -// if your SetNextItemSelectionData() values are indices, you can obtain it from ImGuiMultiSelectIO::NavIdItem, otherwise from g.NavLastValidSelectionUserData. +// if your SetNextItemSelectionUserData() values are indices, you can obtain it from ImGuiMultiSelectIO::NavIdItem, otherwise from g.NavLastValidSelectionUserData. int ImGui::TypingSelectFindMatch(ImGuiTypingSelectRequest* req, int items_count, const char* (*get_item_name_func)(void*, int), void* user_data, int nav_item_idx) { if (req == NULL || req->SelectRequest == false) // Support NULL parameter so both calls can be done from same spot. @@ -6909,20 +7139,909 @@ void ImGui::DebugNodeTypingSelectState(ImGuiTypingSelectState* data) #endif } +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Box-Select support +// This has been extracted away from Multi-Select logic in the hope that it could eventually be used elsewhere, but hasn't been yet. +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Extra logic in MultiSelectItemFooter() and ImGuiListClipper::Step() +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - BoxSelectPreStartDrag() [Internal] +// - BoxSelectActivateDrag() [Internal] +// - BoxSelectDeactivateDrag() [Internal] +// - BoxSelectScrollWithMouseDrag() [Internal] +// - BeginBoxSelect() [Internal] +// - EndBoxSelect() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Call on the initial click. +static void BoxSelectPreStartDrag(ImGuiID id, ImGuiSelectionUserData clicked_item) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = &g.BoxSelectState; + bs->ID = id; + bs->IsStarting = true; // Consider starting box-select. + bs->IsStartedFromVoid = (clicked_item == ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid); + bs->KeyMods = g.IO.KeyMods; + bs->StartPosRel = bs->EndPosRel = ImGui::WindowPosAbsToRel(g.CurrentWindow, g.IO.MousePos); + bs->ScrollAccum = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); +} + +static void BoxSelectActivateDrag(ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs, ImGuiWindow* window) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("[selection] BeginBoxSelect() 0X%08X: Activate\n", bs->ID); + bs->IsActive = true; + bs->Window = window; + bs->IsStarting = false; + ImGui::SetActiveID(bs->ID, window); + ImGui::SetActiveIdUsingAllKeyboardKeys(); + if (bs->IsStartedFromVoid && (bs->KeyMods & (ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiMod_Shift)) == 0) + bs->RequestClear = true; +} + +static void BoxSelectDeactivateDrag(ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + bs->IsActive = bs->IsStarting = false; + if (g.ActiveId == bs->ID) + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("[selection] BeginBoxSelect() 0X%08X: Deactivate\n", bs->ID); + ImGui::ClearActiveID(); + } + bs->ID = 0; +} + +static void BoxSelectScrollWithMouseDrag(ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs, ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& inner_r) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + IM_ASSERT(bs->Window == window); + for (int n = 0; n < 2; n++) // each axis + { + const float mouse_pos = g.IO.MousePos[n]; + const float dist = (mouse_pos > inner_r.Max[n]) ? mouse_pos - inner_r.Max[n] : (mouse_pos < inner_r.Min[n]) ? mouse_pos - inner_r.Min[n] : 0.0f; + const float scroll_curr = window->Scroll[n]; + if (dist == 0.0f || (dist < 0.0f && scroll_curr < 0.0f) || (dist > 0.0f && scroll_curr >= window->ScrollMax[n])) + continue; + + const float speed_multiplier = ImLinearRemapClamp(g.FontSize, g.FontSize * 5.0f, 1.0f, 4.0f, ImAbs(dist)); // x1 to x4 depending on distance + const float scroll_step = g.FontSize * 35.0f * speed_multiplier * ImSign(dist) * g.IO.DeltaTime; + bs->ScrollAccum[n] += scroll_step; + + // Accumulate into a stored value so we can handle high-framerate + const float scroll_step_i = ImFloor(bs->ScrollAccum[n]); + if (scroll_step_i == 0.0f) + continue; + if (n == 0) + ImGui::SetScrollX(window, scroll_curr + scroll_step_i); + else + ImGui::SetScrollY(window, scroll_curr + scroll_step_i); + bs->ScrollAccum[n] -= scroll_step_i; + } +} + +bool ImGui::BeginBoxSelect(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID box_select_id, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags ms_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = &g.BoxSelectState; + KeepAliveID(box_select_id); + if (bs->ID != box_select_id) + return false; + + // IsStarting is set by MultiSelectItemFooter() when considering a possible box-select. We validate it here and lock geometry. + bs->UnclipMode = false; + bs->RequestClear = false; + if (bs->IsStarting && IsMouseDragPastThreshold(0)) + BoxSelectActivateDrag(bs, window); + else if ((bs->IsStarting || bs->IsActive) && g.IO.MouseDown[0] == false) + BoxSelectDeactivateDrag(bs); + if (!bs->IsActive) + return false; + + // Current frame absolute prev/current rectangles are used to toggle selection. + // They are derived from positions relative to scrolling space. + const ImRect scope_rect = window->InnerClipRect; + ImVec2 start_pos_abs = WindowPosRelToAbs(window, bs->StartPosRel); + ImVec2 prev_end_pos_abs = WindowPosRelToAbs(window, bs->EndPosRel); // Clamped already + ImVec2 curr_end_pos_abs = g.IO.MousePos; + if (ms_flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow) // Box-select scrolling only happens with ScopeWindow + curr_end_pos_abs = ImClamp(curr_end_pos_abs, scope_rect.Min, scope_rect.Max); + bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Min = ImMin(start_pos_abs, prev_end_pos_abs); + bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Max = ImMax(start_pos_abs, prev_end_pos_abs); + bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Min = ImMin(start_pos_abs, curr_end_pos_abs); + bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Max = ImMax(start_pos_abs, curr_end_pos_abs); + + // Box-select 2D mode detects horizontal changes (vertical ones are already picked by Clipper) + // Storing an extra rect used by widgets supporting box-select. + if (ms_flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d) + if (bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Min.x != bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Min.x || bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Max.x != bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Max.x) + { + bs->UnclipMode = true; + bs->UnclipRect = bs->BoxSelectRectPrev; // FIXME-OPT: UnclipRect x coordinates could be intersection of Prev and Curr rect on X axis. + bs->UnclipRect.Add(bs->BoxSelectRectCurr); + } + + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bs->UnclipRect.Min, bs->UnclipRect.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,0,200), 0.0f, 0, 3.0f); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Min, bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,0,200), 0.0f, 0, 3.0f); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Min, bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Max, IM_COL32(0,255,0,200), 0.0f, 0, 1.0f); + return true; +} + +void ImGui::EndBoxSelect(const ImRect& scope_rect, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags ms_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = &g.BoxSelectState; + IM_ASSERT(bs->IsActive); + bs->UnclipMode = false; + + // Render selection rectangle + bs->EndPosRel = WindowPosAbsToRel(window, ImClamp(g.IO.MousePos, scope_rect.Min, scope_rect.Max)); // Clamp stored position according to current scrolling view + ImRect box_select_r = bs->BoxSelectRectCurr; + box_select_r.ClipWith(scope_rect); + window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(box_select_r.Min, box_select_r.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_SeparatorHovered, 0.30f)); // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Styling + window->DrawList->AddRect(box_select_r.Min, box_select_r.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_NavHighlight)); // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Styling + + // Scroll + const bool enable_scroll = (ms_flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow) && (ms_flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelectNoScroll) == 0; + if (enable_scroll) + { + ImRect scroll_r = scope_rect; + scroll_r.Expand(-g.FontSize); + //GetForegroundDrawList()->AddRect(scroll_r.Min, scroll_r.Max, IM_COL32(0, 255, 0, 255)); + if (!scroll_r.Contains(g.IO.MousePos)) + BoxSelectScrollWithMouseDrag(bs, window, scroll_r); + } +} //------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Widgets: Multi-Select support //------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - DebugLogMultiSelectRequests() [Internal] +// - BeginMultiSelect() +// - EndMultiSelect() +// - SetNextItemSelectionUserData() +// - MultiSelectItemHeader() [Internal] +// - MultiSelectItemFooter() [Internal] +// - DebugNodeMultiSelectState() [Internal] +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +static void DebugLogMultiSelectRequests(const char* function, const ImGuiMultiSelectIO* io) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + for (const ImGuiSelectionRequest& req : io->Requests) + { + if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetAll) IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("[selection] %s: Request: SetAll %d (= %s)\n", function, req.Selected, req.Selected ? "SelectAll" : "Clear"); + if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange) IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("[selection] %s: Request: SetRange %" IM_PRId64 "..%" IM_PRId64 " (0x%" IM_PRIX64 "..0x%" IM_PRIX64 ") = %d (dir %d)\n", function, req.RangeFirstItem, req.RangeLastItem, req.RangeFirstItem, req.RangeLastItem, req.Selected, req.RangeDirection); + } +} + +// Return ImGuiMultiSelectIO structure. +// Lifetime: don't hold on ImGuiMultiSelectIO* pointers over multiple frames or past any subsequent call to BeginMultiSelect() or EndMultiSelect(). +// Passing 'selection_size' and 'items_count' parameters is currently optional. +// - 'selection_size' is useful to disable some shortcut routing: e.g. ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape won't claim Escape key when selection_size 0, +// allowing a first press to clear selection THEN the second press to leave child window and return to parent. +// - 'items_count' is stored in ImGuiMultiSelectIO which makes it a convenient way to pass the information to your ApplyRequest() handler (but you may pass it differently). +// - If they are costly for you to compute (e.g. external intrusive selection without maintaining size), you may avoid them and pass -1. +// - If you can easily tell if your selection is empty or not, you may pass 0/1, or you may enable ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape flag dynamically. +ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ImGui::BeginMultiSelect(ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags, int selection_size, int items_count) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + if (++g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked > g.MultiSelectTempData.Size) + g.MultiSelectTempData.resize(g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked, ImGuiMultiSelectTempData()); + ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms = &g.MultiSelectTempData[g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked - 1]; + IM_STATIC_ASSERT(offsetof(ImGuiMultiSelectTempData, IO) == 0); // Clear() relies on that. + g.CurrentMultiSelect = ms; + if ((flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect)) == 0) + flags |= ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow; + if (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect) + flags &= ~(ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d); + if (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d) + flags &= ~ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d; + + // FIXME: BeginFocusScope() + const ImGuiID id = window->IDStack.back(); + ms->Clear(); + ms->FocusScopeId = id; + ms->Flags = flags; + ms->IsFocused = (ms->FocusScopeId == g.NavFocusScopeId); + ms->BackupCursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos; + ms->ScopeRectMin = window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorPos; + PushFocusScope(ms->FocusScopeId); + if (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow) // Mark parent child window as navigable into, with highlight. Assume user will always submit interactive items. + window->DC.NavLayersActiveMask |= 1 << ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + + // Use copy of keyboard mods at the time of the request, otherwise we would requires mods to be held for an extra frame. + ms->KeyMods = g.NavJustMovedToId ? (g.NavJustMovedToIsTabbing ? 0 : g.NavJustMovedToKeyMods) : g.IO.KeyMods; + if (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect) + ms->KeyMods &= ~ImGuiMod_Shift; + + // Bind storage + ImGuiMultiSelectState* storage = g.MultiSelectStorage.GetOrAddByKey(id); + storage->ID = id; + storage->LastFrameActive = g.FrameCount; + storage->LastSelectionSize = selection_size; + storage->Window = window; + ms->Storage = storage; + + // Output to user + ms->IO.Requests.resize(0); + ms->IO.RangeSrcItem = storage->RangeSrcItem; + ms->IO.NavIdItem = storage->NavIdItem; + ms->IO.NavIdSelected = (storage->NavIdSelected == 1) ? true : false; + ms->IO.ItemsCount = items_count; + + // Clear when using Navigation to move within the scope + // (we compare FocusScopeId so it possible to use multiple selections inside a same window) + bool request_clear = false; + bool request_select_all = false; + if (g.NavJustMovedToId != 0 && g.NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId == ms->FocusScopeId && g.NavJustMovedToHasSelectionData) + { + if (ms->KeyMods & ImGuiMod_Shift) + ms->IsKeyboardSetRange = true; + if (ms->IsKeyboardSetRange) + IM_ASSERT(storage->RangeSrcItem != ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid); // Not ready -> could clear? + if ((ms->KeyMods & (ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiMod_Shift)) == 0 && (flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect)) == 0) + request_clear = true; + } + else if (g.NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId == ms->FocusScopeId) + { + // Also clear on leaving scope (may be optional?) + if ((ms->KeyMods & (ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiMod_Shift)) == 0 && (flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect)) == 0) + request_clear = true; + } + + // Box-select handling: update active state. + ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = &g.BoxSelectState; + if (flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d)) + { + ms->BoxSelectId = GetID("##BoxSelect"); + if (BeginBoxSelect(window, ms->BoxSelectId, flags)) + request_clear |= bs->RequestClear; + } + + if (ms->IsFocused) + { + // Shortcut: Clear selection (Escape) + // - Only claim shortcut if selection is not empty, allowing further presses on Escape to e.g. leave current child window. + // - Box select also handle Escape and needs to pass an id to bypass ActiveIdUsingAllKeyboardKeys lock. + if (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape) + { + if (selection_size != 0 || bs->IsActive) + if (Shortcut(ImGuiKey_Escape, ImGuiInputFlags_None, bs->IsActive ? bs->ID : 0)) + { + request_clear = true; + if (bs->IsActive) + BoxSelectDeactivateDrag(bs); + } + } + + // Shortcut: Select all (CTRL+A) + if (!(flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect) && !(flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoSelectAll)) + if (Shortcut(ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiKey_A)) + request_select_all = true; + } + + if (request_clear || request_select_all) + { + MultiSelectAddSetAll(ms, request_select_all); + if (!request_select_all) + storage->LastSelectionSize = 0; + } + ms->LoopRequestSetAll = request_select_all ? 1 : request_clear ? 0 : -1; + ms->LastSubmittedItem = ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid; + + if (g.DebugLogFlags & ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventSelection) + DebugLogMultiSelectRequests("BeginMultiSelect", &ms->IO); + + return &ms->IO; +} + +// Return updated ImGuiMultiSelectIO structure. +// Lifetime: don't hold on ImGuiMultiSelectIO* pointers over multiple frames or past any subsequent call to BeginMultiSelect() or EndMultiSelect(). +ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ImGui::EndMultiSelect() +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms = g.CurrentMultiSelect; + ImGuiMultiSelectState* storage = ms->Storage; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + IM_ASSERT(ms->FocusScopeId == g.CurrentFocusScopeId); + IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentMultiSelect != NULL && storage->Window == g.CurrentWindow); + IM_ASSERT(g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked > 0 && &g.MultiSelectTempData[g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked - 1] == g.CurrentMultiSelect); + + const ImRect scope_rect = (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect) ? ImRect(ms->ScopeRectMin, ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, ms->ScopeRectMin)) : window->InnerClipRect; + if (ms->IsFocused) + { + // We currently don't allow user code to modify RangeSrcItem by writing to BeginIO's version, but that would be an easy change here. + if (ms->IO.RangeSrcReset || (ms->RangeSrcPassedBy == false && ms->IO.RangeSrcItem != ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid)) // Can't read storage->RangeSrcItem here -> we want the state at begining of the scope (see tests for easy failure) + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("[selection] EndMultiSelect: Reset RangeSrcItem.\n"); // Will set be to NavId. + storage->RangeSrcItem = ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid; + } + if (ms->NavIdPassedBy == false && storage->NavIdItem != ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid) + { + IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("[selection] EndMultiSelect: Reset NavIdItem.\n"); + storage->NavIdItem = ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid; + storage->NavIdSelected = -1; + } + + if ((ms->Flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d)) && GetBoxSelectState(ms->BoxSelectId)) + EndBoxSelect(scope_rect, ms->Flags); + } + + if (ms->IsEndIO == false) + ms->IO.Requests.resize(0); + + // Clear selection when clicking void? + // We specifically test for IsMouseDragPastThreshold(0) == false to allow box-selection! + // The InnerRect test is necessary for non-child/decorated windows. + bool scope_hovered = IsWindowHovered() && window->InnerRect.Contains(g.IO.MousePos); + if (scope_hovered && (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect)) + scope_hovered &= scope_rect.Contains(g.IO.MousePos); + if (scope_hovered && g.HoveredId == 0 && g.ActiveId == 0) + { + if (ms->Flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d)) + { + if (!g.BoxSelectState.IsActive && !g.BoxSelectState.IsStarting && g.IO.MouseClickedCount[0] == 1) + { + BoxSelectPreStartDrag(ms->BoxSelectId, ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid); + FocusWindow(window, ImGuiFocusRequestFlags_UnlessBelowModal); + SetHoveredID(ms->BoxSelectId); + if (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect) + SetNavID(0, ImGuiNavLayer_Main, ms->FocusScopeId, ImRect(g.IO.MousePos, g.IO.MousePos)); // Automatically switch FocusScope for initial click from void to box-select. + } + } + + if (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid) + if (IsMouseReleased(0) && IsMouseDragPastThreshold(0) == false && g.IO.KeyMods == ImGuiMod_None) + MultiSelectAddSetAll(ms, false); + } + + // Courtesy nav wrapping helper flag + if (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NavWrapX) + { + IM_ASSERT(ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow); // Only supported at window scope + ImGui::NavMoveRequestTryWrapping(ImGui::GetCurrentWindow(), ImGuiNavMoveFlags_WrapX); + } + + // Unwind + window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(ms->BackupCursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos); + PopFocusScope(); + + if (g.DebugLogFlags & ImGuiDebugLogFlags_EventSelection) + DebugLogMultiSelectRequests("EndMultiSelect", &ms->IO); + + ms->FocusScopeId = 0; + ms->Flags = ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_None; + g.CurrentMultiSelect = (--g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked > 0) ? &g.MultiSelectTempData[g.MultiSelectTempDataStacked - 1] : NULL; + + return &ms->IO; +} void ImGui::SetNextItemSelectionUserData(ImGuiSelectionUserData selection_user_data) { // Note that flags will be cleared by ItemAdd(), so it's only useful for Navigation code! // This designed so widgets can also cheaply set this before calling ItemAdd(), so we are not tied to MultiSelect api. ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.NextItemData.ItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData; g.NextItemData.SelectionUserData = selection_user_data; + g.NextItemData.FocusScopeId = g.CurrentFocusScopeId; + + if (ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms = g.CurrentMultiSelect) + { + // Auto updating RangeSrcPassedBy for cases were clipper is not used (done before ItemAdd() clipping) + g.NextItemData.ItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData | ImGuiItemFlags_IsMultiSelect; + if (ms->IO.RangeSrcItem == selection_user_data) + ms->RangeSrcPassedBy = true; + } + else + { + g.NextItemData.ItemFlags |= ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData; + } +} + +// In charge of: +// - Applying SetAll for submitted items. +// - Applying SetRange for submitted items and record end points. +// - Altering button behavior flags to facilitate use with drag and drop. +void ImGui::MultiSelectItemHeader(ImGuiID id, bool* p_selected, ImGuiButtonFlags* p_button_flags) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms = g.CurrentMultiSelect; + + bool selected = *p_selected; + if (ms->IsFocused) + { + ImGuiMultiSelectState* storage = ms->Storage; + ImGuiSelectionUserData item_data = g.NextItemData.SelectionUserData; + IM_ASSERT(g.NextItemData.FocusScopeId == g.CurrentFocusScopeId && "Forgot to call SetNextItemSelectionUserData() prior to item, required in BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() scope"); + + // Apply SetAll (Clear/SelectAll) requests requested by BeginMultiSelect(). + // This is only useful if the user hasn't processed them already, and this only works if the user isn't using the clipper. + // If you are using a clipper you need to process the SetAll request after calling BeginMultiSelect() + if (ms->LoopRequestSetAll != -1) + selected = (ms->LoopRequestSetAll == 1); + + // When using SHIFT+Nav: because it can incur scrolling we cannot afford a frame of lag with the selection highlight (otherwise scrolling would happen before selection) + // For this to work, we need someone to set 'RangeSrcPassedBy = true' at some point (either clipper either SetNextItemSelectionUserData() function) + if (ms->IsKeyboardSetRange) + { + IM_ASSERT(id != 0 && (ms->KeyMods & ImGuiMod_Shift) != 0); + const bool is_range_dst = (ms->RangeDstPassedBy == false) && g.NavJustMovedToId == id; // Assume that g.NavJustMovedToId is not clipped. + if (is_range_dst) + ms->RangeDstPassedBy = true; + if (is_range_dst && storage->RangeSrcItem == ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid) // If we don't have RangeSrc, assign RangeSrc = RangeDst + { + storage->RangeSrcItem = item_data; + storage->RangeSelected = selected ? 1 : 0; + } + const bool is_range_src = storage->RangeSrcItem == item_data; + if (is_range_src || is_range_dst || ms->RangeSrcPassedBy != ms->RangeDstPassedBy) + { + // Apply range-select value to visible items + IM_ASSERT(storage->RangeSrcItem != ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid && storage->RangeSelected != -1); + selected = (storage->RangeSelected != 0); + } + else if ((ms->KeyMods & ImGuiMod_Ctrl) == 0 && (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear) == 0) + { + // Clear other items + selected = false; + } + } + *p_selected = selected; + } + + // Alter button behavior flags + // To handle drag and drop of multiple items we need to avoid clearing selection on click. + // Enabling this test makes actions using CTRL+SHIFT delay their effect on MouseUp which is annoying, but it allows drag and drop of multiple items. + if (p_button_flags != NULL) + { + ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = *p_button_flags; + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_NoHoveredOnFocus; + if ((!selected || (g.ActiveId == id && g.ActiveIdHasBeenPressedBefore)) && !(ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease)) + button_flags = (button_flags | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) & ~ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease; + else + button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease; + *p_button_flags = button_flags; + } +} + +// In charge of: +// - Auto-select on navigation. +// - Box-select toggle handling. +// - Right-click handling. +// - Altering selection based on Ctrl/Shift modifiers, both for keyboard and mouse. +// - Record current selection state for RangeSrc +// This is all rather complex, best to run and refer to "widgets_multiselect_xxx" tests in imgui_test_suite. +void ImGui::MultiSelectItemFooter(ImGuiID id, bool* p_selected, bool* p_pressed) +{ + ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; + ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; + + bool selected = *p_selected; + bool pressed = *p_pressed; + ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms = g.CurrentMultiSelect; + ImGuiMultiSelectState* storage = ms->Storage; + if (pressed) + ms->IsFocused = true; + + bool hovered = false; + if (g.LastItemData.StatusFlags & ImGuiItemStatusFlags_HoveredRect) + hovered = IsItemHovered(ImGuiHoveredFlags_AllowWhenBlockedByPopup); + if (!ms->IsFocused && !hovered) + return; + + ImGuiSelectionUserData item_data = g.NextItemData.SelectionUserData; + + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags = ms->Flags; + const bool is_singleselect = (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect) != 0; + bool is_ctrl = (ms->KeyMods & ImGuiMod_Ctrl) != 0; + bool is_shift = (ms->KeyMods & ImGuiMod_Shift) != 0; + + bool apply_to_range_src = false; + + if (g.NavId == id && storage->RangeSrcItem == ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid) + apply_to_range_src = true; + if (ms->IsEndIO == false) + { + ms->IO.Requests.resize(0); + ms->IsEndIO = true; + } + + // Auto-select as you navigate a list + if (g.NavJustMovedToId == id) + { + if ((flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect) == 0) + { + if (is_ctrl && is_shift) + pressed = true; + else if (!is_ctrl) + selected = pressed = true; + } + else + { + // With NoAutoSelect, using Shift+keyboard performs a write/copy + if (is_shift) + pressed = true; + else if (!is_ctrl) + apply_to_range_src = true; // Since if (pressed) {} main block is not running we update this + } + } + + if (apply_to_range_src) + { + storage->RangeSrcItem = item_data; + storage->RangeSelected = selected; // Will be updated at the end of this function anyway. + } + + // Box-select toggle handling + if (ms->BoxSelectId != 0) + if (ImGuiBoxSelectState* bs = GetBoxSelectState(ms->BoxSelectId)) + { + const bool rect_overlap_curr = bs->BoxSelectRectCurr.Overlaps(g.LastItemData.Rect); + const bool rect_overlap_prev = bs->BoxSelectRectPrev.Overlaps(g.LastItemData.Rect); + if ((rect_overlap_curr && !rect_overlap_prev && !selected) || (rect_overlap_prev && !rect_overlap_curr)) + { + if (storage->LastSelectionSize <= 0 && bs->IsStartedFromVoid) + { + pressed = true; // First item act as a pressed: code below will emit selection request and set NavId (whatever we emit here will be overridden anyway) + } + else + { + selected = !selected; + MultiSelectAddSetRange(ms, selected, +1, item_data, item_data); + } + storage->LastSelectionSize = ImMax(storage->LastSelectionSize + 1, 1); + } + } + + // Right-click handling. + // FIXME-MULTISELECT: Currently filtered out by ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect but maybe should be moved to Selectable(). See https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/pull/5816 + if (hovered && IsMouseClicked(1) && (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect) == 0) + { + if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveId != id) + ClearActiveID(); + SetFocusID(id, window); + if (!pressed && !selected) + { + pressed = true; + is_ctrl = is_shift = false; + } + } + + // Unlike Space, Enter doesn't alter selection (but can still return a press) unless current item is not selected. + // The later, "unless current item is not select", may become optional? It seems like a better default if Enter doesn't necessarily open something + // (unlike e.g. Windows explorer). For use case where Enter always open something, we might decide to make this optional? + const bool enter_pressed = pressed && (g.NavActivateId == id) && (g.NavActivateFlags & ImGuiActivateFlags_PreferInput); + + // Alter selection + if (pressed && (!enter_pressed || !selected)) + { + // Box-select + ImGuiInputSource input_source = (g.NavJustMovedToId == id || g.NavActivateId == id) ? g.NavInputSource : ImGuiInputSource_Mouse; + if (flags & (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d | ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d)) + if (selected == false && !g.BoxSelectState.IsActive && !g.BoxSelectState.IsStarting && input_source == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse && g.IO.MouseClickedCount[0] == 1) + BoxSelectPreStartDrag(ms->BoxSelectId, item_data); + + //---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + // ACTION | Begin | Pressed/Activated | End + //---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + // Keys Navigated: | Clear | Src=item, Sel=1 SetRange 1 + // Keys Navigated: Ctrl | n/a | n/a + // Keys Navigated: Shift | n/a | Dst=item, Sel=1, => Clear + SetRange 1 + // Keys Navigated: Ctrl+Shift | n/a | Dst=item, Sel=Src => Clear + SetRange Src-Dst + // Keys Activated: | n/a | Src=item, Sel=1 => Clear + SetRange 1 + // Keys Activated: Ctrl | n/a | Src=item, Sel=!Sel => SetSange 1 + // Keys Activated: Shift | n/a | Dst=item, Sel=1 => Clear + SetSange 1 + //---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + // Mouse Pressed: | n/a | Src=item, Sel=1, => Clear + SetRange 1 + // Mouse Pressed: Ctrl | n/a | Src=item, Sel=!Sel => SetRange 1 + // Mouse Pressed: Shift | n/a | Dst=item, Sel=1, => Clear + SetRange 1 + // Mouse Pressed: Ctrl+Shift | n/a | Dst=item, Sel=!Sel => SetRange Src-Dst + //---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + if ((flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear) == 0) + { + bool request_clear = false; + if (is_singleselect) + request_clear = true; + else if ((input_source == ImGuiInputSource_Mouse || g.NavActivateId == id) && !is_ctrl) + request_clear = (flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClearOnReselect) ? !selected : true; + else if ((input_source == ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard || input_source == ImGuiInputSource_Gamepad) && is_shift && !is_ctrl) + request_clear = true; // With is_shift==false the RequestClear was done in BeginIO, not necessary to do again. + if (request_clear) + MultiSelectAddSetAll(ms, false); + } + + int range_direction; + bool range_selected; + if (is_shift && !is_singleselect) + { + //IM_ASSERT(storage->HasRangeSrc && storage->HasRangeValue); + if (storage->RangeSrcItem == ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid) + storage->RangeSrcItem = item_data; + if ((flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect) == 0) + { + // Shift+Arrow always select + // Ctrl+Shift+Arrow copy source selection state (already stored by BeginMultiSelect() in storage->RangeSelected) + range_selected = (is_ctrl && storage->RangeSelected != -1) ? (storage->RangeSelected != 0) : true; + } + else + { + // Shift+Arrow copy source selection state + // Shift+Click always copy from target selection state + if (ms->IsKeyboardSetRange) + range_selected = (storage->RangeSelected != -1) ? (storage->RangeSelected != 0) : true; + else + range_selected = !selected; + } + range_direction = ms->RangeSrcPassedBy ? +1 : -1; + } + else + { + // Ctrl inverts selection, otherwise always select + if ((flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect) == 0) + selected = is_ctrl ? !selected : true; + else + selected = !selected; + storage->RangeSrcItem = item_data; + range_selected = selected; + range_direction = +1; + } + MultiSelectAddSetRange(ms, range_selected, range_direction, storage->RangeSrcItem, item_data); + } + + // Update/store the selection state of the Source item (used by CTRL+SHIFT, when Source is unselected we perform a range unselect) + if (storage->RangeSrcItem == item_data) + storage->RangeSelected = selected ? 1 : 0; + + // Update/store the selection state of focused item + if (g.NavId == id) + { + storage->NavIdItem = item_data; + storage->NavIdSelected = selected ? 1 : 0; + } + if (storage->NavIdItem == item_data) + ms->NavIdPassedBy = true; + ms->LastSubmittedItem = item_data; + + *p_selected = selected; + *p_pressed = pressed; +} + +void ImGui::MultiSelectAddSetAll(ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms, bool selected) +{ + ImGuiSelectionRequest req = { ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetAll, selected, 0, ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid, ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid }; + ms->IO.Requests.resize(0); // Can always clear previous requests + ms->IO.Requests.push_back(req); // Add new request +} + +void ImGui::MultiSelectAddSetRange(ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms, bool selected, int range_dir, ImGuiSelectionUserData first_item, ImGuiSelectionUserData last_item) +{ + // Merge contiguous spans into same request (unless NoRangeSelect is set which guarantees single-item ranges) + if (ms->IO.Requests.Size > 0 && first_item == last_item && (ms->Flags & ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect) == 0) + { + ImGuiSelectionRequest* prev = &ms->IO.Requests.Data[ms->IO.Requests.Size - 1]; + if (prev->Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange && prev->RangeLastItem == ms->LastSubmittedItem && prev->Selected == selected) + { + prev->RangeLastItem = last_item; + return; + } + } + + ImGuiSelectionRequest req = { ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange, selected, (ImS8)range_dir, (range_dir > 0) ? first_item : last_item, (range_dir > 0) ? last_item : first_item }; + ms->IO.Requests.push_back(req); // Add new request +} + +void ImGui::DebugNodeMultiSelectState(ImGuiMultiSelectState* storage) +{ +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEBUG_TOOLS + const bool is_active = (storage->LastFrameActive >= GetFrameCount() - 2); // Note that fully clipped early out scrolling tables will appear as inactive here. + if (!is_active) { PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GetStyleColorVec4(ImGuiCol_TextDisabled)); } + bool open = TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)storage->ID, "MultiSelect 0x%08X in '%s'%s", storage->ID, storage->Window ? storage->Window->Name : "N/A", is_active ? "" : " *Inactive*"); + if (!is_active) { PopStyleColor(); } + if (!open) + return; + Text("RangeSrcItem = %" IM_PRId64 " (0x%" IM_PRIX64 "), RangeSelected = %d", storage->RangeSrcItem, storage->RangeSrcItem, storage->RangeSelected); + Text("NavIdItem = %" IM_PRId64 " (0x%" IM_PRIX64 "), NavIdSelected = %d", storage->NavIdItem, storage->NavIdItem, storage->NavIdSelected); + Text("LastSelectionSize = %d", storage->LastSelectionSize); // Provided by user + TreePop(); +#else + IM_UNUSED(storage); +#endif } +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Widgets: Multi-Select helpers +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// - ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage +// - ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage() +{ + Size = 0; + PreserveOrder = false; + UserData = NULL; + AdapterIndexToStorageId = [](ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage*, int idx) { return (ImGuiID)idx; }; + _SelectionOrder = 1; // Always >0 +} + +void ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::Clear() +{ + Size = 0; + _SelectionOrder = 1; // Always >0 + _Storage.Data.resize(0); +} + +void ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::Swap(ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage& r) +{ + ImSwap(Size, r.Size); + ImSwap(_SelectionOrder, r._SelectionOrder); + _Storage.Data.swap(r._Storage.Data); +} + +bool ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::Contains(ImGuiID id) const +{ + return _Storage.GetInt(id, 0) != 0; +} + +static int IMGUI_CDECL PairComparerByValueInt(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) +{ + int lhs_v = ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)lhs)->val_i; + int rhs_v = ((const ImGuiStoragePair*)rhs)->val_i; + return (lhs_v > rhs_v ? +1 : lhs_v < rhs_v ? -1 : 0); +} + +// GetNextSelectedItem() is an abstraction allowing us to change our underlying actual storage system without impacting user. +// (e.g. store unselected vs compact down, compact down on demand, use raw ImVector instead of ImGuiStorage...) +bool ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::GetNextSelectedItem(void** opaque_it, ImGuiID* out_id) +{ + ImGuiStoragePair* it = (ImGuiStoragePair*)*opaque_it; + ImGuiStoragePair* it_end = _Storage.Data.Data + _Storage.Data.Size; + if (PreserveOrder && it == NULL && it_end != NULL) + ImQsort(_Storage.Data.Data, (size_t)_Storage.Data.Size, sizeof(ImGuiStoragePair), PairComparerByValueInt); // ~ImGuiStorage::BuildSortByValueInt() + if (it == NULL) + it = _Storage.Data.Data; + IM_ASSERT(it >= _Storage.Data.Data && it <= it_end); + if (it != it_end) + while (it->val_i == 0 && it < it_end) + it++; + const bool has_more = (it != it_end); + *opaque_it = has_more ? (void**)(it + 1) : (void**)(it); + *out_id = has_more ? it->key : 0; + if (PreserveOrder && !has_more) + _Storage.BuildSortByKey(); + return has_more; +} + +void ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::SetItemSelected(ImGuiID id, bool selected) +{ + int* p_int = _Storage.GetIntRef(id, 0); + if (selected && *p_int == 0) { *p_int = _SelectionOrder++; Size++; } + else if (!selected && *p_int != 0) { *p_int = 0; Size--; } +} + +// Optimized for batch edits (with same value of 'selected') +static void ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchSetItemSelected(ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* selection, ImGuiID id, bool selected, int size_before_amends, int selection_order) +{ + ImGuiStorage* storage = &selection->_Storage; + ImGuiStoragePair* it = ImLowerBound(storage->Data.Data, storage->Data.Data + size_before_amends, id); + const bool is_contained = (it != storage->Data.Data + size_before_amends) && (it->key == id); + if (selected == (is_contained && it->val_i != 0)) + return; + if (selected && !is_contained) + storage->Data.push_back(ImGuiStoragePair(id, selection_order)); // Push unsorted at end of vector, will be sorted in SelectionMultiAmendsFinish() + else if (is_contained) + it->val_i = selected ? selection_order : 0; // Modify in-place. + selection->Size += selected ? +1 : -1; +} + +static void ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchFinish(ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* selection, bool selected, int size_before_amends) +{ + ImGuiStorage* storage = &selection->_Storage; + if (selected && selection->Size != size_before_amends) + storage->BuildSortByKey(); // When done selecting: sort everything +} + +// Apply requests coming from BeginMultiSelect() and EndMultiSelect(). +// - Enable 'Demo->Tools->Debug Log->Selection' to see selection requests as they happen. +// - Honoring SetRange requests requires that you can iterate/interpolate between RangeFirstItem and RangeLastItem. +// - In this demo we often submit indices to SetNextItemSelectionUserData() + store the same indices in persistent selection. +// - Your code may do differently. If you store pointers or objects ID in ImGuiSelectionUserData you may need to perform +// a lookup in order to have some way to iterate/interpolate between two items. +// - A full-featured application is likely to allow search/filtering which is likely to lead to using indices +// and constructing a view index <> object id/ptr data structure anyway. +// WHEN YOUR APPLICATION SETTLES ON A CHOICE, YOU WILL PROBABLY PREFER TO GET RID OF THIS UNNECESSARY 'ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage' INDIRECTION LOGIC. +// Notice that with the simplest adapter (using indices everywhere), all functions return their parameters. +// The most simple implementation (using indices everywhere) would look like: +// for (ImGuiSelectionRequest& req : ms_io->Requests) +// { +// if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetAll) { Clear(); if (req.Selected) { for (int n = 0; n < items_count; n++) { SetItemSelected(n, true); } } +// if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange) { for (int n = (int)ms_io->RangeFirstItem; n <= (int)ms_io->RangeLastItem; n++) { SetItemSelected(n, ms_io->Selected); } } +// } +void ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage::ApplyRequests(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io) +{ + // For convenience we obtain ItemsCount as passed to BeginMultiSelect(), which is optional. + // It makes sense when using ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage to simply pass your items count to BeginMultiSelect(). + // Other scheme may handle SetAll differently. + IM_ASSERT(ms_io->ItemsCount != -1 && "Missing value for items_count in BeginMultiSelect() call!"); + IM_ASSERT(AdapterIndexToStorageId != NULL); + + // This is optimized/specialized to cope with very large selections (e.g. 100k+ items) + // - A simpler version could call SetItemSelected() directly instead of ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchSetItemSelected() + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchFinish(). + // - Optimized select can append unsorted, then sort in a second pass. Optimized unselect can clear in-place then compact in a second pass. + // - A more optimal version wouldn't even use ImGuiStorage but directly a ImVector to reduce bandwidth, but this is a reasonable trade off to reuse code. + // - There are many ways this could be better optimized. The worse case scenario being: using BoxSelect2d in a grid, box-select scrolling down while wiggling + // left and right: it affects coarse clipping + can emit multiple SetRange with 1 item each.) + // FIXME-OPT: For each block of consecutive SetRange request: + // - add all requests to a sorted list, store ID, selected, offset in ImGuiStorage. + // - rewrite sorted storage a single time. + for (ImGuiSelectionRequest& req : ms_io->Requests) + { + if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetAll) + { + Clear(); + if (req.Selected) + { + _Storage.Data.reserve(ms_io->ItemsCount); + const int size_before_amends = _Storage.Data.Size; + for (int idx = 0; idx < ms_io->ItemsCount; idx++, _SelectionOrder++) + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchSetItemSelected(this, GetStorageIdFromIndex(idx), req.Selected, size_before_amends, _SelectionOrder); + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchFinish(this, req.Selected, size_before_amends); + } + } + else if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange) + { + const int selection_changes = (int)req.RangeLastItem - (int)req.RangeFirstItem + 1; + //ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG_SELECTION("Req %d/%d: set %d to %d\n", ms_io->Requests.index_from_ptr(&req), ms_io->Requests.Size, selection_changes, req.Selected); + if (selection_changes == 1 || (selection_changes < Size / 100)) + { + // Multiple sorted insertion + copy likely to be faster. + // Technically we could do a single copy with a little more work (sort sequential SetRange requests) + for (int idx = (int)req.RangeFirstItem; idx <= (int)req.RangeLastItem; idx++) + SetItemSelected(GetStorageIdFromIndex(idx), req.Selected); + } + else + { + // Append insertion + single sort likely be faster. + // Use req.RangeDirection to set order field so that shift+clicking from 1 to 5 is different than shift+clicking from 5 to 1 + const int size_before_amends = _Storage.Data.Size; + int selection_order = _SelectionOrder + ((req.RangeDirection < 0) ? selection_changes - 1 : 0); + for (int idx = (int)req.RangeFirstItem; idx <= (int)req.RangeLastItem; idx++, selection_order += req.RangeDirection) + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchSetItemSelected(this, GetStorageIdFromIndex(idx), req.Selected, size_before_amends, selection_order); + if (req.Selected) + _SelectionOrder += selection_changes; + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage_BatchFinish(this, req.Selected, size_before_amends); + } + } + } +} + +//------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage::ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage() +{ + UserData = NULL; + AdapterSetItemSelected = NULL; +} + +// Apply requests coming from BeginMultiSelect() and EndMultiSelect(). +// We also pull 'ms_io->ItemsCount' as passed for BeginMultiSelect() for consistency with ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage +// This makes no assumption about underlying storage. +void ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage::ApplyRequests(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io) +{ + IM_ASSERT(AdapterSetItemSelected); + for (ImGuiSelectionRequest& req : ms_io->Requests) + { + if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetAll) + for (int idx = 0; idx < ms_io->ItemsCount; idx++) + AdapterSetItemSelected(this, idx, req.Selected); + if (req.Type == ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange) + for (int idx = (int)req.RangeFirstItem; idx <= (int)req.RangeLastItem; idx++) + AdapterSetItemSelected(this, idx, req.Selected); + } +} //------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Widgets: ListBox @@ -7526,7 +8645,7 @@ bool ImGui::BeginMenuEx(const char* label, const char* icon, bool enabled) bool pressed; // We use ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoSetKeyOwner to allow down on one menu item, move, up on another. - const ImGuiSelectableFlags selectable_flags = ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID | ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoSetKeyOwner | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups; + const ImGuiSelectableFlags selectable_flags = ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoHoldingActiveID | ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoSetKeyOwner | ImGuiSelectableFlags_SelectOnClick | ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoAutoClosePopups; if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) { // Menu inside an horizontal menu bar @@ -7902,7 +9021,9 @@ bool ImGui::BeginTabBar(const char* str_id, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags) tab_bar->ID = id; tab_bar->SeparatorMinX = tab_bar->BarRect.Min.x - IM_TRUNC(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); tab_bar->SeparatorMaxX = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.x + IM_TRUNC(window->WindowPadding.x * 0.5f); - return BeginTabBarEx(tab_bar, tab_bar_bb, flags | ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused); + //if (g.NavWindow && IsWindowChildOf(g.NavWindow, window, false, false)) + flags |= ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused; + return BeginTabBarEx(tab_bar, tab_bar_bb, flags); } bool ImGui::BeginTabBarEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImRect& tab_bar_bb, ImGuiTabBarFlags flags) @@ -7956,7 +9077,7 @@ bool ImGui::BeginTabBarEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const ImRect& tab_bar_bb, ImG // Draw separator // (it would be misleading to draw this in EndTabBar() suggesting that it may be drawn over tabs, as tab bar are appendable) - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused) ? ImGuiCol_TabActive : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive); + const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_IsFocused) ? ImGuiCol_TabSelected : ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected); if (g.Style.TabBarBorderSize > 0.0f) { const float y = tab_bar->BarRect.Max.y; @@ -8816,8 +9937,16 @@ bool ImGui::TabItemEx(ImGuiTabBar* tab_bar, const char* label, bool* p_open, // Render tab shape ImDrawList* display_draw_list = window->DrawList; - const ImU32 tab_col = GetColorU32((held || hovered) ? ImGuiCol_TabHovered : tab_contents_visible ? (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_TabActive : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive) : (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_Tab : ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused)); + const ImU32 tab_col = GetColorU32((held || hovered) ? ImGuiCol_TabHovered : tab_contents_visible ? (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_TabSelected : ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected) : (tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_Tab : ImGuiCol_TabDimmed)); TabItemBackground(display_draw_list, bb, flags, tab_col); + if (tab_contents_visible && (tab_bar->Flags & ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline) && style.TabBarOverlineSize > 0.0f) + { + float x_offset = IM_TRUNC(0.4f * style.TabRounding); + if (x_offset < 2.0f * g.CurrentDpiScale) + x_offset = 0.0f; + float y_offset = 1.0f * g.CurrentDpiScale; + display_draw_list->AddLine(bb.GetTL() + ImVec2(x_offset, y_offset), bb.GetTR() + ImVec2(-x_offset, y_offset), GetColorU32(tab_bar_focused ? ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline : ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline), style.TabBarOverlineSize); + } RenderNavHighlight(bb, id); // Select with right mouse button. This is so the common idiom for context menu automatically highlight the current widget. diff --git a/include/imconfig.h b/include/imconfig.h index d556cbaf1be9..6e4c743d4ed9 100644 --- a/include/imconfig.h +++ b/include/imconfig.h @@ -21,10 +21,11 @@ //---- Define attributes of all API symbols declarations, e.g. for DLL under Windows // Using Dear ImGui via a shared library is not recommended, because of function call overhead and because we don't guarantee backward nor forward ABI compatibility. -// DLL users: heaps and globals are not shared across DLL boundaries! You will need to call SetCurrentContext() + SetAllocatorFunctions() -// for each static/DLL boundary you are calling from. Read "Context and Memory Allocators" section of imgui.cpp for more details. -//#define IMGUI_API __declspec( dllexport ) -//#define IMGUI_API __declspec( dllimport ) +// - Windows DLL users: heaps and globals are not shared across DLL boundaries! You will need to call SetCurrentContext() + SetAllocatorFunctions() +// for each static/DLL boundary you are calling from. Read "Context and Memory Allocators" section of imgui.cpp for more details. +//#define IMGUI_API __declspec(dllexport) // MSVC Windows: DLL export +//#define IMGUI_API __declspec(dllimport) // MSVC Windows: DLL import +//#define IMGUI_API __attribute__((visibility("default"))) // GCC/Clang: override visibility when set is hidden //---- Don't define obsolete functions/enums/behaviors. Consider enabling from time to time after updating to clean your code of obsolete function/names. //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS @@ -42,6 +43,7 @@ //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCTIONS // [Win32] [Default with non-Visual Studio compilers] Don't implement default IME handler (won't require imm32.lib/.a) //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_FUNCTIONS // [Win32] Won't use and link with any Win32 function (clipboard, IME). //#define IMGUI_ENABLE_OSX_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCTIONS // [OSX] Implement default OSX clipboard handler (need to link with '-framework ApplicationServices', this is why this is not the default). +//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_SHELL_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement default io.PlatformOpenInShellFn() handler (Win32: ShellExecute(), require shell32.lib/.a, Mac/Linux: use system("")). //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_FORMAT_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFormatString/ImFormatStringV so you can implement them yourself (e.g. if you don't want to link with vsnprintf) //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_MATH_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFabs/ImSqrt/ImPow/ImFmod/ImCos/ImSin/ImAcos/ImAtan2 so you can implement them yourself. //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_FILE_FUNCTIONS // Don't implement ImFileOpen/ImFileClose/ImFileRead/ImFileWrite and ImFileHandle at all (replace them with dummies) @@ -49,6 +51,9 @@ //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_DEFAULT_ALLOCATORS // Don't implement default allocators calling malloc()/free() to avoid linking with them. You will need to call ImGui::SetAllocatorFunctions(). //#define IMGUI_DISABLE_SSE // Disable use of SSE intrinsics even if available +//---- Enable Test Engine / Automation features. +//#define IMGUI_ENABLE_TEST_ENGINE // Enable imgui_test_engine hooks. Generally set automatically by include "imgui_te_config.h", see Test Engine for details. + //---- Include imgui_user.h at the end of imgui.h as a convenience // May be convenient for some users to only explicitly include vanilla imgui.h and have extra stuff included. //#define IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_H diff --git a/include/imgui.h b/include/imgui.h index aef2bf22c172..47626ad6fa59 100644 --- a/include/imgui.h +++ b/include/imgui.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (headers) // Help: @@ -27,8 +27,8 @@ // Library Version // (Integer encoded as XYYZZ for use in #if preprocessor conditionals, e.g. '#if IMGUI_VERSION_NUM >= 12345') -#define IMGUI_VERSION "1.90.8 WIP" -#define IMGUI_VERSION_NUM 19072 +#define IMGUI_VERSION "1.91.0 WIP" +#define IMGUI_VERSION_NUM 19099 #define IMGUI_HAS_TABLE /* @@ -39,11 +39,12 @@ Index of this file: // [SECTION] Dear ImGui end-user API functions // [SECTION] Flags & Enumerations // [SECTION] Tables API flags and structures (ImGuiTableFlags, ImGuiTableColumnFlags, ImGuiTableRowFlags, ImGuiTableBgTarget, ImGuiTableSortSpecs, ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs) -// [SECTION] Helpers: Memory allocations macros, ImVector<> +// [SECTION] Helpers: Debug log, Memory allocations macros, ImVector<> // [SECTION] ImGuiStyle // [SECTION] ImGuiIO // [SECTION] Misc data structures (ImGuiInputTextCallbackData, ImGuiSizeCallbackData, ImGuiPayload) // [SECTION] Helpers (ImGuiOnceUponAFrame, ImGuiTextFilter, ImGuiTextBuffer, ImGuiStorage, ImGuiListClipper, Math Operators, ImColor) +// [SECTION] Multi-Select API flags and structures (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags, ImGuiMultiSelectIO, ImGuiSelectionRequest, ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage, ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage) // [SECTION] Drawing API (ImDrawCallback, ImDrawCmd, ImDrawIdx, ImDrawVert, ImDrawChannel, ImDrawListSplitter, ImDrawFlags, ImDrawListFlags, ImDrawList, ImDrawData) // [SECTION] Font API (ImFontConfig, ImFontGlyph, ImFontGlyphRangesBuilder, ImFontAtlasFlags, ImFontAtlas, ImFont) // [SECTION] Viewports (ImGuiViewportFlags, ImGuiViewport) @@ -174,11 +175,16 @@ struct ImGuiIO; // Main configuration and I/O between your a struct ImGuiInputTextCallbackData; // Shared state of InputText() when using custom ImGuiInputTextCallback (rare/advanced use) struct ImGuiKeyData; // Storage for ImGuiIO and IsKeyDown(), IsKeyPressed() etc functions. struct ImGuiListClipper; // Helper to manually clip large list of items +struct ImGuiMultiSelectIO; // Structure to interact with a BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() block struct ImGuiOnceUponAFrame; // Helper for running a block of code not more than once a frame struct ImGuiPayload; // User data payload for drag and drop operations -struct ImGuiPlatformImeData; // Platform IME data for io.SetPlatformImeDataFn() function. +struct ImGuiPlatformImeData; // Platform IME data for io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() function. +struct ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage; // Optional helper to store multi-selection state + apply multi-selection requests. +struct ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage;//Optional helper to apply multi-selection requests to existing randomly accessible storage. +struct ImGuiSelectionRequest; // A selection request (stored in ImGuiMultiSelectIO) struct ImGuiSizeCallbackData; // Callback data when using SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() (rare/advanced use) -struct ImGuiStorage; // Helper for key->value storage +struct ImGuiStorage; // Helper for key->value storage (container sorted by key) +struct ImGuiStoragePair; // Helper for key->value storage (pair) struct ImGuiStyle; // Runtime data for styling/colors struct ImGuiTableSortSpecs; // Sorting specifications for a table (often handling sort specs for a single column, occasionally more) struct ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs; // Sorting specification for one column of a table @@ -223,8 +229,10 @@ typedef int ImGuiFocusedFlags; // -> enum ImGuiFocusedFlags_ // Flags: f typedef int ImGuiHoveredFlags; // -> enum ImGuiHoveredFlags_ // Flags: for IsItemHovered(), IsWindowHovered() etc. typedef int ImGuiInputFlags; // -> enum ImGuiInputFlags_ // Flags: for Shortcut(), SetNextItemShortcut() typedef int ImGuiInputTextFlags; // -> enum ImGuiInputTextFlags_ // Flags: for InputText(), InputTextMultiline() +typedef int ImGuiItemFlags; // -> enum ImGuiItemFlags_ // Flags: for PushItemFlag(), shared by all items typedef int ImGuiKeyChord; // -> ImGuiKey | ImGuiMod_XXX // Flags: for IsKeyChordPressed(), Shortcut() etc. an ImGuiKey optionally OR-ed with one or more ImGuiMod_XXX values. typedef int ImGuiPopupFlags; // -> enum ImGuiPopupFlags_ // Flags: for OpenPopup*(), BeginPopupContext*(), IsPopupOpen() +typedef int ImGuiMultiSelectFlags; // -> enum ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_// Flags: for BeginMultiSelect() typedef int ImGuiSelectableFlags; // -> enum ImGuiSelectableFlags_ // Flags: for Selectable() typedef int ImGuiSliderFlags; // -> enum ImGuiSliderFlags_ // Flags: for DragFloat(), DragInt(), SliderFloat(), SliderInt() etc. typedef int ImGuiTabBarFlags; // -> enum ImGuiTabBarFlags_ // Flags: for BeginTabBar() @@ -260,6 +268,11 @@ typedef ImWchar32 ImWchar; typedef ImWchar16 ImWchar; #endif +// Multi-Selection item index or identifier when using BeginMultiSelect() +// - Used by SetNextItemSelectionUserData() + and inside ImGuiMultiSelectIO structure. +// - Most users are likely to use this store an item INDEX but this may be used to store a POINTER/ID as well. Read comments near ImGuiMultiSelectIO for details. +typedef ImS64 ImGuiSelectionUserData; + // Callback and functions types typedef int (*ImGuiInputTextCallback)(ImGuiInputTextCallbackData* data); // Callback function for ImGui::InputText() typedef void (*ImGuiSizeCallback)(ImGuiSizeCallbackData* data); // Callback function for ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints() @@ -435,10 +448,8 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float val); // modify a style float variable. always use this if you modify the style after NewFrame(). IMGUI_API void PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, const ImVec2& val); // modify a style ImVec2 variable. always use this if you modify the style after NewFrame(). IMGUI_API void PopStyleVar(int count = 1); - IMGUI_API void PushTabStop(bool tab_stop); // == tab stop enable. Allow focusing using TAB/Shift-TAB, enabled by default but you can disable it for certain widgets - IMGUI_API void PopTabStop(); - IMGUI_API void PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat); // in 'repeat' mode, Button*() functions return repeated true in a typematic manner (using io.KeyRepeatDelay/io.KeyRepeatRate setting). Note that you can call IsItemActive() after any Button() to tell if the button is held in the current frame. - IMGUI_API void PopButtonRepeat(); + IMGUI_API void PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags option, bool enabled); // modify specified shared item flag, e.g. PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, true) + IMGUI_API void PopItemFlag(); // Parameters stacks (current window) IMGUI_API void PushItemWidth(float item_width); // push width of items for common large "item+label" widgets. >0.0f: width in pixels, <0.0f align xx pixels to the right of window (so -FLT_MIN always align width to the right side). @@ -542,6 +553,8 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API bool RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button); // shortcut to handle the above pattern when value is an integer IMGUI_API void ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg = ImVec2(-FLT_MIN, 0), const char* overlay = NULL); IMGUI_API void Bullet(); // draw a small circle + keep the cursor on the same line. advance cursor x position by GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing(), same distance that TreeNode() uses + IMGUI_API bool TextLink(const char* label); // hyperlink text button, return true when clicked + IMGUI_API void TextLinkOpenURL(const char* label, const char* url = NULL); // hyperlink text button, automatically open file/url when clicked // Widgets: Images // - Read about ImTextureID here: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Image-Loading-and-Displaying-Examples @@ -659,6 +672,18 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API bool Selectable(const char* label, bool selected = false, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // "bool selected" carry the selection state (read-only). Selectable() is clicked is returns true so you can modify your selection state. size.x==0.0: use remaining width, size.x>0.0: specify width. size.y==0.0: use label height, size.y>0.0: specify height IMGUI_API bool Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& size = ImVec2(0, 0)); // "bool* p_selected" point to the selection state (read-write), as a convenient helper. + // Multi-selection system for Selectable(), Checkbox() functions* + // - This enables standard multi-selection/range-selection idioms (CTRL+Mouse/Keyboard, SHIFT+Mouse/Keyboard, etc.) in a way that also allow a clipper to be used. + // - ImGuiSelectionUserData is often used to store your item index within the current view (but may store something else). + // - Read comments near ImGuiMultiSelectIO for instructions/details and see 'Demo->Widgets->Selection State & Multi-Select' for demo. + // - (*) TreeNode() is technically supported but... using this correctly is more complicate: you need some sort of linear/random access to your tree, + // which is suited to advanced trees setups already implementing filters and clipper. We will work toward simplifying and demoing this. + // - 'selection_size' and 'items_count' parameters are optional and used by a few features. If they are costly for you to compute, you may avoid them. + IMGUI_API ImGuiMultiSelectIO* BeginMultiSelect(ImGuiMultiSelectFlags flags, int selection_size = -1, int items_count = -1); + IMGUI_API ImGuiMultiSelectIO* EndMultiSelect(); + IMGUI_API void SetNextItemSelectionUserData(ImGuiSelectionUserData selection_user_data); + IMGUI_API bool IsItemToggledSelection(); // Was the last item selection state toggled? Useful if you need the per-item information _before_ reaching EndMultiSelect(). We only returns toggle _event_ in order to handle clipping correctly. + // Widgets: List Boxes // - This is essentially a thin wrapper to using BeginChild/EndChild with the ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle flag for stylistic changes + displaying a label. // - You can submit contents and manage your selection state however you want it, by creating e.g. Selectable() or any other items. @@ -778,7 +803,7 @@ namespace ImGui // - TableNextColumn() -> Text("Hello 0") -> TableNextColumn() -> Text("Hello 1") // OK: TableNextColumn() automatically gets to next row! // - TableNextRow() -> Text("Hello 0") // Not OK! Missing TableSetColumnIndex() or TableNextColumn()! Text will not appear! // - 5. Call EndTable() - IMGUI_API bool BeginTable(const char* str_id, int column, ImGuiTableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), float inner_width = 0.0f); + IMGUI_API bool BeginTable(const char* str_id, int columns, ImGuiTableFlags flags = 0, const ImVec2& outer_size = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), float inner_width = 0.0f); IMGUI_API void EndTable(); // only call EndTable() if BeginTable() returns true! IMGUI_API void TableNextRow(ImGuiTableRowFlags row_flags = 0, float min_row_height = 0.0f); // append into the first cell of a new row. IMGUI_API bool TableNextColumn(); // append into the next column (or first column of next row if currently in last column). Return true when column is visible. @@ -811,6 +836,7 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API const char* TableGetColumnName(int column_n = -1); // return "" if column didn't have a name declared by TableSetupColumn(). Pass -1 to use current column. IMGUI_API ImGuiTableColumnFlags TableGetColumnFlags(int column_n = -1); // return column flags so you can query their Enabled/Visible/Sorted/Hovered status flags. Pass -1 to use current column. IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnEnabled(int column_n, bool v);// change user accessible enabled/disabled state of a column. Set to false to hide the column. User can use the context menu to change this themselves (right-click in headers, or right-click in columns body with ImGuiTableFlags_ContextMenuInBody) + IMGUI_API int TableGetHoveredColumn(); // return hovered column. return -1 when table is not hovered. return columns_count if the unused space at the right of visible columns is hovered. Can also use (TableGetColumnFlags() & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered) instead. IMGUI_API void TableSetBgColor(ImGuiTableBgTarget target, ImU32 color, int column_n = -1); // change the color of a cell, row, or column. See ImGuiTableBgTarget_ flags for details. // Legacy Columns API (prefer using Tables!) @@ -859,6 +885,7 @@ namespace ImGui // Disabling [BETA API] // - Disable all user interactions and dim items visuals (applying style.DisabledAlpha over current colors) // - Those can be nested but it cannot be used to enable an already disabled section (a single BeginDisabled(true) in the stack is enough to keep everything disabled) + // - Tooltips windows by exception are opted out of disabling. // - BeginDisabled(false) essentially does nothing useful but is provided to facilitate use of boolean expressions. If you can avoid calling BeginDisabled(False)/EndDisabled() best to avoid it. IMGUI_API void BeginDisabled(bool disabled = true); IMGUI_API void EndDisabled(); @@ -957,6 +984,14 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API bool Shortcut(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags flags = 0); IMGUI_API void SetNextItemShortcut(ImGuiKeyChord key_chord, ImGuiInputFlags flags = 0); + // Inputs Utilities: Key/Input Ownership [BETA] + // - One common use case would be to allow your items to disable standard inputs behaviors such + // as Tab or Alt key handling, Mouse Wheel scrolling, etc. + // e.g. Button(...); SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey_MouseWheelY); to make hovering/activating a button disable wheel for scrolling. + // - Reminder ImGuiKey enum include access to mouse buttons and gamepad, so key ownership can apply to them. + // - Many related features are still in imgui_internal.h. For instance, most IsKeyXXX()/IsMouseXXX() functions have an owner-id-aware version. + IMGUI_API void SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key); // Set key owner to last item ID if it is hovered or active. Equivalent to 'if (IsItemHovered() || IsItemActive()) { SetKeyOwner(key, GetItemID());'. + // Inputs Utilities: Mouse specific // - To refer to a mouse button, you may use named enums in your code e.g. ImGuiMouseButton_Left, ImGuiMouseButton_Right. // - You can also use regular integer: it is forever guaranteed that 0=Left, 1=Right, 2=Middle. @@ -998,6 +1033,10 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void DebugFlashStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx); IMGUI_API void DebugStartItemPicker(); IMGUI_API bool DebugCheckVersionAndDataLayout(const char* version_str, size_t sz_io, size_t sz_style, size_t sz_vec2, size_t sz_vec4, size_t sz_drawvert, size_t sz_drawidx); // This is called by IMGUI_CHECKVERSION() macro. +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEBUG_TOOLS + IMGUI_API void DebugLog(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); // Call via IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG() for maximum stripping in caller code! + IMGUI_API void DebugLogV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); +#endif // Memory Allocators // - Those functions are not reliant on the current context. @@ -1043,7 +1082,6 @@ enum ImGuiWindowFlags_ ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMouseInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavInputs | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoNavFocus, // [Internal] - ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened = 1 << 23, // [BETA] On child window: share focus scope, allow gamepad/keyboard navigation to cross over parent border to this child or between sibling child windows. ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow = 1 << 24, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginChild() ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip = 1 << 25, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginTooltip() ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup = 1 << 26, // Don't use! For internal use by BeginPopup() @@ -1052,7 +1090,8 @@ enum ImGuiWindowFlags_ // Obsolete names #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS - ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding = 1 << 30, // Obsoleted in 1.90: Use ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding in BeginChild() call. + ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding = 1 << 30, // Obsoleted in 1.90.0: Use ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding in BeginChild() call. + ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened = 1 << 31, // Obsoleted in 1.90.9: Use ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened in BeginChild() call. #endif }; @@ -1076,34 +1115,56 @@ enum ImGuiChildFlags_ ImGuiChildFlags_AutoResizeY = 1 << 5, // Enable auto-resizing height. Read "IMPORTANT: Size measurement" details above. ImGuiChildFlags_AlwaysAutoResize = 1 << 6, // Combined with AutoResizeX/AutoResizeY. Always measure size even when child is hidden, always return true, always disable clipping optimization! NOT RECOMMENDED. ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle = 1 << 7, // Style the child window like a framed item: use FrameBg, FrameRounding, FrameBorderSize, FramePadding instead of ChildBg, ChildRounding, ChildBorderSize, WindowPadding. + ImGuiChildFlags_NavFlattened = 1 << 8, // [BETA] Share focus scope, allow gamepad/keyboard navigation to cross over parent border to this child or between sibling child windows. +}; + +// Flags for ImGui::PushItemFlag() +// (Those are shared by all items) +enum ImGuiItemFlags_ +{ + ImGuiItemFlags_None = 0, // (Default) + ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop = 1 << 0, // false // Disable keyboard tabbing. This is a "lighter" version of ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav. + ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav = 1 << 1, // false // Disable any form of focusing (keyboard/gamepad directional navigation and SetKeyboardFocusHere() calls). + ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus = 1 << 2, // false // Disable item being a candidate for default focus (e.g. used by title bar items). + ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat = 1 << 3, // false // Any button-like behavior will have repeat mode enabled (based on io.KeyRepeatDelay and io.KeyRepeatRate values). Note that you can also call IsItemActive() after any button to tell if it is being held. + ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups = 1 << 4, // true // MenuItem()/Selectable() automatically close their parent popup window. }; // Flags for ImGui::InputText() // (Those are per-item flags. There are shared flags in ImGuiIO: io.ConfigInputTextCursorBlink and io.ConfigInputTextEnterKeepActive) enum ImGuiInputTextFlags_ { + // Basic filters (also see ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter) ImGuiInputTextFlags_None = 0, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal = 1 << 0, // Allow 0123456789.+-*/ ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal = 1 << 1, // Allow 0123456789ABCDEFabcdef - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase = 1 << 2, // Turn a..z into A..Z - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank = 1 << 3, // Filter out spaces, tabs - ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll = 1 << 4, // Select entire text when first taking mouse focus - ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue = 1 << 5, // Return 'true' when Enter is pressed (as opposed to every time the value was modified). Consider looking at the IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() function. - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion = 1 << 6, // Callback on pressing TAB (for completion handling) - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory = 1 << 7, // Callback on pressing Up/Down arrows (for history handling) - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways = 1 << 8, // Callback on each iteration. User code may query cursor position, modify text buffer. - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter = 1 << 9, // Callback on character inputs to replace or discard them. Modify 'EventChar' to replace or discard, or return 1 in callback to discard. - ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput = 1 << 10, // Pressing TAB input a '\t' character into the text field - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine = 1 << 11, // In multi-line mode, unfocus with Enter, add new line with Ctrl+Enter (default is opposite: unfocus with Ctrl+Enter, add line with Enter). - ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll = 1 << 12, // Disable following the cursor horizontally - ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysOverwrite = 1 << 13, // Overwrite mode - ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 14, // Read-only mode - ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password = 1 << 15, // Password mode, display all characters as '*' + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific = 1 << 2, // Allow 0123456789.+-*/eE (Scientific notation input) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase = 1 << 3, // Turn a..z into A..Z + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank = 1 << 4, // Filter out spaces, tabs + + // Inputs + ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput = 1 << 5, // Pressing TAB input a '\t' character into the text field + ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue = 1 << 6, // Return 'true' when Enter is pressed (as opposed to every time the value was modified). Consider looking at the IsItemDeactivatedAfterEdit() function. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_EscapeClearsAll = 1 << 7, // Escape key clears content if not empty, and deactivate otherwise (contrast to default behavior of Escape to revert) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine = 1 << 8, // In multi-line mode, validate with Enter, add new line with Ctrl+Enter (default is opposite: validate with Ctrl+Enter, add line with Enter). + + // Other options + ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 9, // Read-only mode + ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password = 1 << 10, // Password mode, display all characters as '*', disable copy + ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysOverwrite = 1 << 11, // Overwrite mode + ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll = 1 << 12, // Select entire text when first taking mouse focus + ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal = 1 << 13, // InputFloat(), InputInt(), InputScalar() etc. only: parse empty string as zero value. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_DisplayEmptyRefVal = 1 << 14, // InputFloat(), InputInt(), InputScalar() etc. only: when value is zero, do not display it. Generally used with ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyRefVal. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll = 1 << 15, // Disable following the cursor horizontally ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoUndoRedo = 1 << 16, // Disable undo/redo. Note that input text owns the text data while active, if you want to provide your own undo/redo stack you need e.g. to call ClearActiveID(). - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsScientific = 1 << 17, // Allow 0123456789.+-*/eE (Scientific notation input) - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize = 1 << 18, // Callback on buffer capacity changes request (beyond 'buf_size' parameter value), allowing the string to grow. Notify when the string wants to be resized (for string types which hold a cache of their Size). You will be provided a new BufSize in the callback and NEED to honor it. (see misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an example of using this) - ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit = 1 << 19, // Callback on any edit (note that InputText() already returns true on edit, the callback is useful mainly to manipulate the underlying buffer while focus is active) - ImGuiInputTextFlags_EscapeClearsAll = 1 << 20, // Escape key clears content if not empty, and deactivate otherwise (contrast to default behavior of Escape to revert) + + // Callback features + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion = 1 << 17, // Callback on pressing TAB (for completion handling) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory = 1 << 18, // Callback on pressing Up/Down arrows (for history handling) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways = 1 << 19, // Callback on each iteration. User code may query cursor position, modify text buffer. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter = 1 << 20, // Callback on character inputs to replace or discard them. Modify 'EventChar' to replace or discard, or return 1 in callback to discard. + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackResize = 1 << 21, // Callback on buffer capacity changes request (beyond 'buf_size' parameter value), allowing the string to grow. Notify when the string wants to be resized (for string types which hold a cache of their Size). You will be provided a new BufSize in the callback and NEED to honor it. (see misc/cpp/imgui_stdlib.h for an example of using this) + ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackEdit = 1 << 22, // Callback on any edit (note that InputText() already returns true on edit, the callback is useful mainly to manipulate the underlying buffer while focus is active) // Obsolete names //ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysInsertMode = ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysOverwrite // [renamed in 1.82] name was not matching behavior @@ -1123,7 +1184,7 @@ enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow = 1 << 7, // Only open when clicking on the arrow part. If ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick is also set, single-click arrow or double-click all box to open. ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf = 1 << 8, // No collapsing, no arrow (use as a convenience for leaf nodes). ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet = 1 << 9, // Display a bullet instead of arrow. IMPORTANT: node can still be marked open/close if you don't set the _Leaf flag! - ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_FramePadding = 1 << 10, // Use FramePadding (even for an unframed text node) to vertically align text baseline to regular widget height. Equivalent to calling AlignTextToFramePadding(). + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_FramePadding = 1 << 10, // Use FramePadding (even for an unframed text node) to vertically align text baseline to regular widget height. Equivalent to calling AlignTextToFramePadding() before the node. ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanAvailWidth = 1 << 11, // Extend hit box to the right-most edge, even if not framed. This is not the default in order to allow adding other items on the same line without using AllowOverlap mode. ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanFullWidth = 1 << 12, // Extend hit box to the left-most and right-most edges (cover the indent area). ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_SpanTextWidth = 1 << 13, // Narrow hit box + narrow hovering highlight, will only cover the label text. @@ -1166,14 +1227,15 @@ enum ImGuiPopupFlags_ enum ImGuiSelectableFlags_ { ImGuiSelectableFlags_None = 0, - ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups = 1 << 0, // Clicking this doesn't close parent popup window + ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoAutoClosePopups = 1 << 0, // Clicking this doesn't close parent popup window (overrides ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups) ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns = 1 << 1, // Frame will span all columns of its container table (text will still fit in current column) ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick = 1 << 2, // Generate press events on double clicks too ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled = 1 << 3, // Cannot be selected, display grayed out text ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowOverlap = 1 << 4, // (WIP) Hit testing to allow subsequent widgets to overlap this one #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS - ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap = ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowOverlap, // Renamed in 1.89.7 + ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups = ImGuiSelectableFlags_NoAutoClosePopups, // Renamed in 1.91.0 + ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowItemOverlap = ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowOverlap, // Renamed in 1.89.7 #endif }; @@ -1202,8 +1264,9 @@ enum ImGuiTabBarFlags_ ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoCloseWithMiddleMouseButton = 1 << 3, // Disable behavior of closing tabs (that are submitted with p_open != NULL) with middle mouse button. You may handle this behavior manually on user's side with if (IsItemHovered() && IsMouseClicked(2)) *p_open = false. ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTabListScrollingButtons = 1 << 4, // Disable scrolling buttons (apply when fitting policy is ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll) ImGuiTabBarFlags_NoTooltip = 1 << 5, // Disable tooltips when hovering a tab - ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown = 1 << 6, // Resize tabs when they don't fit - ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll = 1 << 7, // Add scroll buttons when tabs don't fit + ImGuiTabBarFlags_DrawSelectedOverline = 1 << 6, // Draw selected overline markers over selected tab + ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown = 1 << 7, // Resize tabs when they don't fit + ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll = 1 << 8, // Add scroll buttons when tabs don't fit ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyMask_ = ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown | ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyScroll, ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyDefault_ = ImGuiTabBarFlags_FittingPolicyResizeDown, }; @@ -1285,12 +1348,18 @@ enum ImGuiDragDropFlags_ ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceNoHoldToOpenOthers = 1 << 2, // Disable the behavior that allows to open tree nodes and collapsing header by holding over them while dragging a source item. ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAllowNullID = 1 << 3, // Allow items such as Text(), Image() that have no unique identifier to be used as drag source, by manufacturing a temporary identifier based on their window-relative position. This is extremely unusual within the dear imgui ecosystem and so we made it explicit. ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceExtern = 1 << 4, // External source (from outside of dear imgui), won't attempt to read current item/window info. Will always return true. Only one Extern source can be active simultaneously. - ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload = 1 << 5, // Automatically expire the payload if the source cease to be submitted (otherwise payloads are persisting while being dragged) + ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadAutoExpire = 1 << 5, // Automatically expire the payload if the source cease to be submitted (otherwise payloads are persisting while being dragged) + ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadNoCrossContext = 1 << 6, // Hint to specify that the payload may not be copied outside current dear imgui context. + ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadNoCrossProcess = 1 << 7, // Hint to specify that the payload may not be copied outside current process. // AcceptDragDropPayload() flags ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery = 1 << 10, // AcceptDragDropPayload() will returns true even before the mouse button is released. You can then call IsDelivery() to test if the payload needs to be delivered. ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoDrawDefaultRect = 1 << 11, // Do not draw the default highlight rectangle when hovering over target. ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoPreviewTooltip = 1 << 12, // Request hiding the BeginDragDropSource tooltip from the BeginDragDropTarget site. ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptPeekOnly = ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptBeforeDelivery | ImGuiDragDropFlags_AcceptNoDrawDefaultRect, // For peeking ahead and inspecting the payload before delivery. + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + ImGuiDragDropFlags_SourceAutoExpirePayload = ImGuiDragDropFlags_PayloadAutoExpire, // Renamed in 1.90.9 +#endif }; // Standard Drag and Drop payload types. You can define you own payload types using short strings. Types starting with '_' are defined by Dear ImGui. @@ -1310,6 +1379,7 @@ enum ImGuiDataType_ ImGuiDataType_U64, // unsigned long long / unsigned __int64 ImGuiDataType_Float, // float ImGuiDataType_Double, // double + ImGuiDataType_Bool, // bool (provided for user convenience, not supported by scalar widgets) ImGuiDataType_COUNT }; @@ -1518,8 +1588,9 @@ enum ImGuiConfigFlags_ ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableGamepad = 1 << 1, // Master gamepad navigation enable flag. Backend also needs to set ImGuiBackendFlags_HasGamepad. ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos = 1 << 2, // Instruct navigation to move the mouse cursor. May be useful on TV/console systems where moving a virtual mouse is awkward. Will update io.MousePos and set io.WantSetMousePos=true. If enabled you MUST honor io.WantSetMousePos requests in your backend, otherwise ImGui will react as if the mouse is jumping around back and forth. ImGuiConfigFlags_NavNoCaptureKeyboard = 1 << 3, // Instruct navigation to not set the io.WantCaptureKeyboard flag when io.NavActive is set. - ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse = 1 << 4, // Instruct imgui to clear mouse position/buttons in NewFrame(). This allows ignoring the mouse information set by the backend. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouse = 1 << 4, // Instruct dear imgui to disable mouse inputs and interactions. ImGuiConfigFlags_NoMouseCursorChange = 1 << 5, // Instruct backend to not alter mouse cursor shape and visibility. Use if the backend cursor changes are interfering with yours and you don't want to use SetMouseCursor() to change mouse cursor. You may want to honor requests from imgui by reading GetMouseCursor() yourself instead. + ImGuiConfigFlags_NoKeyboard = 1 << 6, // Instruct dear imgui to disable keyboard inputs and interactions. This is done by ignoring keyboard events and clearing existing states. // User storage (to allow your backend/engine to communicate to code that may be shared between multiple projects. Those flags are NOT used by core Dear ImGui) ImGuiConfigFlags_IsSRGB = 1 << 20, // Application is SRGB-aware. @@ -1572,11 +1643,13 @@ enum ImGuiCol_ ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip, // Resize grip in lower-right and lower-left corners of windows. ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered, ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive, - ImGuiCol_Tab, // TabItem in a TabBar - ImGuiCol_TabHovered, - ImGuiCol_TabActive, - ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused, - ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive, + ImGuiCol_TabHovered, // Tab background, when hovered + ImGuiCol_Tab, // Tab background, when tab-bar is focused & tab is unselected + ImGuiCol_TabSelected, // Tab background, when tab-bar is focused & tab is selected + ImGuiCol_TabSelectedOverline, // Tab horizontal overline, when tab-bar is focused & tab is selected + ImGuiCol_TabDimmed, // Tab background, when tab-bar is unfocused & tab is unselected + ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected, // Tab background, when tab-bar is unfocused & tab is selected + ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelectedOverline,//..horizontal overline, when tab-bar is unfocused & tab is selected ImGuiCol_PlotLines, ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered, ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram, @@ -1586,13 +1659,20 @@ enum ImGuiCol_ ImGuiCol_TableBorderLight, // Table inner borders (prefer using Alpha=1.0 here) ImGuiCol_TableRowBg, // Table row background (even rows) ImGuiCol_TableRowBgAlt, // Table row background (odd rows) + ImGuiCol_TextLink, // Hyperlink color ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg, ImGuiCol_DragDropTarget, // Rectangle highlighting a drop target ImGuiCol_NavHighlight, // Gamepad/keyboard: current highlighted item ImGuiCol_NavWindowingHighlight, // Highlight window when using CTRL+TAB ImGuiCol_NavWindowingDimBg, // Darken/colorize entire screen behind the CTRL+TAB window list, when active ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDimBg, // Darken/colorize entire screen behind a modal window, when one is active - ImGuiCol_COUNT + ImGuiCol_COUNT, + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + ImGuiCol_TabActive = ImGuiCol_TabSelected, // [renamed in 1.90.9] + ImGuiCol_TabUnfocused = ImGuiCol_TabDimmed, // [renamed in 1.90.9] + ImGuiCol_TabUnfocusedActive = ImGuiCol_TabDimmedSelected, // [renamed in 1.90.9] +#endif }; // Enumeration for PushStyleVar() / PopStyleVar() to temporarily modify the ImGuiStyle structure. @@ -1631,11 +1711,12 @@ enum ImGuiStyleVar_ ImGuiStyleVar_TabRounding, // float TabRounding ImGuiStyleVar_TabBorderSize, // float TabBorderSize ImGuiStyleVar_TabBarBorderSize, // float TabBarBorderSize - ImGuiStyleVar_TableAngledHeadersAngle, // float TableAngledHeadersAngle - ImGuiStyleVar_TableAngledHeadersTextAlign,// ImVec2 TableAngledHeadersTextAlign + ImGuiStyleVar_TabBarOverlineSize, // float TabBarOverlineSize + ImGuiStyleVar_TableAngledHeadersAngle, // float TableAngledHeadersAngle + ImGuiStyleVar_TableAngledHeadersTextAlign,// ImVec2 TableAngledHeadersTextAlign ImGuiStyleVar_ButtonTextAlign, // ImVec2 ButtonTextAlign ImGuiStyleVar_SelectableTextAlign, // ImVec2 SelectableTextAlign - ImGuiStyleVar_SeparatorTextBorderSize, // float SeparatorTextBorderSize + ImGuiStyleVar_SeparatorTextBorderSize, // float SeparatorTextBorderSize ImGuiStyleVar_SeparatorTextAlign, // ImVec2 SeparatorTextAlign ImGuiStyleVar_SeparatorTextPadding, // ImVec2 SeparatorTextPadding ImGuiStyleVar_COUNT @@ -1648,10 +1729,8 @@ enum ImGuiButtonFlags_ ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft = 1 << 0, // React on left mouse button (default) ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight = 1 << 1, // React on right mouse button ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle = 1 << 2, // React on center mouse button - - // [Internal] - ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMask_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle, - ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft, + ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMask_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonRight | ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonMiddle, // [Internal] + //ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonDefault_ = ImGuiButtonFlags_MouseButtonLeft, }; // Flags for ColorEdit3() / ColorEdit4() / ColorPicker3() / ColorPicker4() / ColorButton() @@ -1706,8 +1785,9 @@ enum ImGuiSliderFlags_ ImGuiSliderFlags_None = 0, ImGuiSliderFlags_AlwaysClamp = 1 << 4, // Clamp value to min/max bounds when input manually with CTRL+Click. By default CTRL+Click allows going out of bounds. ImGuiSliderFlags_Logarithmic = 1 << 5, // Make the widget logarithmic (linear otherwise). Consider using ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat with this if using a format-string with small amount of digits. - ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat = 1 << 6, // Disable rounding underlying value to match precision of the display format string (e.g. %.3f values are rounded to those 3 digits) - ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput = 1 << 7, // Disable CTRL+Click or Enter key allowing to input text directly into the widget + ImGuiSliderFlags_NoRoundToFormat = 1 << 6, // Disable rounding underlying value to match precision of the display format string (e.g. %.3f values are rounded to those 3 digits). + ImGuiSliderFlags_NoInput = 1 << 7, // Disable CTRL+Click or Enter key allowing to input text directly into the widget. + ImGuiSliderFlags_WrapAround = 1 << 8, // Enable wrapping around from max to min and from min to max (only supported by DragXXX() functions for now. ImGuiSliderFlags_InvalidMask_ = 0x7000000F, // [Internal] We treat using those bits as being potentially a 'float power' argument from the previous API that has got miscast to this enum, and will trigger an assert if needed. // Obsolete names @@ -1930,9 +2010,19 @@ struct ImGuiTableColumnSortSpecs }; //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// [SECTION] Helpers: Memory allocations macros, ImVector<> +// [SECTION] Helpers: Debug log, memory allocations macros, ImVector<> //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// Debug Logging into ShowDebugLogWindow(), tty and more. +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_DEBUG_TOOLS +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG(...) ImGui::DebugLog(__VA_ARGS__) +#else +#define IMGUI_DEBUG_LOG(...) ((void)0) +#endif + //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // IM_MALLOC(), IM_FREE(), IM_NEW(), IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(), IM_DELETE() // We call C++ constructor on own allocated memory via the placement "new(ptr) Type()" syntax. @@ -2065,12 +2155,13 @@ struct ImGuiStyle float TabBorderSize; // Thickness of border around tabs. float TabMinWidthForCloseButton; // Minimum width for close button to appear on an unselected tab when hovered. Set to 0.0f to always show when hovering, set to FLT_MAX to never show close button unless selected. float TabBarBorderSize; // Thickness of tab-bar separator, which takes on the tab active color to denote focus. + float TabBarOverlineSize; // Thickness of tab-bar overline, which highlights the selected tab-bar. float TableAngledHeadersAngle; // Angle of angled headers (supported values range from -50.0f degrees to +50.0f degrees). ImVec2 TableAngledHeadersTextAlign;// Alignment of angled headers within the cell ImGuiDir ColorButtonPosition; // Side of the color button in the ColorEdit4 widget (left/right). Defaults to ImGuiDir_Right. ImVec2 ButtonTextAlign; // Alignment of button text when button is larger than text. Defaults to (0.5f, 0.5f) (centered). ImVec2 SelectableTextAlign; // Alignment of selectable text. Defaults to (0.0f, 0.0f) (top-left aligned). It's generally important to keep this left-aligned if you want to lay multiple items on a same line. - float SeparatorTextBorderSize; // Thickkness of border in SeparatorText() + float SeparatorTextBorderSize; // Thickness of border in SeparatorText() ImVec2 SeparatorTextAlign; // Alignment of text within the separator. Defaults to (0.0f, 0.5f) (left aligned, center). ImVec2 SeparatorTextPadding; // Horizontal offset of text from each edge of the separator + spacing on other axis. Generally small values. .y is recommended to be == FramePadding.y. ImVec2 DisplayWindowPadding; // Apply to regular windows: amount which we enforce to keep visible when moving near edges of your screen. @@ -2175,9 +2266,9 @@ struct ImGuiIO // Option to deactivate io.AddFocusEvent(false) handling. // - May facilitate interactions with a debugger when focus loss leads to clearing inputs data. // - Backends may have other side-effects on focus loss, so this will reduce side-effects but not necessary remove all of them. - bool ConfigDebugIgnoreFocusLoss; // = false // Ignore io.AddFocusEvent(false), consequently not calling io.ClearInputKeys() in input processing. + bool ConfigDebugIgnoreFocusLoss; // = false // Ignore io.AddFocusEvent(false), consequently not calling io.ClearInputKeys()/io.ClearInputMouse() in input processing. - // Options to audit .ini data + // Option to audit .ini data bool ConfigDebugIniSettings; // = false // Save .ini data with extra comments (particularly helpful for Docking, but makes saving slower) //------------------------------------------------------------------ @@ -2198,9 +2289,15 @@ struct ImGuiIO void (*SetClipboardTextFn)(void* user_data, const char* text); void* ClipboardUserData; + // Optional: Open link/folder/file in OS Shell + // (default to use ShellExecuteA() on Windows, system() on Linux/Mac) + bool (*PlatformOpenInShellFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, const char* path); + void* PlatformOpenInShellUserData; + // Optional: Notify OS Input Method Editor of the screen position of your cursor for text input position (e.g. when using Japanese/Chinese IME on Windows) // (default to use native imm32 api on Windows) - void (*SetPlatformImeDataFn)(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); + void (*PlatformSetImeDataFn)(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); + //void (*SetPlatformImeDataFn)(ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiPlatformImeData* data); // [Renamed to io.PlatformSetImeDataFn in 1.91.0] // Optional: Platform locale ImWchar PlatformLocaleDecimalPoint; // '.' // [Experimental] Configure decimal point e.g. '.' or ',' useful for some languages (e.g. German), generally pulled from *localeconv()->decimal_point @@ -2224,7 +2321,8 @@ struct ImGuiIO IMGUI_API void SetKeyEventNativeData(ImGuiKey key, int native_keycode, int native_scancode, int native_legacy_index = -1); // [Optional] Specify index for legacy <1.87 IsKeyXXX() functions with native indices + specify native keycode, scancode. IMGUI_API void SetAppAcceptingEvents(bool accepting_events); // Set master flag for accepting key/mouse/text events (default to true). Useful if you have native dialog boxes that are interrupting your application loop/refresh, and you want to disable events being queued while your app is frozen. IMGUI_API void ClearEventsQueue(); // Clear all incoming events. - IMGUI_API void ClearInputKeys(); // Clear current keyboard/mouse/gamepad state + current frame text input buffer. Equivalent to releasing all keys/buttons. + IMGUI_API void ClearInputKeys(); // Clear current keyboard/gamepad state + current frame text input buffer. Equivalent to releasing all keys/buttons. + IMGUI_API void ClearInputMouse(); // Clear current mouse state. #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS IMGUI_API void ClearInputCharacters(); // [Obsoleted in 1.89.8] Clear the current frame text input buffer. Now included within ClearInputKeys(). #endif @@ -2453,6 +2551,16 @@ struct ImGuiTextBuffer IMGUI_API void appendfv(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(2); }; +// [Internal] Key+Value for ImGuiStorage +struct ImGuiStoragePair +{ + ImGuiID key; + union { int val_i; float val_f; void* val_p; }; + ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, int _val) { key = _key; val_i = _val; } + ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, float _val) { key = _key; val_f = _val; } + ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, void* _val) { key = _key; val_p = _val; } +}; + // Helper: Key->Value storage // Typically you don't have to worry about this since a storage is held within each Window. // We use it to e.g. store collapse state for a tree (Int 0/1) @@ -2464,15 +2572,6 @@ struct ImGuiTextBuffer struct ImGuiStorage { // [Internal] - struct ImGuiStoragePair - { - ImGuiID key; - union { int val_i; float val_f; void* val_p; }; - ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, int _val) { key = _key; val_i = _val; } - ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, float _val) { key = _key; val_f = _val; } - ImGuiStoragePair(ImGuiID _key, void* _val) { key = _key; val_p = _val; } - }; - ImVector Data; // - Get***() functions find pair, never add/allocate. Pairs are sorted so a query is O(log N) @@ -2501,6 +2600,10 @@ struct ImGuiStorage IMGUI_API void BuildSortByKey(); // Obsolete: use on your own storage if you know only integer are being stored (open/close all tree nodes) IMGUI_API void SetAllInt(int val); + +#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS + //typedef ::ImGuiStoragePair ImGuiStoragePair; // 1.90.8: moved type outside struct +#endif }; // Helper: Manually clip large list of items. @@ -2531,9 +2634,10 @@ struct ImGuiListClipper int ItemsCount; // [Internal] Number of items float ItemsHeight; // [Internal] Height of item after a first step and item submission can calculate it float StartPosY; // [Internal] Cursor position at the time of Begin() or after table frozen rows are all processed + double StartSeekOffsetY; // [Internal] Account for frozen rows in a table and initial loss of precision in very large windows. void* TempData; // [Internal] Internal data - // items_count: Use INT_MAX if you don't know how many items you have (in which case the cursor won't be advanced in the final step) + // items_count: Use INT_MAX if you don't know how many items you have (in which case the cursor won't be advanced in the final step, and you can call SeekCursorForItem() manually if you need) // items_height: Use -1.0f to be calculated automatically on first step. Otherwise pass in the distance between your items, typically GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() or GetFrameHeightWithSpacing(). IMGUI_API ImGuiListClipper(); IMGUI_API ~ImGuiListClipper(); @@ -2546,6 +2650,11 @@ struct ImGuiListClipper inline void IncludeItemByIndex(int item_index) { IncludeItemsByIndex(item_index, item_index + 1); } IMGUI_API void IncludeItemsByIndex(int item_begin, int item_end); // item_end is exclusive e.g. use (42, 42+1) to make item 42 never clipped. + // Seek cursor toward given item. This is automatically called while stepping. + // - The only reason to call this is: you can use ImGuiListClipper::Begin(INT_MAX) if you don't know item count ahead of time. + // - In this case, after all steps are done, you'll want to call SeekCursorForItem(item_count). + IMGUI_API void SeekCursorForItem(int item_index); + #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS inline void IncludeRangeByIndices(int item_begin, int item_end) { IncludeItemsByIndex(item_begin, item_end); } // [renamed in 1.89.9] inline void ForceDisplayRangeByIndices(int item_begin, int item_end) { IncludeItemsByIndex(item_begin, item_end); } // [renamed in 1.89.6] @@ -2626,6 +2735,154 @@ struct ImColor static ImColor HSV(float h, float s, float v, float a = 1.0f) { float r, g, b; ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(h, s, v, r, g, b); return ImColor(r, g, b, a); } }; +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Multi-Select API flags and structures (ImGuiMultiSelectFlags, ImGuiSelectionRequestType, ImGuiSelectionRequest, ImGuiMultiSelectIO, ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage) +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +// Multi-selection system +// Documentation at: https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Multi-Select +// - Refer to 'Demo->Widgets->Selection State & Multi-Select' for demos using this. +// - This system implements standard multi-selection idioms (CTRL+Mouse/Keyboard, SHIFT+Mouse/Keyboard, etc) +// with support for clipper (skipping non-visible items), box-select and many other details. +// - Selectable(), Checkbox() are supported but custom widgets may use it as well. +// - TreeNode() is technically supported but... using this correctly is more complicated: you need some sort of linear/random access to your tree, +// which is suited to advanced trees setups also implementing filters and clipper. We will work toward simplifying and demoing it. +// - In the spirit of Dear ImGui design, your code owns actual selection data. +// This is designed to allow all kinds of selection storage you may use in your application e.g. set/map/hash. +// About ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage: +// - This is an optional helper to store a selection state and apply selection requests. +// - It is used by our demos and provided as a convenience to quickly implement multi-selection. +// Usage: +// - Identify submitted items with SetNextItemSelectionUserData(), most likely using an index into your current data-set. +// - Store and maintain actual selection data using persistent object identifiers. +// - Usage flow: +// BEGIN - (1) Call BeginMultiSelect() and retrieve the ImGuiMultiSelectIO* result. +// - (2) Honor request list (SetAll/SetRange requests) by updating your selection data. Same code as Step 6. +// - (3) [If using clipper] You need to make sure RangeSrcItem is always submitted. Calculate its index and pass to clipper.IncludeItemByIndex(). If storing indices in ImGuiSelectionUserData, a simple clipper.IncludeItemByIndex(ms_io->RangeSrcItem) call will work. +// LOOP - (4) Submit your items with SetNextItemSelectionUserData() + Selectable()/TreeNode() calls. +// END - (5) Call EndMultiSelect() and retrieve the ImGuiMultiSelectIO* result. +// - (6) Honor request list (SetAll/SetRange requests) by updating your selection data. Same code as Step 2. +// If you submit all items (no clipper), Step 2 and 3 are optional and will be handled by each item themselves. It is fine to always honor those steps. +// About ImGuiSelectionUserData: +// - This can store an application-defined identifier (e.g. index or pointer) submitted via SetNextItemSelectionUserData(). +// - In return we store them into RangeSrcItem/RangeFirstItem/RangeLastItem and other fields in ImGuiMultiSelectIO. +// - Most applications will store an object INDEX, hence the chosen name and type. Storing an index is natural, because +// SetRange requests will give you two end-points and you will need to iterate/interpolate between them to update your selection. +// - However it is perfectly possible to store a POINTER or another IDENTIFIER inside ImGuiSelectionUserData. +// Our system never assume that you identify items by indices, it never attempts to interpolate between two values. +// - If you enable ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect then it is guaranteed that you will never have to interpolate +// between two ImGuiSelectionUserData, which may be a convenient way to use part of the feature with less code work. +// - As most users will want to store an index, for convenience and to reduce confusion we use ImS64 instead of void*, +// being syntactically easier to downcast. Feel free to reinterpret_cast and store a pointer inside. + +// Flags for BeginMultiSelect() +enum ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ +{ + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_None = 0, + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SingleSelect = 1 << 0, // Disable selecting more than one item. This is available to allow single-selection code to share same code/logic if desired. It essentially disables the main purpose of BeginMultiSelect() tho! + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoSelectAll = 1 << 1, // Disable CTRL+A shortcut to select all. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoRangeSelect = 1 << 2, // Disable Shift+selection mouse/keyboard support (useful for unordered 2D selection). With BoxSelect is also ensure contiguous SetRange requests are not combined into one. This allows not handling interpolation in SetRange requests. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect = 1 << 3, // Disable selecting items when navigating (useful for e.g. supporting range-select in a list of checkboxes) + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClear = 1 << 4, // Disable clearing selection when navigating or selecting another one (generally used with ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoSelect. useful for e.g. supporting range-select in a list of checkboxes) + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NoAutoClearOnReselect = 1 << 5, // Disable clearing selection when clicking/selecting an already selected item + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect1d = 1 << 6, // Enable box-selection with same width and same x pos items (e.g. only full row Selectable()). Box-selection works better with little bit of spacing between items hit-box in order to be able to aim at empty space. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelect2d = 1 << 7, // Enable box-selection with varying width or varying x pos items support (e.g. different width labels, or 2D layout/grid). This is slower: alters clipping logic so that e.g. horizontal movements will update selection of normally clipped items. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_BoxSelectNoScroll = 1 << 8, // Disable scrolling when box-selecting near edges of scope. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnEscape = 1 << 9, // Clear selection when pressing Escape while scope is focused. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ClearOnClickVoid = 1 << 10, // Clear selection when clicking on empty location within scope. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeWindow = 1 << 11, // Scope for _BoxSelect and _ClearOnClickVoid is whole window (Default). Use if BeginMultiSelect() covers a whole window or used a single time in same window. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_ScopeRect = 1 << 12, // Scope for _BoxSelect and _ClearOnClickVoid is rectangle encompassing BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect(). Use if BeginMultiSelect() is called multiple times in same window. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClick = 1 << 13, // Apply selection on mouse down when clicking on unselected item. (Default) + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_SelectOnClickRelease = 1 << 14, // Apply selection on mouse release when clicking an unselected item. Allow dragging an unselected item without altering selection. + //ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_RangeSelect2d = 1 << 15, // Shift+Selection uses 2d geometry instead of linear sequence, so possible to use Shift+up/down to select vertically in grid. Analogous to what BoxSelect does. + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags_NavWrapX = 1 << 16, // [Temporary] Enable navigation wrapping on X axis. Provided as a convenience because we don't have a design for the general Nav API for this yet. When the more general feature be public we may obsolete this flag in favor of new one. +}; + +// Main IO structure returned by BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect(). +// This mainly contains a list of selection requests. +// - Use 'Demo->Tools->Debug Log->Selection' to see requests as they happen. +// - Some fields are only useful if your list is dynamic and allows deletion (getting post-deletion focus/state right is shown in the demo) +// - Below: who reads/writes each fields? 'r'=read, 'w'=write, 'ms'=multi-select code, 'app'=application/user code. +struct ImGuiMultiSelectIO +{ + //------------------------------------------// BeginMultiSelect / EndMultiSelect + ImVector Requests; // ms:w, app:r / ms:w app:r // Requests to apply to your selection data. + ImGuiSelectionUserData RangeSrcItem; // ms:w app:r / // (If using clipper) Begin: Source item (often the first selected item) must never be clipped: use clipper.IncludeItemByIndex() to ensure it is submitted. + ImGuiSelectionUserData NavIdItem; // ms:w, app:r / // (If using deletion) Last known SetNextItemSelectionUserData() value for NavId (if part of submitted items). + bool NavIdSelected; // ms:w, app:r / app:r // (If using deletion) Last known selection state for NavId (if part of submitted items). + bool RangeSrcReset; // app:w / ms:r // (If using deletion) Set before EndMultiSelect() to reset ResetSrcItem (e.g. if deleted selection). + int ItemsCount; // ms:w, app:r / app:r // 'int items_count' parameter to BeginMultiSelect() is copied here for convenience, allowing simpler calls to your ApplyRequests handler. Not used internally. +}; + +// Selection request type +enum ImGuiSelectionRequestType +{ + ImGuiSelectionRequestType_None = 0, + ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetAll, // Request app to clear selection (if Selected==false) or select all items (if Selected==true). We cannot set RangeFirstItem/RangeLastItem as its contents is entirely up to user (not necessarily an index) + ImGuiSelectionRequestType_SetRange, // Request app to select/unselect [RangeFirstItem..RangeLastItem] items (inclusive) based on value of Selected. Only EndMultiSelect() request this, app code can read after BeginMultiSelect() and it will always be false. +}; + +// Selection request item +struct ImGuiSelectionRequest +{ + //------------------------------------------// BeginMultiSelect / EndMultiSelect + ImGuiSelectionRequestType Type; // ms:w, app:r / ms:w, app:r // Request type. You'll most often receive 1 Clear + 1 SetRange with a single-item range. + bool Selected; // ms:w, app:r / ms:w, app:r // Parameter for SetAll/SetRange requests (true = select, false = unselect) + ImS8 RangeDirection; // / ms:w app:r // Parameter for SetRange request: +1 when RangeFirstItem comes before RangeLastItem, -1 otherwise. Useful if you want to preserve selection order on a backward Shift+Click. + ImGuiSelectionUserData RangeFirstItem; // / ms:w, app:r // Parameter for SetRange request (this is generally == RangeSrcItem when shift selecting from top to bottom). + ImGuiSelectionUserData RangeLastItem; // / ms:w, app:r // Parameter for SetRange request (this is generally == RangeSrcItem when shift selecting from bottom to top). Inclusive! +}; + +// Optional helper to store multi-selection state + apply multi-selection requests. +// - Used by our demos and provided as a convenience to easily implement basic multi-selection. +// - Iterate selection with 'void* it = NULL; ImGuiID id; while (selection.GetNextSelectedItem(&it, &id)) { ... }' +// Or you can check 'if (Contains(id)) { ... }' for each possible object if their number is not too high to iterate. +// - USING THIS IS NOT MANDATORY. This is only a helper and not a required API. +// To store a multi-selection, in your application you could: +// - Use this helper as a convenience. We use our simple key->value ImGuiStorage as a std::set replacement. +// - Use your own external storage: e.g. std::set, std::vector, interval trees, intrusively stored selection etc. +// In ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage we: +// - always use indices in the multi-selection API (passed to SetNextItemSelectionUserData(), retrieved in ImGuiMultiSelectIO) +// - use the AdapterIndexToStorageId() indirection layer to abstract how persistent selection data is derived from an index. +// - use decently optimized logic to allow queries and insertion of very large selection sets. +// - do not preserve selection order. +// Many combinations are possible depending on how you prefer to store your items and how you prefer to store your selection. +// Large applications are likely to eventually want to get rid of this indirection layer and do their own thing. +// See https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/wiki/Multi-Select for details and pseudo-code using this helper. +struct ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage +{ + // Members + int Size; // // Number of selected items, maintained by this helper. + bool PreserveOrder; // = false // GetNextSelectedItem() will return ordered selection (currently implemented by two additional sorts of selection. Could be improved) + void* UserData; // = NULL // User data for use by adapter function // e.g. selection.UserData = (void*)my_items; + ImGuiID (*AdapterIndexToStorageId)(ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* self, int idx); // e.g. selection.AdapterIndexToStorageId = [](ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage* self, int idx) { return ((MyItems**)self->UserData)[idx]->ID; }; + int _SelectionOrder;// [Internal] Increasing counter to store selection order + ImGuiStorage _Storage; // [Internal] Selection set. Think of this as similar to e.g. std::set. Prefer not accessing directly: iterate with GetNextSelectedItem(). + + // Methods + ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage(); + IMGUI_API void ApplyRequests(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io); // Apply selection requests coming from BeginMultiSelect() and EndMultiSelect() functions. It uses 'items_count' passed to BeginMultiSelect() + IMGUI_API bool Contains(ImGuiID id) const; // Query if an item id is in selection. + IMGUI_API void Clear(); // Clear selection + IMGUI_API void Swap(ImGuiSelectionBasicStorage& r); // Swap two selections + IMGUI_API void SetItemSelected(ImGuiID id, bool selected); // Add/remove an item from selection (generally done by ApplyRequests() function) + IMGUI_API bool GetNextSelectedItem(void** opaque_it, ImGuiID* out_id); // Iterate selection with 'void* it = NULL; ImGuiId id; while (selection.GetNextSelectedItem(&it, &id)) { ... }' + inline ImGuiID GetStorageIdFromIndex(int idx) { return AdapterIndexToStorageId(this, idx); } // Convert index to item id based on provided adapter. +}; + +// Optional helper to apply multi-selection requests to existing randomly accessible storage. +// Convenient if you want to quickly wire multi-select API on e.g. an array of bool or items storing their own selection state. +struct ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage +{ + // Members + void* UserData; // User data for use by adapter function // e.g. selection.UserData = (void*)my_items; + void (*AdapterSetItemSelected)(ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage* self, int idx, bool selected); // e.g. AdapterSetItemSelected = [](ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage* self, int idx, bool selected) { ((MyItems**)self->UserData)[idx]->Selected = selected; } + + // Methods + IMGUI_API ImGuiSelectionExternalStorage(); + IMGUI_API void ApplyRequests(ImGuiMultiSelectIO* ms_io); // Apply selection requests by using AdapterSetItemSelected() calls +}; + //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Drawing API (ImDrawCmd, ImDrawIdx, ImDrawVert, ImDrawChannel, ImDrawListSplitter, ImDrawListFlags, ImDrawList, ImDrawData) // Hold a series of drawing commands. The user provides a renderer for ImDrawData which essentially contains an array of ImDrawList. @@ -3149,7 +3406,7 @@ struct ImFont float EllipsisCharStep; // 4 // out // Step between characters when EllipsisCount > 0 bool DirtyLookupTables; // 1 // out // float Scale; // 4 // in // = 1.f // Base font scale, multiplied by the per-window font scale which you can adjust with SetWindowFontScale() - float Ascent, Descent; // 4+4 // out // // Ascent: distance from top to bottom of e.g. 'A' [0..FontSize] + float Ascent, Descent; // 4+4 // out // // Ascent: distance from top to bottom of e.g. 'A' [0..FontSize] (unscaled) int MetricsTotalSurface;// 4 // out // // Total surface in pixels to get an idea of the font rasterization/texture cost (not exact, we approximate the cost of padding between glyphs) ImU8 Used4kPagesMap[(IM_UNICODE_CODEPOINT_MAX+1)/4096/8]; // 2 bytes if ImWchar=ImWchar16, 34 bytes if ImWchar==ImWchar32. Store 1-bit for each block of 4K codepoints that has one active glyph. This is mainly used to facilitate iterations across all used codepoints. @@ -3209,6 +3466,7 @@ struct ImGuiViewport ImVec2 WorkSize; // Work Area: Size of the viewport minus task bars, menu bars, status bars (<= Size) // Platform/Backend Dependent Data + void* PlatformHandle; // void* to hold higher-level, platform window handle (e.g. HWND, GLFWWindow*, SDL_Window*) void* PlatformHandleRaw; // void* to hold lower-level, platform-native window handle (under Win32 this is expected to be a HWND, unused for other platforms) ImGuiViewport() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } @@ -3222,7 +3480,7 @@ struct ImGuiViewport // [SECTION] Platform Dependent Interfaces //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// (Optional) Support for IME (Input Method Editor) via the io.SetPlatformImeDataFn() function. +// (Optional) Support for IME (Input Method Editor) via the io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() function. struct ImGuiPlatformImeData { bool WantVisible; // A widget wants the IME to be visible @@ -3241,29 +3499,34 @@ struct ImGuiPlatformImeData #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_FUNCTIONS namespace ImGui { + // OBSOLETED in 1.91.0 (from July 2024) + static inline void PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat) { PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat, repeat); } + static inline void PopButtonRepeat() { PopItemFlag(); } + static inline void PushTabStop(bool tab_stop) { PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, !tab_stop); } + static inline void PopTabStop() { PopItemFlag(); } // OBSOLETED in 1.90.0 (from September 2023) - static inline bool BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = 0) { return BeginChild(id, size, ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle, window_flags); } - static inline void EndChildFrame() { EndChild(); } + static inline bool BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = 0) { return BeginChild(id, size, ImGuiChildFlags_FrameStyle, window_flags); } + static inline void EndChildFrame() { EndChild(); } //static inline bool BeginChild(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags){ return BeginChild(str_id, size_arg, border ? ImGuiChildFlags_Border : ImGuiChildFlags_None, window_flags); } // Unnecessary as true == ImGuiChildFlags_Border //static inline bool BeginChild(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags) { return BeginChild(id, size_arg, border ? ImGuiChildFlags_Border : ImGuiChildFlags_None, window_flags); } // Unnecessary as true == ImGuiChildFlags_Border - static inline void ShowStackToolWindow(bool* p_open = NULL) { ShowIDStackToolWindow(p_open); } - IMGUI_API bool ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*old_callback)(void* user_data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* user_data, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1); + static inline void ShowStackToolWindow(bool* p_open = NULL) { ShowIDStackToolWindow(p_open); } IMGUI_API bool Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*old_callback)(void* user_data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* user_data, int items_count, int popup_max_height_in_items = -1); + IMGUI_API bool ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*old_callback)(void* user_data, int idx, const char** out_text), void* user_data, int items_count, int height_in_items = -1); // OBSOLETED in 1.89.7 (from June 2023) - IMGUI_API void SetItemAllowOverlap(); // Use SetNextItemAllowOverlap() before item. + IMGUI_API void SetItemAllowOverlap(); // Use SetNextItemAllowOverlap() before item. // OBSOLETED in 1.89.4 (from March 2023) - static inline void PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool tab_stop) { PushTabStop(tab_stop); } - static inline void PopAllowKeyboardFocus() { PopTabStop(); } + static inline void PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool tab_stop) { PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop, !tab_stop); } + static inline void PopAllowKeyboardFocus() { PopItemFlag(); } // OBSOLETED in 1.89 (from August 2022) IMGUI_API bool ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0 = ImVec2(0, 0), const ImVec2& uv1 = ImVec2(1, 1), int frame_padding = -1, const ImVec4& bg_col = ImVec4(0, 0, 0, 0), const ImVec4& tint_col = ImVec4(1, 1, 1, 1)); // Use new ImageButton() signature (explicit item id, regular FramePadding) - // OBSOLETED in 1.87 (from February 2022) - IMGUI_API ImGuiKey GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey key); // Map ImGuiKey_* values into legacy native key index. == io.KeyMap[key]. When using a 1.87+ backend using io.AddKeyEvent(), calling GetKeyIndex() with ANY ImGuiKey_XXXX values will return the same value! - //static inline ImGuiKey GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey key) { IM_ASSERT(key >= ImGuiKey_NamedKey_BEGIN && key < ImGuiKey_NamedKey_END); return key; } + // OBSOLETED in 1.87 (from February 2022 but more formally obsoleted April 2024) + IMGUI_API ImGuiKey GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey key); // Map ImGuiKey_* values into legacy native key index. == io.KeyMap[key]. When using a 1.87+ backend using io.AddKeyEvent(), calling GetKeyIndex() with ANY ImGuiKey_XXXX values will return the same value! + //static inline ImGuiKey GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey key) { IM_ASSERT(key >= ImGuiKey_NamedKey_BEGIN && key < ImGuiKey_NamedKey_END); return key; } // Some of the older obsolete names along with their replacement (commented out so they are not reported in IDE) //-- OBSOLETED in 1.88 (from May 2022) - //static inline void CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool want_capture_keyboard = true) { SetNextFrameWantCaptureKeyboard(want_capture_keyboard); } // Renamed as name was misleading + removed default value. - //static inline void CaptureMouseFromApp(bool want_capture_mouse = true) { SetNextFrameWantCaptureMouse(want_capture_mouse); } // Renamed as name was misleading + removed default value. + //static inline void CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool want_capture_keyboard = true) { SetNextFrameWantCaptureKeyboard(want_capture_keyboard); } // Renamed as name was misleading + removed default value. + //static inline void CaptureMouseFromApp(bool want_capture_mouse = true) { SetNextFrameWantCaptureMouse(want_capture_mouse); } // Renamed as name was misleading + removed default value. //-- OBSOLETED in 1.86 (from November 2021) //IMGUI_API void CalcListClipping(int items_count, float items_height, int* out_items_display_start, int* out_items_display_end); // Code removed, see 1.90 for last version of the code. Calculate range of visible items for large list of evenly sized items. Prefer using ImGuiListClipper. //-- OBSOLETED in 1.85 (from August 2021) @@ -3336,8 +3599,8 @@ namespace ImGui // RENAMED and MERGED both ImGuiKey_ModXXX and ImGuiModFlags_XXX into ImGuiMod_XXX (from September 2022) // RENAMED ImGuiKeyModFlags -> ImGuiModFlags in 1.88 (from April 2022). Exceptionally commented out ahead of obscolescence schedule to reduce confusion and because they were not meant to be used in the first place. -typedef ImGuiKeyChord ImGuiModFlags; // == int. We generally use ImGuiKeyChord to mean "a ImGuiKey or-ed with any number of ImGuiMod_XXX value", but you may store only mods in there. -enum ImGuiModFlags_ { ImGuiModFlags_None = 0, ImGuiModFlags_Ctrl = ImGuiMod_Ctrl, ImGuiModFlags_Shift = ImGuiMod_Shift, ImGuiModFlags_Alt = ImGuiMod_Alt, ImGuiModFlags_Super = ImGuiMod_Super }; +//typedef ImGuiKeyChord ImGuiModFlags; // == int. We generally use ImGuiKeyChord to mean "a ImGuiKey or-ed with any number of ImGuiMod_XXX value", so you may store mods in there. +//enum ImGuiModFlags_ { ImGuiModFlags_None = 0, ImGuiModFlags_Ctrl = ImGuiMod_Ctrl, ImGuiModFlags_Shift = ImGuiMod_Shift, ImGuiModFlags_Alt = ImGuiMod_Alt, ImGuiModFlags_Super = ImGuiMod_Super }; //typedef ImGuiKeyChord ImGuiKeyModFlags; // == int //enum ImGuiKeyModFlags_ { ImGuiKeyModFlags_None = 0, ImGuiKeyModFlags_Ctrl = ImGuiMod_Ctrl, ImGuiKeyModFlags_Shift = ImGuiMod_Shift, ImGuiKeyModFlags_Alt = ImGuiMod_Alt, ImGuiKeyModFlags_Super = ImGuiMod_Super }; diff --git a/include/imgui_internal.h b/include/imgui_internal.h index 2a31473c5dfb..3bcca85004fd 100644 --- a/include/imgui_internal.h +++ b/include/imgui_internal.h @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.90.8 WIP +// dear imgui, v1.91.0 WIP // (internal structures/api) // You may use this file to debug, understand or extend Dear ImGui features but we don't provide any guarantee of forward compatibility. @@ -14,14 +14,15 @@ Index of this file: // [SECTION] Macros // [SECTION] Generic helpers // [SECTION] ImDrawList support -// [SECTION] Widgets support: flags, enums, data structures // [SECTION] Data types support +// [SECTION] Widgets support: flags, enums, data structures // [SECTION] Popup support // [SECTION] Inputs support // [SECTION] Clipper support // [SECTION] Navigation support // [SECTION] Typing-select support // [SECTION] Columns support +// [SECTION] Box-select support // [SECTION] Multi-select support // [SECTION] Docking support // [SECTION] Viewport support @@ -123,6 +124,7 @@ struct ImBitVector; // Store 1-bit per value struct ImRect; // An axis-aligned rectangle (2 points) struct ImDrawDataBuilder; // Helper to build a ImDrawData instance struct ImDrawListSharedData; // Data shared between all ImDrawList instances +struct ImGuiBoxSelectState; // Box-selection state (currently used by multi-selection, could potentially be used by others) struct ImGuiColorMod; // Stacked color modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it struct ImGuiContext; // Main Dear ImGui context struct ImGuiContextHook; // Hook for extensions like ImGuiTestEngine @@ -134,8 +136,9 @@ struct ImGuiInputTextDeactivateData;// Short term storage to backup text of a de struct ImGuiLastItemData; // Status storage for last submitted items struct ImGuiLocEntry; // A localization entry. struct ImGuiMenuColumns; // Simple column measurement, currently used for MenuItem() only +struct ImGuiMultiSelectState; // Multi-selection persistent state (for focused selection). +struct ImGuiMultiSelectTempData; // Multi-selection temporary state (while traversing). struct ImGuiNavItemData; // Result of a gamepad/keyboard directional navigation move query result -struct ImGuiNavTreeNodeData; // Temporary storage for last TreeNode() being a Left arrow landing candidate. struct ImGuiMetricsConfig; // Storage for ShowMetricsWindow() and DebugNodeXXX() functions struct ImGuiNextWindowData; // Storage for SetNextWindow** functions struct ImGuiNextItemData; // Storage for SetNextItem** functions @@ -154,6 +157,7 @@ struct ImGuiTableInstanceData; // Storage for one instance of a same table struct ImGuiTableTempData; // Temporary storage for one table (one per table in the stack), shared between tables. struct ImGuiTableSettings; // Storage for a table .ini settings struct ImGuiTableColumnsSettings; // Storage for a column .ini settings +struct ImGuiTreeNodeStackData; // Temporary storage for TreeNode(). struct ImGuiTypingSelectState; // Storage for GetTypingSelectRequest() struct ImGuiTypingSelectRequest; // Storage for GetTypingSelectRequest() (aimed to be public) struct ImGuiWindow; // Storage for one window @@ -169,7 +173,6 @@ typedef int ImGuiLayoutType; // -> enum ImGuiLayoutType_ // E typedef int ImGuiActivateFlags; // -> enum ImGuiActivateFlags_ // Flags: for navigation/focus function (will be for ActivateItem() later) typedef int ImGuiDebugLogFlags; // -> enum ImGuiDebugLogFlags_ // Flags: for ShowDebugLogWindow(), g.DebugLogFlags typedef int ImGuiFocusRequestFlags; // -> enum ImGuiFocusRequestFlags_ // Flags: for FocusWindow(); -typedef int ImGuiItemFlags; // -> enum ImGuiItemFlags_ // Flags: for PushItemFlag(), g.LastItemData.InFlags typedef int ImGuiItemStatusFlags; // -> enum ImGuiItemStatusFlags_ // Flags: for g.LastItemData.StatusFlags typedef int ImGuiOldColumnFlags; // -> enum ImGuiOldColumnFlags_ // Flags: for BeginColumns() typedef int ImGuiNavHighlightFlags; // -> enum ImGuiNavHighlightFlags_ // Flags: for RenderNavHighlight() @@ -348,6 +351,7 @@ namespace ImStb // - Helper: ImPool<> // - Helper: ImChunkStream<> // - Helper: ImGuiTextIndex +// - Helper: ImGuiStorage //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // Helpers: Hashing @@ -384,6 +388,7 @@ IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_OFF static inline char ImToUpper(char c) { return (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z') ? c &= ~32 : c; } static inline bool ImCharIsBlankA(char c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t'; } static inline bool ImCharIsBlankW(unsigned int c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == 0x3000; } +static inline bool ImCharIsXdigitA(char c) { return (c >= '0' && c <= '9') || (c >= 'A' && c <= 'F') || (c >= 'a' && c <= 'f'); } IM_MSVC_RUNTIME_CHECKS_RESTORE // Helpers: Formatting @@ -488,6 +493,7 @@ static inline int ImModPositive(int a, int b) static inline float ImDot(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b) { return a.x * b.x + a.y * b.y; } static inline ImVec2 ImRotate(const ImVec2& v, float cos_a, float sin_a) { return ImVec2(v.x * cos_a - v.y * sin_a, v.x * sin_a + v.y * cos_a); } static inline float ImLinearSweep(float current, float target, float speed) { if (current < target) return ImMin(current + speed, target); if (current > target) return ImMax(current - speed, target); return current; } +static inline float ImLinearRemapClamp(float s0, float s1, float d0, float d1, float x) { return ImSaturate((x - s0) / (s1 - s0)) * (d1 - d0) + d0; } static inline ImVec2 ImMul(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x * rhs.x, lhs.y * rhs.y); } static inline bool ImIsFloatAboveGuaranteedIntegerPrecision(float f) { return f <= -16777216 || f >= 16777216; } static inline float ImExponentialMovingAverage(float avg, float sample, int n) { avg -= avg / n; avg += sample / n; return avg; } @@ -722,7 +728,7 @@ struct ImChunkStream void swap(ImChunkStream& rhs) { rhs.Buf.swap(Buf); } }; -// Helper: ImGuiTextIndex<> +// Helper: ImGuiTextIndex // Maintain a line index for a text buffer. This is a strong candidate to be moved into the public API. struct ImGuiTextIndex { @@ -736,6 +742,8 @@ struct ImGuiTextIndex void append(const char* base, int old_size, int new_size); }; +// Helper: ImGuiStorage +IMGUI_API ImGuiStoragePair* ImLowerBound(ImGuiStoragePair* in_begin, ImGuiStoragePair* in_end, ImGuiID key); //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] ImDrawList support //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -772,6 +780,7 @@ struct IMGUI_API ImDrawListSharedData ImVec2 TexUvWhitePixel; // UV of white pixel in the atlas ImFont* Font; // Current/default font (optional, for simplified AddText overload) float FontSize; // Current/default font size (optional, for simplified AddText overload) + float FontScale; // Current/default font scale (== FontSize / Font->FontSize) float CurveTessellationTol; // Tessellation tolerance when using PathBezierCurveTo() float CircleSegmentMaxError; // Number of circle segments to use per pixel of radius for AddCircle() etc ImVec4 ClipRectFullscreen; // Value for PushClipRectFullscreen() @@ -798,33 +807,65 @@ struct ImDrawDataBuilder ImDrawDataBuilder() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } }; +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Data types support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiDataVarInfo +{ + ImGuiDataType Type; + ImU32 Count; // 1+ + ImU32 Offset; // Offset in parent structure + void* GetVarPtr(void* parent) const { return (void*)((unsigned char*)parent + Offset); } +}; + +struct ImGuiDataTypeStorage +{ + ImU8 Data[8]; // Opaque storage to fit any data up to ImGuiDataType_COUNT +}; + +// Type information associated to one ImGuiDataType. Retrieve with DataTypeGetInfo(). +struct ImGuiDataTypeInfo +{ + size_t Size; // Size in bytes + const char* Name; // Short descriptive name for the type, for debugging + const char* PrintFmt; // Default printf format for the type + const char* ScanFmt; // Default scanf format for the type +}; + +// Extend ImGuiDataType_ +enum ImGuiDataTypePrivate_ +{ + ImGuiDataType_String = ImGuiDataType_COUNT + 1, + ImGuiDataType_Pointer, + ImGuiDataType_ID, +}; + //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Widgets support: flags, enums, data structures //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Flags used by upcoming items +// Extend ImGuiItemFlags // - input: PushItemFlag() manipulates g.CurrentItemFlags, ItemAdd() calls may add extra flags. // - output: stored in g.LastItemData.InFlags -// Current window shared by all windows. -// This is going to be exposed in imgui.h when stabilized enough. -enum ImGuiItemFlags_ +enum ImGuiItemFlagsPrivate_ { // Controlled by user - ImGuiItemFlags_None = 0, - ImGuiItemFlags_NoTabStop = 1 << 0, // false // Disable keyboard tabbing. This is a "lighter" version of ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav. - ImGuiItemFlags_ButtonRepeat = 1 << 1, // false // Button() will return true multiple times based on io.KeyRepeatDelay and io.KeyRepeatRate settings. - ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled = 1 << 2, // false // Disable interactions but doesn't affect visuals. See BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled(). See github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/211 - ImGuiItemFlags_NoNav = 1 << 3, // false // Disable any form of focusing (keyboard/gamepad directional navigation and SetKeyboardFocusHere() calls) - ImGuiItemFlags_NoNavDefaultFocus = 1 << 4, // false // Disable item being a candidate for default focus (e.g. used by title bar items) - ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup = 1 << 5, // false // Disable MenuItem/Selectable() automatically closing their popup window - ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue = 1 << 6, // false // [BETA] Represent a mixed/indeterminate value, generally multi-selection where values differ. Currently only supported by Checkbox() (later should support all sorts of widgets) - ImGuiItemFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 7, // false // [ALPHA] Allow hovering interactions but underlying value is not changed. - ImGuiItemFlags_NoWindowHoverableCheck = 1 << 8, // false // Disable hoverable check in ItemHoverable() - ImGuiItemFlags_AllowOverlap = 1 << 9, // false // Allow being overlapped by another widget. Not-hovered to Hovered transition deferred by a frame. + ImGuiItemFlags_Disabled = 1 << 10, // false // Disable interactions (DOES NOT affect visuals, see BeginDisabled()/EndDisabled() for full disable feature, and github #211). + ImGuiItemFlags_ReadOnly = 1 << 11, // false // [ALPHA] Allow hovering interactions but underlying value is not changed. + ImGuiItemFlags_MixedValue = 1 << 12, // false // [BETA] Represent a mixed/indeterminate value, generally multi-selection where values differ. Currently only supported by Checkbox() (later should support all sorts of widgets) + ImGuiItemFlags_NoWindowHoverableCheck = 1 << 13, // false // Disable hoverable check in ItemHoverable() + ImGuiItemFlags_AllowOverlap = 1 << 14, // false // Allow being overlapped by another widget. Not-hovered to Hovered transition deferred by a frame. // Controlled by widget code - ImGuiItemFlags_Inputable = 1 << 10, // false // [WIP] Auto-activate input mode when tab focused. Currently only used and supported by a few items before it becomes a generic feature. - ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData = 1 << 11, // false // Set by SetNextItemSelectionUserData() + ImGuiItemFlags_Inputable = 1 << 20, // false // [WIP] Auto-activate input mode when tab focused. Currently only used and supported by a few items before it becomes a generic feature. + ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData = 1 << 21, // false // Set by SetNextItemSelectionUserData() + ImGuiItemFlags_IsMultiSelect = 1 << 22, // false // Set by SetNextItemSelectionUserData() + + ImGuiItemFlags_Default_ = ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups, // Please don't change, use PushItemFlag() instead. + + // Obsolete + //ImGuiItemFlags_SelectableDontClosePopup = !ImGuiItemFlags_AutoClosePopups, // Can't have a redirect as we inverted the behavior }; // Status flags for an already submitted item @@ -927,8 +968,8 @@ enum ImGuiSelectableFlagsPrivate_ // Extend ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlagsPrivate_ { - ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton = 1 << 20, - ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_UpsideDownArrow = 1 << 21,// (FIXME-WIP) Turn Down arrow into an Up arrow, but reversed trees (#6517) + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ClipLabelForTrailingButton = 1 << 28,// FIXME-WIP: Hard-coded for CollapsingHeader() + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_UpsideDownArrow = 1 << 29,// FIXME-WIP: Turn Down arrow into an Up arrow, but reversed trees (#6517) }; enum ImGuiSeparatorFlags_ @@ -1167,29 +1208,28 @@ struct ImGuiNextWindowData inline void ClearFlags() { Flags = ImGuiNextWindowDataFlags_None; } }; -// Multi-Selection item index or identifier when using SetNextItemSelectionUserData()/BeginMultiSelect() -// (Most users are likely to use this store an item INDEX but this may be used to store a POINTER as well.) -typedef ImS64 ImGuiSelectionUserData; - enum ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_ { ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_None = 0, ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasWidth = 1 << 0, ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasOpen = 1 << 1, ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasShortcut = 1 << 2, + ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_HasRefVal = 1 << 3, }; struct ImGuiNextItemData { ImGuiNextItemDataFlags Flags; - ImGuiItemFlags ItemFlags; // Currently only tested/used for ImGuiItemFlags_AllowOverlap. + ImGuiItemFlags ItemFlags; // Currently only tested/used for ImGuiItemFlags_AllowOverlap and ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData. // Non-flags members are NOT cleared by ItemAdd() meaning they are still valid during NavProcessItem() + ImGuiID FocusScopeId; // Set by SetNextItemSelectionUserData() ImGuiSelectionUserData SelectionUserData; // Set by SetNextItemSelectionUserData() (note that NULL/0 is a valid value, we use -1 == ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid to mark invalid values) float Width; // Set by SetNextItemWidth() ImGuiKeyChord Shortcut; // Set by SetNextItemShortcut() ImGuiInputFlags ShortcutFlags; // Set by SetNextItemShortcut() bool OpenVal; // Set by SetNextItemOpen() - ImGuiCond OpenCond : 8; + ImU8 OpenCond; // Set by SetNextItemOpen() + ImGuiDataTypeStorage RefVal; // Not exposed yet, for ImGuiInputTextFlags_ParseEmptyAsRefVal ImGuiNextItemData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); SelectionUserData = -1; } inline void ClearFlags() { Flags = ImGuiNextItemDataFlags_None; ItemFlags = ImGuiItemFlags_None; } // Also cleared manually by ItemAdd()! @@ -1211,14 +1251,16 @@ struct ImGuiLastItemData ImGuiLastItemData() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } }; -// Store data emitted by TreeNode() for usage by TreePop() to implement ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere. -// This is the minimum amount of data that we need to perform the equivalent of NavApplyItemToResult() and which we can't infer in TreePop() -// Only stored when the node is a potential candidate for landing on a Left arrow jump. -struct ImGuiNavTreeNodeData +// Store data emitted by TreeNode() for usage by TreePop() +// - To implement ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NavLeftJumpsBackHere: store the minimum amount of data +// which we can't infer in TreePop(), to perform the equivalent of NavApplyItemToResult(). +// Only stored when the node is a potential candidate for landing on a Left arrow jump. +struct ImGuiTreeNodeStackData { ImGuiID ID; - ImGuiItemFlags InFlags; - ImRect NavRect; + ImGuiTreeNodeFlags TreeFlags; + ImGuiItemFlags InFlags; // Used for nav landing + ImRect NavRect; // Used for nav landing }; struct IMGUI_API ImGuiStackSizes @@ -1243,7 +1285,8 @@ struct ImGuiWindowStackData { ImGuiWindow* Window; ImGuiLastItemData ParentLastItemDataBackup; - ImGuiStackSizes StackSizesOnBegin; // Store size of various stacks for asserting + ImGuiStackSizes StackSizesOnBegin; // Store size of various stacks for asserting + bool DisabledOverrideReenable; // Non-child window override disabled flag }; struct ImGuiShrinkWidthItem @@ -1262,40 +1305,6 @@ struct ImGuiPtrOrIndex ImGuiPtrOrIndex(int index) { Ptr = NULL; Index = index; } }; -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// [SECTION] Data types support -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -struct ImGuiDataVarInfo -{ - ImGuiDataType Type; - ImU32 Count; // 1+ - ImU32 Offset; // Offset in parent structure - void* GetVarPtr(void* parent) const { return (void*)((unsigned char*)parent + Offset); } -}; - -struct ImGuiDataTypeTempStorage -{ - ImU8 Data[8]; // Can fit any data up to ImGuiDataType_COUNT -}; - -// Type information associated to one ImGuiDataType. Retrieve with DataTypeGetInfo(). -struct ImGuiDataTypeInfo -{ - size_t Size; // Size in bytes - const char* Name; // Short descriptive name for the type, for debugging - const char* PrintFmt; // Default printf format for the type - const char* ScanFmt; // Default scanf format for the type -}; - -// Extend ImGuiDataType_ -enum ImGuiDataTypePrivate_ -{ - ImGuiDataType_String = ImGuiDataType_COUNT + 1, - ImGuiDataType_Pointer, - ImGuiDataType_ID, -}; - //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Popup support //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -1593,7 +1602,7 @@ struct ImGuiNavItemData float DistBox; // Move // Best candidate box distance to current NavId float DistCenter; // Move // Best candidate center distance to current NavId float DistAxial; // Move // Best candidate axial distance to current NavId - ImGuiSelectionUserData SelectionUserData;//I+Mov // Best candidate SetNextItemSelectionData() value. + ImGuiSelectionUserData SelectionUserData;//I+Mov // Best candidate SetNextItemSelectionUserData() value. Valid if (InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData) ImGuiNavItemData() { Clear(); } void Clear() { Window = NULL; ID = FocusScopeId = 0; InFlags = 0; SelectionUserData = -1; DistBox = DistCenter = DistAxial = FLT_MAX; } @@ -1699,6 +1708,33 @@ struct ImGuiOldColumns ImGuiOldColumns() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } }; +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +// [SECTION] Box-select support +//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +struct ImGuiBoxSelectState +{ + // Active box-selection data (persistent, 1 active at a time) + ImGuiID ID; + bool IsActive; + bool IsStarting; + bool IsStartedFromVoid; // Starting click was not from an item. + bool RequestClear; + ImGuiKeyChord KeyMods : 16; // Latched key-mods for box-select logic. + ImVec2 StartPosRel; // Start position in window-contents relative space (to support scrolling) + ImVec2 EndPosRel; // End position in window-contents relative space + ImVec2 ScrollAccum; // Scrolling accumulator (to behave at high-frame spaces) + ImGuiWindow* Window; + + // Temporary/Transient data + bool UnclipMode; // (Temp/Transient, here in hot area). Set/cleared by the BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() owning active box-select. + ImRect UnclipRect; // Rectangle where ItemAdd() clipping may be temporarily disabled. Need support by multi-select supporting widgets. + ImRect BoxSelectRectPrev; // Selection rectangle in absolute coordinates (derived every frame from BoxSelectStartPosRel and MousePos) + ImRect BoxSelectRectCurr; + + ImGuiBoxSelectState() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } +}; + //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Multi-select support //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- @@ -1706,9 +1742,45 @@ struct ImGuiOldColumns // We always assume that -1 is an invalid value (which works for indices and pointers) #define ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid ((ImGuiSelectionUserData)-1) -#ifdef IMGUI_HAS_MULTI_SELECT -// -#endif // #ifdef IMGUI_HAS_MULTI_SELECT +// Temporary storage for multi-select +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiMultiSelectTempData +{ + ImGuiMultiSelectIO IO; // MUST BE FIRST FIELD. Requests are set and returned by BeginMultiSelect()/EndMultiSelect() + written to by user during the loop. + ImGuiMultiSelectState* Storage; + ImGuiID FocusScopeId; // Copied from g.CurrentFocusScopeId (unless another selection scope was pushed manually) + ImGuiMultiSelectFlags Flags; + ImVec2 ScopeRectMin; + ImVec2 BackupCursorMaxPos; + ImGuiSelectionUserData LastSubmittedItem; // Copy of last submitted item data, used to merge output ranges. + ImGuiID BoxSelectId; + ImGuiKeyChord KeyMods; + ImS8 LoopRequestSetAll; // -1: no operation, 0: clear all, 1: select all. + bool IsEndIO; // Set when switching IO from BeginMultiSelect() to EndMultiSelect() state. + bool IsFocused; // Set if currently focusing the selection scope (any item of the selection). May be used if you have custom shortcut associated to selection. + bool IsKeyboardSetRange; // Set by BeginMultiSelect() when using Shift+Navigation. Because scrolling may be affected we can't afford a frame of lag with Shift+Navigation. + bool NavIdPassedBy; + bool RangeSrcPassedBy; // Set by the item that matches RangeSrcItem. + bool RangeDstPassedBy; // Set by the item that matches NavJustMovedToId when IsSetRange is set. + + ImGuiMultiSelectTempData() { Clear(); } + void Clear() { size_t io_sz = sizeof(IO); ClearIO(); memset((void*)(&IO + 1), 0, sizeof(*this) - io_sz); } // Zero-clear except IO as we preserve IO.Requests[] buffer allocation. + void ClearIO() { IO.Requests.resize(0); IO.RangeSrcItem = IO.NavIdItem = ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid; IO.NavIdSelected = IO.RangeSrcReset = false; } +}; + +// Persistent storage for multi-select (as long as selection is alive) +struct IMGUI_API ImGuiMultiSelectState +{ + ImGuiWindow* Window; + ImGuiID ID; + int LastFrameActive; // Last used frame-count, for GC. + int LastSelectionSize; // Set by BeginMultiSelect() based on optional info provided by user. May be -1 if unknown. + ImS8 RangeSelected; // -1 (don't have) or true/false + ImS8 NavIdSelected; // -1 (don't have) or true/false + ImGuiSelectionUserData RangeSrcItem; // + ImGuiSelectionUserData NavIdItem; // SetNextItemSelectionUserData() value for NavId (if part of submitted items) + + ImGuiMultiSelectState() { Window = NULL; ID = 0; LastFrameActive = LastSelectionSize = 0; RangeSelected = NavIdSelected = -1; RangeSrcItem = NavIdItem = ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid; } +}; //----------------------------------------------------------------------------- // [SECTION] Docking support @@ -1800,6 +1872,7 @@ enum ImGuiLocKey : int ImGuiLocKey_WindowingMainMenuBar, ImGuiLocKey_WindowingPopup, ImGuiLocKey_WindowingUntitled, + ImGuiLocKey_CopyLink, ImGuiLocKey_COUNT }; @@ -1921,6 +1994,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImFont* Font; // (Shortcut) == FontStack.empty() ? IO.Font : FontStack.back() float FontSize; // (Shortcut) == FontBaseSize * g.CurrentWindow->FontWindowScale == window->FontSize(). Text height for current window. float FontBaseSize; // (Shortcut) == IO.FontGlobalScale * Font->Scale * Font->FontSize. Base text height. + float FontScale; // == FontSize / Font->FontSize float CurrentDpiScale; // Current window/viewport DpiScale ImDrawListSharedData DrawListSharedData; double Time; @@ -1933,6 +2007,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext bool GcCompactAll; // Request full GC bool TestEngineHookItems; // Will call test engine hooks: ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemAdd(), ImGuiTestEngineHook_ItemInfo(), ImGuiTestEngineHook_Log() void* TestEngine; // Test engine user data + char ContextName[16]; // Storage for a context name (to facilitate debugging multi-context setups) // Inputs ImVector InputEventsQueue; // Input events which will be trickled/written into IO structure. @@ -1952,6 +2027,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImGuiWindow* CurrentWindow; // Window being drawn into ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindow; // Window the mouse is hovering. Will typically catch mouse inputs. ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow; // Hovered window ignoring MovingWindow. Only set if MovingWindow is set. + ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindowBeforeClear; // Window the mouse is hovering. Filled even with _NoMouse. This is currently useful for multi-context compositors. ImGuiWindow* MovingWindow; // Track the window we clicked on (in order to preserve focus). The actual window that is moved is generally MovingWindow->RootWindow. ImGuiWindow* WheelingWindow; // Track the window we started mouse-wheeling on. Until a timer elapse or mouse has moved, generally keep scrolling the same window even if during the course of scrolling the mouse ends up hovering a child window. ImVec2 WheelingWindowRefMousePos; @@ -1965,10 +2041,11 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImGuiID DebugHookIdInfo; // Will call core hooks: DebugHookIdInfo() from GetID functions, used by ID Stack Tool [next HoveredId/ActiveId to not pull in an extra cache-line] ImGuiID HoveredId; // Hovered widget, filled during the frame ImGuiID HoveredIdPreviousFrame; - bool HoveredIdAllowOverlap; - bool HoveredIdDisabled; // At least one widget passed the rect test, but has been discarded by disabled flag or popup inhibit. May be true even if HoveredId == 0. float HoveredIdTimer; // Measure contiguous hovering time float HoveredIdNotActiveTimer; // Measure contiguous hovering time where the item has not been active + bool HoveredIdAllowOverlap; + bool HoveredIdIsDisabled; // At least one widget passed the rect test, but has been discarded by disabled flag or popup inhibit. May be true even if HoveredId == 0. + bool ItemUnclipByLog; // Disable ItemAdd() clipping, essentially a memory-locality friendly copy of LogEnabled ImGuiID ActiveId; // Active widget ImGuiID ActiveIdIsAlive; // Active widget has been seen this frame (we can't use a bool as the ActiveId may change within the frame) float ActiveIdTimer; @@ -2001,7 +2078,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImGuiKeyOwnerData KeysOwnerData[ImGuiKey_NamedKey_COUNT]; ImGuiKeyRoutingTable KeysRoutingTable; ImU32 ActiveIdUsingNavDirMask; // Active widget will want to read those nav move requests (e.g. can activate a button and move away from it) - bool ActiveIdUsingAllKeyboardKeys; // Active widget will want to read all keyboard keys inputs. (FIXME: This is a shortcut for not taking ownership of 100+ keys but perhaps best to not have the inconsistency) + bool ActiveIdUsingAllKeyboardKeys; // Active widget will want to read all keyboard keys inputs. (this is a shortcut for not taking ownership of 100+ keys, frequently used by drag operations) ImGuiKeyChord DebugBreakInShortcutRouting; // Set to break in SetShortcutRouting()/Shortcut() calls. #ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_OBSOLETE_KEYIO ImU32 ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask; // If you used this. Since (IMGUI_VERSION_NUM >= 18804) : 'g.ActiveIdUsingNavInputMask |= (1 << ImGuiNavInput_Cancel);' becomes 'SetKeyOwner(ImGuiKey_Escape, g.ActiveId) and/or SetKeyOwner(ImGuiKey_NavGamepadCancel, g.ActiveId);' @@ -2026,7 +2103,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImVector GroupStack; // Stack for BeginGroup()/EndGroup() - not inherited by Begin() ImVector OpenPopupStack; // Which popups are open (persistent) ImVector BeginPopupStack; // Which level of BeginPopup() we are in (reset every frame) - ImVector NavTreeNodeStack; // Stack for TreeNode() when a NavLeft requested is emitted. + ImVectorTreeNodeStack; // Stack for TreeNode() // Viewports ImVector Viewports; // Active viewports (Size==1 in 'master' branch). Each viewports hold their copy of ImDrawData. @@ -2035,20 +2112,17 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImGuiWindow* NavWindow; // Focused window for navigation. Could be called 'FocusedWindow' ImGuiID NavId; // Focused item for navigation ImGuiID NavFocusScopeId; // Focused focus scope (e.g. selection code often wants to "clear other items" when landing on an item of the same scope) - ImVector NavFocusRoute; // Reversed copy focus scope stack for NavId (should contains NavFocusScopeId). This essentially follow the window->ParentWindowForFocusRoute chain. + ImGuiNavLayer NavLayer; // Focused layer (main scrolling layer, or menu/title bar layer) ImGuiID NavActivateId; // ~~ (g.ActiveId == 0) && (IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Space) || IsKeyDown(ImGuiKey_Enter) || IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_NavGamepadActivate)) ? NavId : 0, also set when calling ActivateItem() ImGuiID NavActivateDownId; // ~~ IsKeyDown(ImGuiKey_Space) || IsKeyDown(ImGuiKey_Enter) || IsKeyDown(ImGuiKey_NavGamepadActivate) ? NavId : 0 ImGuiID NavActivatePressedId; // ~~ IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Space) || IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_Enter) || IsKeyPressed(ImGuiKey_NavGamepadActivate) ? NavId : 0 (no repeat) ImGuiActivateFlags NavActivateFlags; + ImVector NavFocusRoute; // Reversed copy focus scope stack for NavId (should contains NavFocusScopeId). This essentially follow the window->ParentWindowForFocusRoute chain. ImGuiID NavHighlightActivatedId; float NavHighlightActivatedTimer; - ImGuiID NavJustMovedToId; // Just navigated to this id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). - ImGuiID NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId; // Just navigated to this focus scope id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). - ImGuiKeyChord NavJustMovedToKeyMods; ImGuiID NavNextActivateId; // Set by ActivateItem(), queued until next frame. ImGuiActivateFlags NavNextActivateFlags; ImGuiInputSource NavInputSource; // Keyboard or Gamepad mode? THIS CAN ONLY BE ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard or ImGuiInputSource_Mouse - ImGuiNavLayer NavLayer; // Layer we are navigating on. For now the system is hard-coded for 0=main contents and 1=menu/title bar, may expose layers later. ImGuiSelectionUserData NavLastValidSelectionUserData; // Last valid data passed to SetNextItemSelectionUser(), or -1. For current window. Not reset when focusing an item that doesn't have selection data. bool NavIdIsAlive; // Nav widget has been seen this frame ~~ NavRectRel is valid bool NavMousePosDirty; // When set we will update mouse position if (io.ConfigFlags & ImGuiConfigFlags_NavEnableSetMousePos) if set (NB: this not enabled by default) @@ -2079,6 +2153,14 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImGuiNavItemData NavMoveResultOther; // Best move request candidate within NavWindow's flattened hierarchy (when using ImGuiWindowFlags_NavFlattened flag) ImGuiNavItemData NavTabbingResultFirst; // First tabbing request candidate within NavWindow and flattened hierarchy + // Navigation: record of last move request + ImGuiID NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId; // Just navigated from this focus scope id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). + ImGuiID NavJustMovedToId; // Just navigated to this id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). + ImGuiID NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId; // Just navigated to this focus scope id (result of a successfully MoveRequest). + ImGuiKeyChord NavJustMovedToKeyMods; + bool NavJustMovedToIsTabbing; // Copy of ImGuiNavMoveFlags_IsTabbing. Maybe we should store whole flags. + bool NavJustMovedToHasSelectionData; // Copy of move result's InFlags & ImGuiItemFlags_HasSelectionUserData). Maybe we should just store ImGuiNavItemData. + // Navigation: Windowing (CTRL+TAB for list, or Menu button + keys or directional pads to move/resize) ImGuiKeyChord ConfigNavWindowingKeyNext; // = ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiKey_Tab (or ImGuiMod_Super | ImGuiKey_Tab on OS X). For reconfiguration (see #4828) ImGuiKeyChord ConfigNavWindowingKeyPrev; // = ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiMod_Shift | ImGuiKey_Tab (or ImGuiMod_Super | ImGuiMod_Shift | ImGuiKey_Tab on OS X) @@ -2134,6 +2216,13 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImVector CurrentTabBarStack; ImVector ShrinkWidthBuffer; + // Multi-Select state + ImGuiBoxSelectState BoxSelectState; + ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* CurrentMultiSelect; + int MultiSelectTempDataStacked; // Temporary multi-select data size (because we leave previous instances undestructed, we generally don't use MultiSelectTempData.Size) + ImVector MultiSelectTempData; + ImPool MultiSelectStorage; + // Hover Delay system ImGuiID HoverItemDelayId; ImGuiID HoverItemDelayIdPreviousFrame; @@ -2152,6 +2241,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext ImGuiInputTextDeactivatedState InputTextDeactivatedState; ImFont InputTextPasswordFont; ImGuiID TempInputId; // Temporary text input when CTRL+clicking on a slider, etc. + ImGuiDataTypeStorage DataTypeZeroValue; // 0 for all data types int BeginMenuDepth; int BeginComboDepth; ImGuiColorEditFlags ColorEditOptions; // Store user options for color edit widgets @@ -2182,7 +2272,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext // Platform support ImGuiPlatformImeData PlatformImeData; // Data updated by current frame - ImGuiPlatformImeData PlatformImeDataPrev; // Previous frame data (when changing we will call io.SetPlatformImeDataFn + ImGuiPlatformImeData PlatformImeDataPrev; // Previous frame data. When changed we call the io.PlatformSetImeDataFn() handler. // Settings bool SettingsLoaded; @@ -2249,7 +2339,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext Initialized = false; FontAtlasOwnedByContext = shared_font_atlas ? false : true; Font = NULL; - FontSize = FontBaseSize = CurrentDpiScale = 0.0f; + FontSize = FontBaseSize = FontScale = CurrentDpiScale = 0.0f; IO.Fonts = shared_font_atlas ? shared_font_atlas : IM_NEW(ImFontAtlas)(); Time = 0.0f; FrameCount = 0; @@ -2258,6 +2348,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext GcCompactAll = false; TestEngineHookItems = false; TestEngine = NULL; + memset(ContextName, 0, sizeof(ContextName)); InputEventsNextMouseSource = ImGuiMouseSource_Mouse; InputEventsNextEventId = 1; @@ -2266,6 +2357,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext CurrentWindow = NULL; HoveredWindow = NULL; HoveredWindowUnderMovingWindow = NULL; + HoveredWindowBeforeClear = NULL; MovingWindow = NULL; WheelingWindow = NULL; WheelingWindowStartFrame = WheelingWindowScrolledFrame = -1; @@ -2274,8 +2366,9 @@ struct ImGuiContext DebugHookIdInfo = 0; HoveredId = HoveredIdPreviousFrame = 0; HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; - HoveredIdDisabled = false; + HoveredIdIsDisabled = false; HoveredIdTimer = HoveredIdNotActiveTimer = 0.0f; + ItemUnclipByLog = false; ActiveId = 0; ActiveIdIsAlive = 0; ActiveIdTimer = 0.0f; @@ -2311,18 +2404,18 @@ struct ImGuiContext NavWindow = NULL; NavId = NavFocusScopeId = NavActivateId = NavActivateDownId = NavActivatePressedId = 0; - NavJustMovedToId = NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = NavNextActivateId = 0; + NavLayer = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; + NavNextActivateId = 0; NavActivateFlags = NavNextActivateFlags = ImGuiActivateFlags_None; NavHighlightActivatedId = 0; NavHighlightActivatedTimer = 0.0f; - NavJustMovedToKeyMods = ImGuiMod_None; NavInputSource = ImGuiInputSource_Keyboard; - NavLayer = ImGuiNavLayer_Main; NavLastValidSelectionUserData = ImGuiSelectionUserData_Invalid; NavIdIsAlive = false; NavMousePosDirty = false; NavDisableHighlight = true; NavDisableMouseHover = false; + NavAnyRequest = false; NavInitRequest = false; NavInitRequestFromMove = false; @@ -2337,6 +2430,11 @@ struct ImGuiContext NavTabbingDir = 0; NavTabbingCounter = 0; + NavJustMovedFromFocusScopeId = NavJustMovedToId = NavJustMovedToFocusScopeId = 0; + NavJustMovedToKeyMods = ImGuiMod_None; + NavJustMovedToIsTabbing = false; + NavJustMovedToHasSelectionData = false; + // All platforms use Ctrl+Tab but Ctrl<>Super are swapped on Mac... // FIXME: Because this value is stored, it annoyingly interfere with toggling io.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors updating this.. ConfigNavWindowingKeyNext = IO.ConfigMacOSXBehaviors ? (ImGuiMod_Super | ImGuiKey_Tab) : (ImGuiMod_Ctrl | ImGuiKey_Tab); @@ -2365,6 +2463,8 @@ struct ImGuiContext CurrentTable = NULL; TablesTempDataStacked = 0; CurrentTabBar = NULL; + CurrentMultiSelect = NULL; + MultiSelectTempDataStacked = 0; HoverItemDelayId = HoverItemDelayIdPreviousFrame = HoverItemUnlockedStationaryId = HoverWindowUnlockedStationaryId = 0; HoverItemDelayTimer = HoverItemDelayClearTimer = 0.0f; @@ -2373,6 +2473,7 @@ struct ImGuiContext MouseStationaryTimer = 0.0f; TempInputId = 0; + memset(&DataTypeZeroValue, 0, sizeof(DataTypeZeroValue)); BeginMenuDepth = BeginComboDepth = 0; ColorEditOptions = ImGuiColorEditFlags_DefaultOptions_; ColorEditCurrentID = ColorEditSavedID = 0; @@ -2476,7 +2577,7 @@ struct IMGUI_API ImGuiWindowTempData ImVec2 MenuBarOffset; // MenuBarOffset.x is sort of equivalent of a per-layer CursorPos.x, saved/restored as we switch to the menu bar. The only situation when MenuBarOffset.y is > 0 if when (SafeAreaPadding.y > FramePadding.y), often used on TVs. ImGuiMenuColumns MenuColumns; // Simplified columns storage for menu items measurement int TreeDepth; // Current tree depth. - ImU32 TreeJumpToParentOnPopMask; // Store a copy of !g.NavIdIsAlive for TreeDepth 0..31.. Could be turned into a ImU64 if necessary. + ImU32 TreeHasStackDataDepthMask; // Store whether given depth has ImGuiTreeNodeStackData data. Could be turned into a ImU64 if necessary. ImVector ChildWindows; ImGuiStorage* StateStorage; // Current persistent per-window storage (store e.g. tree node open/close state) ImGuiOldColumns* CurrentColumns; // Current columns set @@ -2995,7 +3096,7 @@ namespace ImGui { // Windows // We should always have a CurrentWindow in the stack (there is an implicit "Debug" window) - // If this ever crash because g.CurrentWindow is NULL it means that either + // If this ever crashes because g.CurrentWindow is NULL, it means that either: // - ImGui::NewFrame() has never been called, which is illegal. // - You are calling ImGui functions after ImGui::EndFrame()/ImGui::Render() and before the next ImGui::NewFrame(), which is also illegal. inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindowRead() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.CurrentWindow; } @@ -3018,6 +3119,7 @@ namespace ImGui inline ImRect WindowRectAbsToRel(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& r) { ImVec2 off = window->DC.CursorStartPos; return ImRect(r.Min.x - off.x, r.Min.y - off.y, r.Max.x - off.x, r.Max.y - off.y); } inline ImRect WindowRectRelToAbs(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& r) { ImVec2 off = window->DC.CursorStartPos; return ImRect(r.Min.x + off.x, r.Min.y + off.y, r.Max.x + off.x, r.Max.y + off.y); } inline ImVec2 WindowPosRelToAbs(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& p) { ImVec2 off = window->DC.CursorStartPos; return ImVec2(p.x + off.x, p.y + off.y); } + inline ImVec2 WindowPosAbsToRel(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& p) { ImVec2 off = window->DC.CursorStartPos; return ImVec2(p.x - off.x, p.y - off.y); } // Windows: Display Order and Focus Order IMGUI_API void FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiFocusRequestFlags flags = 0); @@ -3119,14 +3221,13 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_w, float default_h); IMGUI_API float CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x); IMGUI_API void PushMultiItemsWidths(int components, float width_full); - IMGUI_API bool IsItemToggledSelection(); // Was the last item selection toggled? (after Selectable(), TreeNode() etc. We only returns toggle _event_ in order to handle clipping correctly) IMGUI_API ImVec2 GetContentRegionMaxAbs(); IMGUI_API void ShrinkWidths(ImGuiShrinkWidthItem* items, int count, float width_excess); // Parameter stacks (shared) - IMGUI_API void PushItemFlag(ImGuiItemFlags option, bool enabled); - IMGUI_API void PopItemFlag(); IMGUI_API const ImGuiDataVarInfo* GetStyleVarInfo(ImGuiStyleVar idx); + IMGUI_API void BeginDisabledOverrideReenable(); + IMGUI_API void EndDisabledOverrideReenable(); // Logging/Capture IMGUI_API void LogBegin(ImGuiLogType type, int auto_open_depth); // -> BeginCapture() when we design v2 api, for now stay under the radar by using the old name. @@ -3134,16 +3235,16 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void LogRenderedText(const ImVec2* ref_pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); IMGUI_API void LogSetNextTextDecoration(const char* prefix, const char* suffix); - // Popups, Modals, Tooltips + // Childs IMGUI_API bool BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiChildFlags child_flags, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags); + + // Popups, Modals + IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_window_flags); IMGUI_API void OpenPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags = ImGuiPopupFlags_None); IMGUI_API void ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining, bool restore_focus_to_window_under_popup); IMGUI_API void ClosePopupsOverWindow(ImGuiWindow* ref_window, bool restore_focus_to_window_under_popup); IMGUI_API void ClosePopupsExceptModals(); IMGUI_API bool IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiPopupFlags popup_flags); - IMGUI_API bool BeginPopupEx(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags); - IMGUI_API bool BeginTooltipEx(ImGuiTooltipFlags tooltip_flags, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_window_flags); - IMGUI_API bool BeginTooltipHidden(); IMGUI_API ImRect GetPopupAllowedExtentRect(ImGuiWindow* window); IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* GetTopMostPopupModal(); IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* GetTopMostAndVisiblePopupModal(); @@ -3151,6 +3252,10 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API ImVec2 FindBestWindowPosForPopup(ImGuiWindow* window); IMGUI_API ImVec2 FindBestWindowPosForPopupEx(const ImVec2& ref_pos, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiDir* last_dir, const ImRect& r_outer, const ImRect& r_avoid, ImGuiPopupPositionPolicy policy); + // Tooltips + IMGUI_API bool BeginTooltipEx(ImGuiTooltipFlags tooltip_flags, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_window_flags); + IMGUI_API bool BeginTooltipHidden(); + // Menus IMGUI_API bool BeginViewportSideBar(const char* name, ImGuiViewport* viewport, ImGuiDir dir, float size, ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags); IMGUI_API bool BeginMenuEx(const char* label, const char* icon, bool enabled = true); @@ -3168,7 +3273,7 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestSubmit(ImGuiDir move_dir, ImGuiDir clip_dir, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags, ImGuiScrollFlags scroll_flags); IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestForward(ImGuiDir move_dir, ImGuiDir clip_dir, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags, ImGuiScrollFlags scroll_flags); IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestResolveWithLastItem(ImGuiNavItemData* result); - IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestResolveWithPastTreeNode(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImGuiNavTreeNodeData* tree_node_data); + IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestResolveWithPastTreeNode(ImGuiNavItemData* result, ImGuiTreeNodeStackData* tree_node_data); IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestCancel(); IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestApplyResult(); IMGUI_API void NavMoveRequestTryWrapping(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiNavMoveFlags move_flags); @@ -3233,7 +3338,7 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API ImGuiID GetKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key); IMGUI_API void SetKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key, ImGuiID owner_id, ImGuiInputFlags flags = 0); IMGUI_API void SetKeyOwnersForKeyChord(ImGuiKeyChord key, ImGuiID owner_id, ImGuiInputFlags flags = 0); - IMGUI_API void SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key, ImGuiInputFlags flags = 0); // Set key owner to last item if it is hovered or active. Equivalent to 'if (IsItemHovered() || IsItemActive()) { SetKeyOwner(key, GetItemID());'. + IMGUI_API void SetItemKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key, ImGuiInputFlags flags); // Set key owner to last item if it is hovered or active. Equivalent to 'if (IsItemHovered() || IsItemActive()) { SetKeyOwner(key, GetItemID());'. IMGUI_API bool TestKeyOwner(ImGuiKey key, ImGuiID owner_id); // Test that key is either not owned, either owned by 'owner_id' inline ImGuiKeyOwnerData* GetKeyOwnerData(ImGuiContext* ctx, ImGuiKey key) { if (key & ImGuiMod_Mask_) key = ConvertSingleModFlagToKey(key); IM_ASSERT(IsNamedKey(key)); return &ctx->KeysOwnerData[key - ImGuiKey_NamedKey_BEGIN]; } @@ -3296,6 +3401,18 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API int TypingSelectFindNextSingleCharMatch(ImGuiTypingSelectRequest* req, int items_count, const char* (*get_item_name_func)(void*, int), void* user_data, int nav_item_idx); IMGUI_API int TypingSelectFindBestLeadingMatch(ImGuiTypingSelectRequest* req, int items_count, const char* (*get_item_name_func)(void*, int), void* user_data); + // Box-Select API + IMGUI_API bool BeginBoxSelect(ImGuiWindow* window, ImGuiID box_select_id, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags ms_flags); + IMGUI_API void EndBoxSelect(const ImRect& scope_rect, ImGuiMultiSelectFlags ms_flags); + + // Multi-Select API + IMGUI_API void MultiSelectItemHeader(ImGuiID id, bool* p_selected, ImGuiButtonFlags* p_button_flags); + IMGUI_API void MultiSelectItemFooter(ImGuiID id, bool* p_selected, bool* p_pressed); + IMGUI_API void MultiSelectAddSetAll(ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms, bool selected); + IMGUI_API void MultiSelectAddSetRange(ImGuiMultiSelectTempData* ms, bool selected, int range_dir, ImGuiSelectionUserData first_item, ImGuiSelectionUserData last_item); + inline ImGuiBoxSelectState* GetBoxSelectState(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (id != 0 && g.BoxSelectState.ID == id && g.BoxSelectState.IsActive) ? &g.BoxSelectState : NULL; } + inline ImGuiMultiSelectState* GetMultiSelectState(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.MultiSelectStorage.GetByKey(id); } + // Internal Columns API (this is not exposed because we will encourage transitioning to the Tables API) IMGUI_API void SetWindowClipRectBeforeSetChannel(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImRect& clip_rect); IMGUI_API void BeginColumns(const char* str_id, int count, ImGuiOldColumnFlags flags = 0); // setup number of columns. use an identifier to distinguish multiple column sets. close with EndColumns(). @@ -3312,7 +3429,6 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void TableOpenContextMenu(int column_n = -1); IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnWidth(int column_n, float width); IMGUI_API void TableSetColumnSortDirection(int column_n, ImGuiSortDirection sort_direction, bool append_to_sort_specs); - IMGUI_API int TableGetHoveredColumn(); // May use (TableGetColumnFlags() & ImGuiTableColumnFlags_IsHovered) instead. Return hovered column. return -1 when table is not hovered. return columns_count if the unused space at the right of visible columns is hovered. IMGUI_API int TableGetHoveredRow(); // Retrieve *PREVIOUS FRAME* hovered row. This difference with TableGetHoveredColumn() is the reason why this is not public yet. IMGUI_API float TableGetHeaderRowHeight(); IMGUI_API float TableGetHeaderAngledMaxLabelWidth(); @@ -3433,11 +3549,13 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API bool DragBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, float v_speed, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags); IMGUI_API bool SliderBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_v, const void* p_min, const void* p_max, const char* format, ImGuiSliderFlags flags, ImRect* out_grab_bb); IMGUI_API bool SplitterBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, ImGuiAxis axis, float* size1, float* size2, float min_size1, float min_size2, float hover_extend = 0.0f, float hover_visibility_delay = 0.0f, ImU32 bg_col = 0); - IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end = NULL); + + // Widgets: Tree Nodes + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiID storage_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end = NULL); IMGUI_API void TreePushOverrideID(ImGuiID id); - IMGUI_API void TreeNodeSetOpen(ImGuiID id, bool open); - IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags); // Return open state. Consume previous SetNextItemOpen() data, if any. May return true when logging. - IMGUI_API void SetNextItemSelectionUserData(ImGuiSelectionUserData selection_user_data); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeGetOpen(ImGuiID storage_id); + IMGUI_API void TreeNodeSetOpen(ImGuiID storage_id, bool open); + IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeUpdateNextOpen(ImGuiID storage_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags); // Return open state. Consume previous SetNextItemOpen() data, if any. May return true when logging. // Template functions are instantiated in imgui_widgets.cpp for a finite number of types. // To use them externally (for custom widget) you may need an "extern template" statement in your code in order to link to existing instances and silence Clang warnings (see #2036). @@ -3453,7 +3571,7 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API const ImGuiDataTypeInfo* DataTypeGetInfo(ImGuiDataType data_type); IMGUI_API int DataTypeFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* p_data, const char* format); IMGUI_API void DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* output, const void* arg_1, const void* arg_2); - IMGUI_API bool DataTypeApplyFromText(const char* buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format); + IMGUI_API bool DataTypeApplyFromText(const char* buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format, void* p_data_when_empty = NULL); IMGUI_API int DataTypeCompare(ImGuiDataType data_type, const void* arg_1, const void* arg_2); IMGUI_API bool DataTypeClamp(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const void* p_min, const void* p_max); @@ -3464,6 +3582,7 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API bool TempInputScalar(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data, const char* format, const void* p_clamp_min = NULL, const void* p_clamp_max = NULL); inline bool TempInputIsActive(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (g.ActiveId == id && g.TempInputId == id); } inline ImGuiInputTextState* GetInputTextState(ImGuiID id) { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return (id != 0 && g.InputTextState.ID == id) ? &g.InputTextState : NULL; } // Get input text state if active + IMGUI_API void SetNextItemRefVal(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* p_data); // Color IMGUI_API void ColorTooltip(const char* text, const float* col, ImGuiColorEditFlags flags); @@ -3483,12 +3602,8 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void GcCompactTransientWindowBuffers(ImGuiWindow* window); IMGUI_API void GcAwakeTransientWindowBuffers(ImGuiWindow* window); - // Debug Log - IMGUI_API void DebugLog(const char* fmt, ...) IM_FMTARGS(1); - IMGUI_API void DebugLogV(const char* fmt, va_list args) IM_FMTLIST(1); - IMGUI_API void DebugAllocHook(ImGuiDebugAllocInfo* info, int frame_count, void* ptr, size_t size); // size >= 0 : alloc, size = -1 : free - // Debug Tools + IMGUI_API void DebugAllocHook(ImGuiDebugAllocInfo* info, int frame_count, void* ptr, size_t size); // size >= 0 : alloc, size = -1 : free IMGUI_API void ErrorCheckEndFrameRecover(ImGuiErrorLogCallback log_callback, void* user_data = NULL); IMGUI_API void ErrorCheckEndWindowRecover(ImGuiErrorLogCallback log_callback, void* user_data = NULL); IMGUI_API void ErrorCheckUsingSetCursorPosToExtendParentBoundaries(); @@ -3515,6 +3630,7 @@ namespace ImGui IMGUI_API void DebugNodeTableSettings(ImGuiTableSettings* settings); IMGUI_API void DebugNodeInputTextState(ImGuiInputTextState* state); IMGUI_API void DebugNodeTypingSelectState(ImGuiTypingSelectState* state); + IMGUI_API void DebugNodeMultiSelectState(ImGuiMultiSelectState* state); IMGUI_API void DebugNodeWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, const char* label); IMGUI_API void DebugNodeWindowSettings(ImGuiWindowSettings* settings); IMGUI_API void DebugNodeWindowsList(ImVector* windows, const char* label); diff --git a/misc/freetype/imgui_freetype.cpp b/misc/freetype/imgui_freetype.cpp index a5acab32d1a8..68e38ed95b88 100644 --- a/misc/freetype/imgui_freetype.cpp +++ b/misc/freetype/imgui_freetype.cpp @@ -357,7 +357,7 @@ namespace case FT_PIXEL_MODE_BGRA: { // FIXME: Converting pre-multiplied alpha to straight. Doesn't smell good. - #define DE_MULTIPLY(color, alpha) (ImU32)(255.0f * (float)color / (float)alpha + 0.5f) + #define DE_MULTIPLY(color, alpha) ImMin((ImU32)(255.0f * (float)color / (float)(alpha + FLT_MIN) + 0.5f), 255u) if (multiply_table == nullptr) { for (uint32_t y = 0; y < h; y++, src += src_pitch, dst += dst_pitch)